3 \# Source code to NASM documentation
21 \IR{!=} \c{!=} operator
22 \IR{$ here} \c{$} Here token
25 \IR{%%} \c{%%} operator
26 \IR{%+1} \c{%+1} and \c{%-1} syntax
28 \IR{%0} \c{%0} parameter count
30 \IR{&&} \c{&&} operator
32 \IR{..@} \c{..@} symbol prefix
34 \IR{//} \c{//} operator
36 \IR{<<} \c{<<} operator
37 \IR{<=} \c{<=} operator
38 \IR{<>} \c{<>} operator
40 \IR{==} \c{==} operator
42 \IR{>=} \c{>=} operator
43 \IR{>>} \c{>>} operator
44 \IR{?} \c{?} MASM syntax
46 \IR{^^} \c{^^} operator
48 \IR{||} \c{||} operator
50 \IR{%$} \c{%$} and \c{%$$} prefixes
52 \IR{+ opaddition} \c{+} operator, binary
53 \IR{+ opunary} \c{+} operator, unary
54 \IR{+ modifier} \c{+} modifier
55 \IR{- opsubtraction} \c{-} operator, binary
56 \IR{- opunary} \c{-} operator, unary
57 \IR{alignment, in bin sections} alignment, in \c{bin} sections
58 \IR{alignment, in elf sections} alignment, in \c{elf} sections
59 \IR{alignment, in win32 sections} alignment, in \c{win32} sections
60 \IR{alignment, of elf common variables} alignment, of \c{elf} common
62 \IR{alignment, in obj sections} alignment, in \c{obj} sections
63 \IR{a.out, bsd version} \c{a.out}, BSD version
64 \IR{a.out, linux version} \c{a.out}, Linux version
65 \IR{autoconf} Autoconf
66 \IR{bitwise and} bitwise AND
67 \IR{bitwise or} bitwise OR
68 \IR{bitwise xor} bitwise XOR
69 \IR{block ifs} block IFs
70 \IR{borland pascal} Borland, Pascal
71 \IR{borland's win32 compilers} Borland, Win32 compilers
72 \IR{braces, after % sign} braces, after \c{%} sign
74 \IR{c calling convention} C calling convention
75 \IR{c symbol names} C symbol names
76 \IA{critical expressions}{critical expression}
77 \IA{command line}{command-line}
78 \IA{case sensitivity}{case sensitive}
79 \IA{case-sensitive}{case sensitive}
80 \IA{case-insensitive}{case sensitive}
81 \IA{character constants}{character constant}
82 \IR{common object file format} Common Object File Format
83 \IR{common variables, alignment in elf} common variables, alignment
85 \IR{common, elf extensions to} \c{COMMON}, \c{elf} extensions to
86 \IR{common, obj extensions to} \c{COMMON}, \c{obj} extensions to
87 \IR{declaring structure} declaring structures
88 \IR{default-wrt mechanism} default-\c{WRT} mechanism
91 \IR{dll symbols, exporting} DLL symbols, exporting
92 \IR{dll symbols, importing} DLL symbols, importing
94 \IR{dos archive} DOS archive
95 \IR{dos source archive} DOS source archive
96 \IA{effective address}{effective addresses}
97 \IA{effective-address}{effective addresses}
98 \IR{elf shared libraries} \c{elf} shared libraries
100 \IR{freelink} FreeLink
101 \IR{functions, c calling convention} functions, C calling convention
102 \IR{functions, pascal calling convention} functions, Pascal calling
104 \IR{global, aoutb extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{aoutb} extensions to
105 \IR{global, elf extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{elf} extensions to
106 \IR{global, rdf extensions to} \c{GLOBAL}, \c{rdf} extensions to
108 \IR{got relocations} \c{GOT} relocations
109 \IR{gotoff relocation} \c{GOTOFF} relocations
110 \IR{gotpc relocation} \c{GOTPC} relocations
111 \IR{linux elf} Linux ELF
112 \IR{logical and} logical AND
113 \IR{logical or} logical OR
114 \IR{logical xor} logical XOR
116 \IA{memory reference}{memory references}
117 \IA{misc directory}{misc subdirectory}
118 \IR{misc subdirectory} \c{misc} subdirectory
119 \IR{microsoft omf} Microsoft OMF
120 \IR{mmx registers} MMX registers
121 \IA{modr/m}{modr/m byte}
122 \IR{modr/m byte} ModR/M byte
124 \IR{ms-dos device drivers} MS-DOS device drivers
125 \IR{multipush} \c{multipush} macro
126 \IR{nasm version} NASM version
130 \IR{operating-system} operating system
132 \IR{pascal calling convention}Pascal calling convention
133 \IR{passes} passes, assembly
138 \IR{plt} \c{PLT} relocations
139 \IA{pre-defining macros}{pre-define}
141 \IA{rdoff subdirectory}{rdoff}
142 \IR{rdoff} \c{rdoff} subdirectory
143 \IR{relocatable dynamic object file format} Relocatable Dynamic
145 \IR{relocations, pic-specific} relocations, PIC-specific
146 \IA{repeating}{repeating code}
147 \IR{section alignment, in elf} section alignment, in \c{elf}
148 \IR{section alignment, in bin} section alignment, in \c{bin}
149 \IR{section alignment, in obj} section alignment, in \c{obj}
150 \IR{section alignment, in win32} section alignment, in \c{win32}
151 \IR{section, elf extensions to} \c{SECTION}, \c{elf} extensions to
152 \IR{section, win32 extensions to} \c{SECTION}, \c{win32} extensions to
153 \IR{segment alignment, in bin} segment alignment, in \c{bin}
154 \IR{segment alignment, in obj} segment alignment, in \c{obj}
155 \IR{segment, obj extensions to} \c{SEGMENT}, \c{elf} extensions to
156 \IR{segment names, borland pascal} segment names, Borland Pascal
157 \IR{shift commane} \c{shift} command
159 \IR{sib byte} SIB byte
160 \IA{standard section names}{standardised section names}
161 \IR{symbols, exporting from dlls} symbols, exporting from DLLs
162 \IR{symbols, importing from dlls} symbols, importing from DLLs
164 \IR{test subdirectory} \c{test} subdirectory
166 \IR{underscore, in c symbols} underscore, in C symbols
168 \IR{unix source archive} Unix source archive
170 \IR{version number of nasm} version number of NASM
171 \IR{visual c++} Visual C++
172 \IR{www page} WWW page
175 \IR{windows 95} Windows 95
176 \IR{windows nt} Windows NT
177 \# \IC{program entry point}{entry point, program}
178 \# \IC{program entry point}{start point, program}
179 \# \IC{MS-DOS device drivers}{device drivers, MS-DOS}
180 \# \IC{16-bit mode, versus 32-bit mode}{32-bit mode, versus 16-bit mode}
181 \# \IC{c symbol names}{symbol names, in C}
183 \C{intro} Introduction
185 \H{whatsnasm} What Is NASM?
187 The Netwide Assembler, NASM, is an 80x86 assembler designed for
188 portability and modularity. It supports a range of object file
189 formats, including Linux \c{a.out} and ELF, NetBSD/FreeBSD, COFF,
190 Microsoft 16-bit OBJ and Win32. It will also output plain binary
191 files. Its syntax is designed to be simple and easy to understand,
192 similar to Intel's but less complex. It supports Pentium, P6 and MMX
193 opcodes, and has macro capability.
195 \S{yaasm} Why Yet Another Assembler?
197 The Netwide Assembler grew out of an idea on \i\c{comp.lang.asm.x86}
198 (or possibly \i\c{alt.lang.asm} - I forget which), which was
199 essentially that there didn't seem to be a good free x86-series
200 assembler around, and that maybe someone ought to write one.
202 \b \i\c{a86} is good, but not free, and in particular you don't get any
203 32-bit capability until you pay. It's DOS only, too.
205 \b \i\c{gas} is free, and ports over DOS and Unix, but it's not very good,
206 since it's designed to be a back end to \i\c{gcc}, which always feeds
207 it correct code. So its error checking is minimal. Also, its syntax
208 is horrible, from the point of view of anyone trying to actually
209 \e{write} anything in it. Plus you can't write 16-bit code in it
212 \b \i\c{as86} is Linux-specific, and (my version at least) doesn't seem to
213 have much (or any) documentation.
215 \b \i{MASM} isn't very good, and it's expensive, and it runs only under
218 \b \i{TASM} is better, but still strives for \i{MASM} compatibility, which
219 means millions of directives and tons of red tape. And its syntax is
220 essentially \i{MASM}'s, with the contradictions and quirks that entails
221 (although it sorts out some of those by means of Ideal mode). It's
222 expensive too. And it's DOS-only.
224 So here, for your coding pleasure, is NASM. At present it's
225 still in prototype stage - we don't promise that it can outperform
226 any of these assemblers. But please, \e{please} send us bug reports,
227 fixes, helpful information, and anything else you can get your hands
228 on (and thanks to the many people who've done this already! You all
229 know who you are), and we'll improve it out of all recognition.
232 \S{legal} Licence Conditions
234 Please see the file \c{Licence}, supplied as part of any NASM
235 distribution archive, for the \i{licence} conditions under which you
238 \H{contact} Contact Information
240 The current version of NASM (since 0.98) are maintained by H. Peter
241 Anvin, \W{mailto:hpa@zytor.com}\c{hpa@zytor.com}. If you want to report
242 a bug, please read \k{bugs} first.
244 NASM has a \i{WWW page} at
245 \W{http://www.cryogen.com/Nasm}\c{http://www.cryogen.com/Nasm}.
247 The original authors are \i{e\-mail}able as
248 \W{mailto:jules@earthcorp.com}\c{jules@earthcorp.com} and
249 \W{mailto:anakin@pobox.com}\c{anakin@pobox.com}.
251 \i{New releases} of NASM are uploaded to
252 \W{ftp://ftp.kernel.org/pub/software/devel/nasm/}\i\c{ftp.kernel.org},
253 \W{ftp://sunsite.unc.edu/pub/Linux/devel/lang/assemblers/}\i\c{sunsite.unc.edu},
254 \W{ftp://ftp.simtel.net/pub/simtelnet/msdos/asmutl/}\i\c{ftp.simtel.net}
256 \W{ftp://ftp.coast.net/coast/msdos/asmutil/}\i\c{ftp.coast.net}.
257 Announcements are posted to
258 \W{news:comp.lang.asm.x86}\i\c{comp.lang.asm.x86},
259 \W{news:alt.lang.asm}\i\c{alt.lang.asm},
260 \W{news:comp.os.linux.announce}\i\c{comp.os.linux.announce} and
261 \W{news:comp.archives.msdos.announce}\i\c{comp.archives.msdos.announce}
262 (the last one is done automagically by uploading to
263 \W{ftp://ftp.simtel.net/pub/simtelnet/msdos/asmutl/}\c{ftp.simtel.net}).
265 If you don't have Usenet access, or would rather be informed by
266 \i{e\-mail} when new releases come out, you can subscribe to the
267 \c{nasm-announce} email list by sending an email containing the line
268 \c{subscribe nasm-announce} to
269 \W{mailto:majordomo@linux.kernel.org}\c{majordomo@linux.kernel.org}.
271 If you want information about NASM beta releases, please subscribe to
272 the \c{nasm-beta} email list by sending an email containing the line
273 \c{subscribe nasm-beta} to
274 \W{mailto:majordomo@linux.kernel.org}\c{majordomo@linux.kernel.org}.
276 \H{install} Installation
278 \S{instdos} \i{Installing} NASM under MS-\i{DOS} or Windows
280 Once you've obtained the \i{DOS archive} for NASM, \i\c{nasmXXX.zip}
281 (where \c{XXX} denotes the version number of NASM contained in the
282 archive), unpack it into its own directory (for example
285 The archive will contain four executable files: the NASM executable
286 files \i\c{nasm.exe} and \i\c{nasmw.exe}, and the NDISASM executable
287 files \i\c{ndisasm.exe} and \i\c{ndisasmw.exe}. In each case, the
288 file whose name ends in \c{w} is a \i{Win32} executable, designed to
289 run under \i{Windows 95} or \i{Windows NT} Intel, and the other one
290 is a 16-bit \i{DOS} executable.
292 The only file NASM needs to run is its own executable, so copy
293 (at least) one of \c{nasm.exe} and \c{nasmw.exe} to a directory on
294 your PATH, or alternatively edit \i\c{autoexec.bat} to add the
295 \c{nasm} directory to your \i\c{PATH}. (If you're only installing the
296 Win32 version, you may wish to rename it to \c{nasm.exe}.)
298 That's it - NASM is installed. You don't need the \c{nasm} directory
299 to be present to run NASM (unless you've added it to your \c{PATH}),
300 so you can delete it if you need to save space; however, you may
301 want to keep the documentation or test programs.
303 If you've downloaded the \i{DOS source archive}, \i\c{nasmXXXs.zip},
304 the \c{nasm} directory will also contain the full NASM \i{source
305 code}, and a selection of \i{Makefiles} you can (hopefully) use to
306 rebuild your copy of NASM from scratch. The file \c{Readme} lists the
307 various Makefiles and which compilers they work with.
309 Note that the source files \c{insnsa.c}, \c{insnsd.c}, \c{insnsi.h}
310 and \c{insnsn.c} are automatically generated from the master
311 instruction table \c{insns.dat} by a Perl script; the file
312 \c{macros.c} is generated from \c{standard.mac} by another Perl
313 script. Although the NASM 0.98 distribution includes these generated
314 files, you will need to rebuild them (and hence, will need a Perl
315 interpreter) if you change \c{insns.dat}, \c{standard.mac} or the
316 documentation. It is possible future source distributions may not
317 include these files at all. Ports of \i{Perl} for a variety of
318 platforms, including DOS and Windows, are available from
319 \W{http://www.cpan.org/ports/}\i{www.cpan.org}.
321 \S{instdos} Installing NASM under \i{Unix}
323 Once you've obtained the \i{Unix source archive} for NASM,
324 \i\c{nasm-X.XX.tar.gz} (where \c{X.XX} denotes the version number of
325 NASM contained in the archive), unpack it into a directory such
326 as \c{/usr/local/src}. The archive, when unpacked, will create its
327 own subdirectory \c{nasm-X.XX}.
329 NASM is an \I{Autoconf}\I\c{configure}auto-configuring package: once
330 you've unpacked it, \c{cd} to the directory it's been unpacked into
331 and type \c{./configure}. This shell script will find the best C
332 compiler to use for building NASM and set up \i{Makefiles}
335 Once NASM has auto-configured, you can type \i\c{make} to build the
336 \c{nasm} and \c{ndisasm} binaries, and then \c{make install} to
337 install them in \c{/usr/local/bin} and install the \i{man pages}
338 \i\c{nasm.1} and \i\c{ndisasm.1} in \c{/usr/local/man/man1}.
339 Alternatively, you can give options such as \c{--prefix} to the
340 \c{configure} script (see the file \i\c{INSTALL} for more details), or
341 install the programs yourself.
343 NASM also comes with a set of utilities for handling the RDOFF
344 custom object-file format, which are in the \i\c{rdoff} subdirectory
345 of the NASM archive. You can build these with \c{make rdf} and
346 install them with \c{make rdf_install}, if you want them.
348 If NASM fails to auto-configure, you may still be able to make it
349 compile by using the fall-back Unix makefile \i\c{Makefile.unx}.
350 Copy or rename that file to \c{Makefile} and try typing \c{make}.
351 There is also a \c{Makefile.unx} file in the \c{rdoff} subdirectory.
353 \C{running} Running NASM
355 \H{syntax} NASM \i{Command-Line} Syntax
357 To assemble a file, you issue a command of the form
359 \c nasm -f <format> <filename> [-o <output>]
363 \c nasm -f elf myfile.asm
365 will assemble \c{myfile.asm} into an ELF object file \c{myfile.o}. And
367 \c nasm -f bin myfile.asm -o myfile.com
369 will assemble \c{myfile.asm} into a raw binary file \c{myfile.com}.
371 To produce a listing file, with the hex codes output from NASM
372 displayed on the left of the original sources, use the \c{-l} option
373 to give a listing file name, for example:
375 \c nasm -f coff myfile.asm -l myfile.lst
377 To get further usage instructions from NASM, try typing
381 This will also list the available output file formats, and what they
384 If you use Linux but aren't sure whether your system is \c{a.out} or
389 (in the directory in which you put the NASM binary when you
390 installed it). If it says something like
392 \c nasm: ELF 32-bit LSB executable i386 (386 and up) Version 1
394 then your system is ELF, and you should use the option \c{-f elf}
395 when you want NASM to produce Linux object files. If it says
397 \c nasm: Linux/i386 demand-paged executable (QMAGIC)
399 or something similar, your system is \c{a.out}, and you should use
400 \c{-f aout} instead (Linux \c{a.out} systems are considered obsolete,
401 and are rare these days.)
403 Like Unix compilers and assemblers, NASM is silent unless it
404 goes wrong: you won't see any output at all, unless it gives error
407 \S{opt-o} The \i\c{-o} Option: Specifying the Output File Name
409 NASM will normally choose the name of your output file for you;
410 precisely how it does this is dependent on the object file format.
411 For Microsoft object file formats (\i\c{obj} and \i\c{win32}), it
412 will remove the \c{.asm} \i{extension} (or whatever extension you
413 like to use - NASM doesn't care) from your source file name and
414 substitute \c{.obj}. For Unix object file formats (\i\c{aout},
415 \i\c{coff}, \i\c{elf} and \i\c{as86}) it will substitute \c{.o}. For
416 \i\c{rdf}, it will use \c{.rdf}, and for the \i\c{bin} format it
417 will simply remove the extension, so that \c{myfile.asm} produces
418 the output file \c{myfile}.
420 If the output file already exists, NASM will overwrite it, unless it
421 has the same name as the input file, in which case it will give a
422 warning and use \i\c{nasm.out} as the output file name instead.
424 For situations in which this behaviour is unacceptable, NASM
425 provides the \c{-o} command-line option, which allows you to specify
426 your desired output file name. You invoke \c{-o} by following it
427 with the name you wish for the output file, either with or without
428 an intervening space. For example:
430 \c nasm -f bin program.asm -o program.com
431 \c nasm -f bin driver.asm -odriver.sys
433 \S{opt-f} The \i\c{-f} Option: Specifying the \i{Output File Format}
435 If you do not supply the \c{-f} option to NASM, it will choose an
436 output file format for you itself. In the distribution versions of
437 NASM, the default is always \i\c{bin}; if you've compiled your own
438 copy of NASM, you can redefine \i\c{OF_DEFAULT} at compile time and
439 choose what you want the default to be.
441 Like \c{-o}, the intervening space between \c{-f} and the output
442 file format is optional; so \c{-f elf} and \c{-felf} are both valid.
444 A complete list of the available output file formats can be given by
445 issuing the command \i\c{nasm -h}.
447 \S{opt-l} The \i\c{-l} Option: Generating a \i{Listing File}
449 If you supply the \c{-l} option to NASM, followed (with the usual
450 optional space) by a file name, NASM will generate a
451 \i{source-listing file} for you, in which addresses and generated
452 code are listed on the left, and the actual source code, with
453 expansions of multi-line macros (except those which specifically
454 request no expansion in source listings: see \k{nolist}) on the
457 \c nasm -f elf myfile.asm -l myfile.lst
459 \S{opt-E} The \i\c{-E} Option: Send Errors to a File
461 Under MS-\i{DOS} it can be difficult (though there are ways) to
462 redirect the standard-error output of a program to a file. Since
463 NASM usually produces its warning and \i{error messages} on
464 \i\c{stderr}, this can make it hard to capture the errors if (for
465 example) you want to load them into an editor.
467 NASM therefore provides the \c{-E} option, taking a filename argument
468 which causes errors to be sent to the specified files rather than
469 standard error. Therefore you can \I{redirecting errors}redirect
470 the errors into a file by typing
472 \c nasm -E myfile.err -f obj myfile.asm
474 \S{opt-s} The \i\c{-s} Option: Send Errors to \i\c{stdout}
476 The \c{-s} option redirects \i{error messages} to \c{stdout} rather
477 than \c{stderr}, so it can be redirected under MS-\i{DOS}. To
478 assemble the file \c{myfile.asm} and pipe its output to the \c{more}
479 program, you can type:
481 \c nasm -s -f obj myfile.asm | more
483 See also the \c{-E} option, \k{opt-E}.
485 \S{opt-i} The \i\c{-i}\I\c{-I} Option: Include File Search Directories
487 When NASM sees the \i\c{%include} directive in a source file (see
488 \k{include}), it will search for the given file not only in the
489 current directory, but also in any directories specified on the
490 command line by the use of the \c{-i} option. Therefore you can
491 include files from a \i{macro library}, for example, by typing
493 \c nasm -ic:\\macrolib\\ -f obj myfile.asm
495 (As usual, a space between \c{-i} and the path name is allowed, and
498 NASM, in the interests of complete source-code portability, does not
499 understand the file naming conventions of the OS it is running on;
500 the string you provide as an argument to the \c{-i} option will be
501 prepended exactly as written to the name of the include file.
502 Therefore the trailing backslash in the above example is necessary.
503 Under Unix, a trailing forward slash is similarly necessary.
505 (You can use this to your advantage, if you're really \i{perverse},
506 by noting that the option \c{-ifoo} will cause \c{%include "bar.i"}
507 to search for the file \c{foobar.i}...)
509 If you want to define a \e{standard} \i{include search path},
510 similar to \c{/usr/include} on Unix systems, you should place one or
511 more \c{-i} directives in the \c{NASM} environment variable (see
514 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
515 be specified as \c{-I}.
517 \S{opt-p} The \i\c{-p}\I\c{-P} Option: \I{pre-including files}Pre-Include a File
519 \I\c{%include}NASM allows you to specify files to be
520 \e{pre-included} into your source file, by the use of the \c{-p}
523 \c nasm myfile.asm -p myinc.inc
525 is equivalent to running \c{nasm myfile.asm} and placing the
526 directive \c{%include "myinc.inc"} at the start of the file.
528 For consistency with the \c{-I}, \c{-D} and \c{-U} options, this
529 option can also be specified as \c{-P}.
531 \S{opt-d} The \i\c{-d}\I\c{-D} Option: \I{pre-defining macros} Pre-Define a Macro
533 \I\c{%define}Just as the \c{-p} option gives an alternative to placing
534 \c{%include} directives at the start of a source file, the \c{-d}
535 option gives an alternative to placing a \c{%define} directive. You
538 \c nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100
540 as an alternative to placing the directive
544 at the start of the file. You can miss off the macro value, as well:
545 the option \c{-dFOO} is equivalent to coding \c{%define FOO}. This
546 form of the directive may be useful for selecting \i{assembly-time
547 options} which are then tested using \c{%ifdef}, for example
550 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
551 be specified as \c{-D}.
553 \S{opt-u} The \i\c{-u}\I\c{-U} Option: \I{Undefining macros} Undefine a Macro
555 \I\c{%undef}The \c{-u} option undefines a macro that would otherwise
556 have been pre-defined, either automatically or by a \c{-p} or \c{-d}
557 option specified earlier on the command lines.
559 For example, the following command line:
561 \c nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100 -uFOO
563 would result in \c{FOO} \e{not} being a predefined macro in the
564 program. This is useful to override options specified at a different
567 For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can also
568 be specified as \c{-U}.
570 \S{opt-e} The \i\c{-e} Option: Preprocess Only
572 NASM allows the \i{preprocessor} to be run on its own, up to a
573 point. Using the \c{-e} option (which requires no arguments) will
574 cause NASM to preprocess its input file, expand all the macro
575 references, remove all the comments and preprocessor directives, and
576 print the resulting file on standard output (or save it to a file,
577 if the \c{-o} option is also used).
579 This option cannot be applied to programs which require the
580 preprocessor to evaluate \I{preprocessor expressions}\i{expressions}
581 which depend on the values of symbols: so code such as
583 \c %assign tablesize ($-tablestart)
585 will cause an error in \i{preprocess-only mode}.
587 \S{opt-a} The \i\c{-a} Option: Don't Preprocess At All
589 If NASM is being used as the back end to a compiler, it might be
590 desirable to \I{suppressing preprocessing}suppress preprocessing
591 completely and assume the compiler has already done it, to save time
592 and increase compilation speeds. The \c{-a} option, requiring no
593 argument, instructs NASM to replace its powerful \i{preprocessor}
594 with a \i{stub preprocessor} which does nothing.
596 \S{opt-t} The \i\c{-t} option: Enable TASM Compatibility Mode
598 NASM includes a limited form of compatibility with Borland's TASM.
599 When NASM's -t option is used, the following changes are made:
601 \b local labels may be prefixed with \c{@@} instead of \c{.}
603 \b TASM-style response files beginning with \c{@} may be specified on
604 the command line. This is different from the \c{-@resp} style that NASM
607 \b size override is supported within brackets. In TASM compatible mode,
608 a size override inside square brackets changes the size of the operand,
609 and not the address type of the operand as it does in NASM syntax. E.g.
610 \c{mov eax,[DWORD val]} is valid syntax in TASM compatibility mode.
611 Note that you lose the ability to override the default address type for
614 \b \c{%arg} preprocessor directive is supported which is similar to
615 TASM's ARG directive.
617 \b \c{%local} preprocessor directive
619 \b \c{%stacksize} preprocessor directive
621 \b unprefixed forms of some directives supported (arg, elif, else,
622 endif, if, ifdef, ifdifi, ifndef, include, local)
626 For more information on the directives, see the section on TASM
627 Compatiblity preprocessor directives in \k{tasmcompat}.
629 \S{opt-w} The \i\c{-w} Option: Enable or Disable Assembly \i{Warnings}
631 NASM can observe many conditions during the course of assembly which
632 are worth mentioning to the user, but not a sufficiently severe
633 error to justify NASM refusing to generate an output file. These
634 conditions are reported like errors, but come up with the word
635 `warning' before the message. Warnings do not prevent NASM from
636 generating an output file and returning a success status to the
639 Some conditions are even less severe than that: they are only
640 sometimes worth mentioning to the user. Therefore NASM supports the
641 \c{-w} command-line option, which enables or disables certain
642 classes of assembly warning. Such warning classes are described by a
643 name, for example \c{orphan-labels}; you can enable warnings of
644 this class by the command-line option \c{-w+orphan-labels} and
645 disable it by \c{-w-orphan-labels}.
647 The \i{suppressible warning} classes are:
649 \b \i\c{macro-params} covers warnings about \i{multi-line macros}
650 being invoked with the wrong number of parameters. This warning
651 class is enabled by default; see \k{mlmacover} for an example of why
652 you might want to disable it.
654 \b \i\c{orphan-labels} covers warnings about source lines which
655 contain no instruction but define a label without a trailing colon.
656 NASM does not warn about this somewhat obscure condition by default;
657 see \k{syntax} for an example of why you might want it to.
659 \b \i\c{number-overflow} covers warnings about numeric constants which
660 don't fit in 32 bits (for example, it's easy to type one too many Fs
661 and produce \c{0x7ffffffff} by mistake). This warning class is
664 \S{nasmenv} The \c{NASM} \i{Environment} Variable
666 If you define an environment variable called \c{NASM}, the program
667 will interpret it as a list of extra command-line options, which are
668 processed before the real command line. You can use this to define
669 standard search directories for include files, by putting \c{-i}
670 options in the \c{NASM} variable.
672 The value of the variable is split up at white space, so that the
673 value \c{-s -ic:\\nasmlib} will be treated as two separate options.
674 However, that means that the value \c{-dNAME="my name"} won't do
675 what you might want, because it will be split at the space and the
676 NASM command-line processing will get confused by the two
677 nonsensical words \c{-dNAME="my} and \c{name"}.
679 To get round this, NASM provides a feature whereby, if you begin the
680 \c{NASM} environment variable with some character that isn't a minus
681 sign, then NASM will treat this character as the \i{separator
682 character} for options. So setting the \c{NASM} variable to the
683 value \c{!-s!-ic:\\nasmlib} is equivalent to setting it to \c{-s
684 -ic:\\nasmlib}, but \c{!-dNAME="my name"} will work.
686 \H{qstart} \i{Quick Start} for \i{MASM} Users
688 If you're used to writing programs with MASM, or with \i{TASM} in
689 MASM-compatible (non-Ideal) mode, or with \i\c{a86}, this section
690 attempts to outline the major differences between MASM's syntax and
691 NASM's. If you're not already used to MASM, it's probably worth
692 skipping this section.
694 \S{qscs} NASM Is \I{case sensitivity}Case-Sensitive
696 One simple difference is that NASM is case-sensitive. It makes a
697 difference whether you call your label \c{foo}, \c{Foo} or \c{FOO}.
698 If you're assembling to DOS or OS/2 \c{.OBJ} files, you can invoke
699 the \i\c{UPPERCASE} directive (documented in \k{objfmt}) to ensure
700 that all symbols exported to other code modules are forced to be
701 upper case; but even then, \e{within} a single module, NASM will
702 distinguish between labels differing only in case.
704 \S{qsbrackets} NASM Requires \i{Square Brackets} For \i{Memory References}
706 NASM was designed with simplicity of syntax in mind. One of the
707 \i{design goals} of NASM is that it should be possible, as far as is
708 practical, for the user to look at a single line of NASM code
709 and tell what opcode is generated by it. You can't do this in MASM:
710 if you declare, for example,
715 then the two lines of code
720 generate completely different opcodes, despite having
721 identical-looking syntaxes.
723 NASM avoids this undesirable situation by having a much simpler
724 syntax for memory references. The rule is simply that any access to
725 the \e{contents} of a memory location requires square brackets
726 around the address, and any access to the \e{address} of a variable
727 doesn't. So an instruction of the form \c{mov ax,foo} will
728 \e{always} refer to a compile-time constant, whether it's an \c{EQU}
729 or the address of a variable; and to access the \e{contents} of the
730 variable \c{bar}, you must code \c{mov ax,[bar]}.
732 This also means that NASM has no need for MASM's \i\c{OFFSET}
733 keyword, since the MASM code \c{mov ax,offset bar} means exactly the
734 same thing as NASM's \c{mov ax,bar}. If you're trying to get
735 large amounts of MASM code to assemble sensibly under NASM, you
736 can always code \c{%idefine offset} to make the preprocessor treat
737 the \c{OFFSET} keyword as a no-op.
739 This issue is even more confusing in \i\c{a86}, where declaring a
740 label with a trailing colon defines it to be a `label' as opposed to
741 a `variable' and causes \c{a86} to adopt NASM-style semantics; so in
742 \c{a86}, \c{mov ax,var} has different behaviour depending on whether
743 \c{var} was declared as \c{var: dw 0} (a label) or \c{var dw 0} (a
744 word-size variable). NASM is very simple by comparison:
745 \e{everything} is a label.
747 NASM, in the interests of simplicity, also does not support the
748 \i{hybrid syntaxes} supported by MASM and its clones, such as
749 \c{mov ax,table[bx]}, where a memory reference is denoted by one
750 portion outside square brackets and another portion inside. The
751 correct syntax for the above is \c{mov ax,[table+bx]}. Likewise,
752 \c{mov ax,es:[di]} is wrong and \c{mov ax,[es:di]} is right.
754 \S{qstypes} NASM Doesn't Store \i{Variable Types}
756 NASM, by design, chooses not to remember the types of variables you
757 declare. Whereas MASM will remember, on seeing \c{var dw 0}, that
758 you declared \c{var} as a word-size variable, and will then be able
759 to fill in the \i{ambiguity} in the size of the instruction \c{mov
760 var,2}, NASM will deliberately remember nothing about the symbol
761 \c{var} except where it begins, and so you must explicitly code
762 \c{mov word [var],2}.
764 For this reason, NASM doesn't support the \c{LODS}, \c{MOVS},
765 \c{STOS}, \c{SCAS}, \c{CMPS}, \c{INS}, or \c{OUTS} instructions,
766 but only supports the forms such as \c{LODSB}, \c{MOVSW}, and
767 \c{SCASD}, which explicitly specify the size of the components of
768 the strings being manipulated.
770 \S{qsassume} NASM Doesn't \i\c{ASSUME}
772 As part of NASM's drive for simplicity, it also does not support the
773 \c{ASSUME} directive. NASM will not keep track of what values you
774 choose to put in your segment registers, and will never
775 \e{automatically} generate a \i{segment override} prefix.
777 \S{qsmodel} NASM Doesn't Support \i{Memory Models}
779 NASM also does not have any directives to support different 16-bit
780 memory models. The programmer has to keep track of which functions
781 are supposed to be called with a \i{far call} and which with a
782 \i{near call}, and is responsible for putting the correct form of
783 \c{RET} instruction (\c{RETN} or \c{RETF}; NASM accepts \c{RET}
784 itself as an alternate form for \c{RETN}); in addition, the
785 programmer is responsible for coding CALL FAR instructions where
786 necessary when calling \e{external} functions, and must also keep
787 track of which external variable definitions are far and which are
790 \S{qsfpu} \i{Floating-Point} Differences
792 NASM uses different names to refer to floating-point registers from
793 MASM: where MASM would call them \c{ST(0)}, \c{ST(1)} and so on, and
794 \i\c{a86} would call them simply \c{0}, \c{1} and so on, NASM
795 chooses to call them \c{st0}, \c{st1} etc.
797 As of version 0.96, NASM now treats the instructions with
798 \i{`nowait'} forms in the same way as MASM-compatible assemblers.
799 The idiosyncratic treatment employed by 0.95 and earlier was based
800 on a misunderstanding by the authors.
802 \S{qsother} Other Differences
804 For historical reasons, NASM uses the keyword \i\c{TWORD} where MASM
805 and compatible assemblers use \i\c{TBYTE}.
807 NASM does not declare \i{uninitialised storage} in the same way as
808 MASM: where a MASM programmer might use \c{stack db 64 dup (?)},
809 NASM requires \c{stack resb 64}, intended to be read as `reserve 64
810 bytes'. For a limited amount of compatibility, since NASM treats
811 \c{?} as a valid character in symbol names, you can code \c{? equ 0}
812 and then writing \c{dw ?} will at least do something vaguely useful.
813 \I\c{RESB}\i\c{DUP} is still not a supported syntax, however.
815 In addition to all of this, macros and directives work completely
816 differently to MASM. See \k{preproc} and \k{directive} for further
819 \C{lang} The NASM Language
821 \H{syntax} Layout of a NASM Source Line
823 Like most assemblers, each NASM source line contains (unless it
824 is a macro, a preprocessor directive or an assembler directive: see
825 \k{preproc} and \k{directive}) some combination of the four fields
827 \c label: instruction operands ; comment
829 As usual, most of these fields are optional; the presence or absence
830 of any combination of a label, an instruction and a comment is allowed.
831 Of course, the operand field is either required or forbidden by the
832 presence and nature of the instruction field.
834 NASM places no restrictions on white space within a line: labels may
835 have white space before them, or instructions may have no space
836 before them, or anything. The \i{colon} after a label is also
837 optional. (Note that this means that if you intend to code \c{lodsb}
838 alone on a line, and type \c{lodab} by accident, then that's still a
839 valid source line which does nothing but define a label. Running
840 NASM with the command-line option
841 \I{orphan-labels}\c{-w+orphan-labels} will cause it to warn you if
842 you define a label alone on a line without a \i{trailing colon}.)
844 \i{Valid characters} in labels are letters, numbers, \c{_}, \c{$},
845 \c{#}, \c{@}, \c{~}, \c{.}, and \c{?}. The only characters which may
846 be used as the \e{first} character of an identifier are letters,
847 \c{.} (with special meaning: see \k{locallab}), \c{_} and \c{?}.
848 An identifier may also be prefixed with a \I{$prefix}\c{$} to
849 indicate that it is intended to be read as an identifier and not a
850 reserved word; thus, if some other module you are linking with
851 defines a symbol called \c{eax}, you can refer to \c{$eax} in NASM
852 code to distinguish the symbol from the register.
854 The instruction field may contain any machine instruction: Pentium
855 and P6 instructions, FPU instructions, MMX instructions and even
856 undocumented instructions are all supported. The instruction may be
857 prefixed by \c{LOCK}, \c{REP}, \c{REPE}/\c{REPZ} or
858 \c{REPNE}/\c{REPNZ}, in the usual way. Explicit \I{address-size
859 prefixes}address-size and \i{operand-size prefixes} \c{A16},
860 \c{A32}, \c{O16} and \c{O32} are provided - one example of their use
861 is given in \k{mixsize}. You can also use the name of a \I{segment
862 override}segment register as an instruction prefix: coding
863 \c{es mov [bx],ax} is equivalent to coding \c{mov [es:bx],ax}. We
864 recommend the latter syntax, since it is consistent with other
865 syntactic features of the language, but for instructions such as
866 \c{LODSB}, which has no operands and yet can require a segment
867 override, there is no clean syntactic way to proceed apart from
870 An instruction is not required to use a prefix: prefixes such as
871 \c{CS}, \c{A32}, \c{LOCK} or \c{REPE} can appear on a line by
872 themselves, and NASM will just generate the prefix bytes.
874 In addition to actual machine instructions, NASM also supports a
875 number of pseudo-instructions, described in \k{pseudop}.
877 Instruction \i{operands} may take a number of forms: they can be
878 registers, described simply by the register name (e.g. \c{ax},
879 \c{bp}, \c{ebx}, \c{cr0}: NASM does not use the \c{gas}-style
880 syntax in which register names must be prefixed by a \c{%} sign), or
881 they can be \i{effective addresses} (see \k{effaddr}), constants
882 (\k{const}) or expressions (\k{expr}).
884 For \i{floating-point} instructions, NASM accepts a wide range of
885 syntaxes: you can use two-operand forms like MASM supports, or you
886 can use NASM's native single-operand forms in most cases. Details of
887 all forms of each supported instruction are given in
888 \k{iref}. For example, you can code:
890 \c fadd st1 ; this sets st0 := st0 + st1
891 \c fadd st0,st1 ; so does this
893 \c fadd st1,st0 ; this sets st1 := st1 + st0
894 \c fadd to st1 ; so does this
896 Almost any floating-point instruction that references memory must
897 use one of the prefixes \i\c{DWORD}, \i\c{QWORD} or \i\c{TWORD} to
898 indicate what size of \i{memory operand} it refers to.
900 \H{pseudop} \i{Pseudo-Instructions}
902 Pseudo-instructions are things which, though not real x86 machine
903 instructions, are used in the instruction field anyway because
904 that's the most convenient place to put them. The current
905 pseudo-instructions are \i\c{DB}, \i\c{DW}, \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ} and
906 \i\c{DT}, their \i{uninitialised} counterparts \i\c{RESB},
907 \i\c{RESW}, \i\c{RESD}, \i\c{RESQ} and \i\c{REST}, the \i\c{INCBIN}
908 command, the \i\c{EQU} command, and the \i\c{TIMES} prefix.
910 \S{db} \c{DB} and friends: Declaring Initialised Data
912 \i\c{DB}, \i\c{DW}, \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ} and \i\c{DT} are used, much
913 as in MASM, to declare initialised data in the output file. They can
914 be invoked in a wide range of ways:
915 \I{floating-point}\I{character constant}\I{string constant}
917 \c db 0x55 ; just the byte 0x55
918 \c db 0x55,0x56,0x57 ; three bytes in succession
919 \c db 'a',0x55 ; character constants are OK
920 \c db 'hello',13,10,'$' ; so are string constants
921 \c dw 0x1234 ; 0x34 0x12
922 \c dw 'a' ; 0x41 0x00 (it's just a number)
923 \c dw 'ab' ; 0x41 0x42 (character constant)
924 \c dw 'abc' ; 0x41 0x42 0x43 0x00 (string)
925 \c dd 0x12345678 ; 0x78 0x56 0x34 0x12
926 \c dd 1.234567e20 ; floating-point constant
927 \c dq 1.234567e20 ; double-precision float
928 \c dt 1.234567e20 ; extended-precision float
930 \c{DQ} and \c{DT} do not accept \i{numeric constants} or string
931 constants as operands.
933 \S{resb} \c{RESB} and friends: Declaring \i{Uninitialised} Data
935 \i\c{RESB}, \i\c{RESW}, \i\c{RESD}, \i\c{RESQ} and \i\c{REST} are
936 designed to be used in the BSS section of a module: they declare
937 \e{uninitialised} storage space. Each takes a single operand, which
938 is the number of bytes, words, doublewords or whatever to reserve.
939 As stated in \k{qsother}, NASM does not support the MASM/TASM syntax
940 of reserving uninitialised space by writing \I\c{?}\c{DW ?} or
941 similar things: this is what it does instead. The operand to a
942 \c{RESB}-type pseudo-instruction is a \i\e{critical expression}: see
947 \c buffer: resb 64 ; reserve 64 bytes
948 \c wordvar: resw 1 ; reserve a word
949 \c realarray resq 10 ; array of ten reals
951 \S{incbin} \i\c{INCBIN}: Including External \i{Binary Files}
953 \c{INCBIN} is borrowed from the old Amiga assembler \i{DevPac}: it
954 includes a binary file verbatim into the output file. This can be
955 handy for (for example) including \i{graphics} and \i{sound} data
956 directly into a game executable file. It can be called in one of
959 \c incbin "file.dat" ; include the whole file
960 \c incbin "file.dat",1024 ; skip the first 1024 bytes
961 \c incbin "file.dat",1024,512 ; skip the first 1024, and
962 \c ; actually include at most 512
964 \S{equ} \i\c{EQU}: Defining Constants
966 \c{EQU} defines a symbol to a given constant value: when \c{EQU} is
967 used, the source line must contain a label. The action of \c{EQU} is
968 to define the given label name to the value of its (only) operand.
969 This definition is absolute, and cannot change later. So, for
972 \c message db 'hello, world'
973 \c msglen equ $-message
975 defines \c{msglen} to be the constant 12. \c{msglen} may not then be
976 redefined later. This is not a \i{preprocessor} definition either:
977 the value of \c{msglen} is evaluated \e{once}, using the value of
978 \c{$} (see \k{expr} for an explanation of \c{$}) at the point of
979 definition, rather than being evaluated wherever it is referenced
980 and using the value of \c{$} at the point of reference. Note that
981 the operand to an \c{EQU} is also a \i{critical expression}
984 \S{times} \i\c{TIMES}: \i{Repeating} Instructions or Data
986 The \c{TIMES} prefix causes the instruction to be assembled multiple
987 times. This is partly present as NASM's equivalent of the \i\c{DUP}
988 syntax supported by \i{MASM}-compatible assemblers, in that you can
991 \c zerobuf: times 64 db 0
993 or similar things; but \c{TIMES} is more versatile than that. The
994 argument to \c{TIMES} is not just a numeric constant, but a numeric
995 \e{expression}, so you can do things like
997 \c buffer: db 'hello, world'
998 \c times 64-$+buffer db ' '
1000 which will store exactly enough spaces to make the total length of
1001 \c{buffer} up to 64. Finally, \c{TIMES} can be applied to ordinary
1002 instructions, so you can code trivial \i{unrolled loops} in it:
1006 Note that there is no effective difference between \c{times 100 resb
1007 1} and \c{resb 100}, except that the latter will be assembled about
1008 100 times faster due to the internal structure of the assembler.
1010 The operand to \c{TIMES}, like that of \c{EQU} and those of \c{RESB}
1011 and friends, is a critical expression (\k{crit}).
1013 Note also that \c{TIMES} can't be applied to \i{macros}: the reason
1014 for this is that \c{TIMES} is processed after the macro phase, which
1015 allows the argument to \c{TIMES} to contain expressions such as
1016 \c{64-$+buffer} as above. To repeat more than one line of code, or a
1017 complex macro, use the preprocessor \i\c{%rep} directive.
1019 \H{effaddr} Effective Addresses
1021 An \i{effective address} is any operand to an instruction which
1022 \I{memory reference}references memory. Effective addresses, in NASM,
1023 have a very simple syntax: they consist of an expression evaluating
1024 to the desired address, enclosed in \i{square brackets}. For
1029 \c mov ax,[wordvar+1]
1030 \c mov ax,[es:wordvar+bx]
1032 Anything not conforming to this simple system is not a valid memory
1033 reference in NASM, for example \c{es:wordvar[bx]}.
1035 More complicated effective addresses, such as those involving more
1036 than one register, work in exactly the same way:
1038 \c mov eax,[ebx*2+ecx+offset]
1041 NASM is capable of doing \i{algebra} on these effective addresses,
1042 so that things which don't necessarily \e{look} legal are perfectly
1045 \c mov eax,[ebx*5] ; assembles as [ebx*4+ebx]
1046 \c mov eax,[label1*2-label2] ; ie [label1+(label1-label2)]
1048 Some forms of effective address have more than one assembled form;
1049 in most such cases NASM will generate the smallest form it can. For
1050 example, there are distinct assembled forms for the 32-bit effective
1051 addresses \c{[eax*2+0]} and \c{[eax+eax]}, and NASM will generally
1052 generate the latter on the grounds that the former requires four
1053 bytes to store a zero offset.
1055 NASM has a hinting mechanism which will cause \c{[eax+ebx]} and
1056 \c{[ebx+eax]} to generate different opcodes; this is occasionally
1057 useful because \c{[esi+ebp]} and \c{[ebp+esi]} have different
1058 default segment registers.
1060 However, you can force NASM to generate an effective address in a
1061 particular form by the use of the keywords \c{BYTE}, \c{WORD},
1062 \c{DWORD} and \c{NOSPLIT}. If you need \c{[eax+3]} to be assembled
1063 using a double-word offset field instead of the one byte NASM will
1064 normally generate, you can code \c{[dword eax+3]}. Similarly, you
1065 can force NASM to use a byte offset for a small value which it
1066 hasn't seen on the first pass (see \k{crit} for an example of such a
1067 code fragment) by using \c{[byte eax+offset]}. As special cases,
1068 \c{[byte eax]} will code \c{[eax+0]} with a byte offset of zero, and
1069 \c{[dword eax]} will code it with a double-word offset of zero. The
1070 normal form, \c{[eax]}, will be coded with no offset field.
1072 Similarly, NASM will split \c{[eax*2]} into \c{[eax+eax]} because
1073 that allows the offset field to be absent and space to be saved; in
1074 fact, it will also split \c{[eax*2+offset]} into
1075 \c{[eax+eax+offset]}. You can combat this behaviour by the use of
1076 the \c{NOSPLIT} keyword: \c{[nosplit eax*2]} will force
1077 \c{[eax*2+0]} to be generated literally.
1079 \H{const} \i{Constants}
1081 NASM understands four different types of constant: numeric,
1082 character, string and floating-point.
1084 \S{numconst} \i{Numeric Constants}
1086 A numeric constant is simply a number. NASM allows you to specify
1087 numbers in a variety of number bases, in a variety of ways: you can
1088 suffix \c{H}, \c{Q} and \c{B} for \i{hex}, \i{octal} and \i{binary},
1089 or you can prefix \c{0x} for hex in the style of C, or you can
1090 prefix \c{$} for hex in the style of Borland Pascal. Note, though,
1091 that the \I{$prefix}\c{$} prefix does double duty as a prefix on
1092 identifiers (see \k{syntax}), so a hex number prefixed with a \c{$}
1093 sign must have a digit after the \c{$} rather than a letter.
1097 \c mov ax,100 ; decimal
1098 \c mov ax,0a2h ; hex
1099 \c mov ax,$0a2 ; hex again: the 0 is required
1100 \c mov ax,0xa2 ; hex yet again
1101 \c mov ax,777q ; octal
1102 \c mov ax,10010011b ; binary
1104 \S{chrconst} \i{Character Constants}
1106 A character constant consists of up to four characters enclosed in
1107 either single or double quotes. The type of quote makes no
1108 difference to NASM, except of course that surrounding the constant
1109 with single quotes allows double quotes to appear within it and vice
1112 A character constant with more than one character will be arranged
1113 with \i{little-endian} order in mind: if you code
1117 then the constant generated is not \c{0x61626364}, but
1118 \c{0x64636261}, so that if you were then to store the value into
1119 memory, it would read \c{abcd} rather than \c{dcba}. This is also
1120 the sense of character constants understood by the Pentium's
1121 \i\c{CPUID} instruction (see \k{insCPUID}).
1123 \S{strconst} String Constants
1125 String constants are only acceptable to some pseudo-instructions,
1126 namely the \I\c{DW}\I\c{DD}\I\c{DQ}\I\c{DT}\i\c{DB} family and
1129 A string constant looks like a character constant, only longer. It
1130 is treated as a concatenation of maximum-size character constants
1131 for the conditions. So the following are equivalent:
1133 \c db 'hello' ; string constant
1134 \c db 'h','e','l','l','o' ; equivalent character constants
1136 And the following are also equivalent:
1138 \c dd 'ninechars' ; doubleword string constant
1139 \c dd 'nine','char','s' ; becomes three doublewords
1140 \c db 'ninechars',0,0,0 ; and really looks like this
1142 Note that when used as an operand to \c{db}, a constant like
1143 \c{'ab'} is treated as a string constant despite being short enough
1144 to be a character constant, because otherwise \c{db 'ab'} would have
1145 the same effect as \c{db 'a'}, which would be silly. Similarly,
1146 three-character or four-character constants are treated as strings
1147 when they are operands to \c{dw}.
1149 \S{fltconst} \I{floating-point, constants}Floating-Point Constants
1151 \i{Floating-point} constants are acceptable only as arguments to
1152 \i\c{DD}, \i\c{DQ} and \i\c{DT}. They are expressed in the
1153 traditional form: digits, then a period, then optionally more
1154 digits, then optionally an \c{E} followed by an exponent. The period
1155 is mandatory, so that NASM can distinguish between \c{dd 1}, which
1156 declares an integer constant, and \c{dd 1.0} which declares a
1157 floating-point constant.
1161 \c dd 1.2 ; an easy one
1162 \c dq 1.e10 ; 10,000,000,000
1163 \c dq 1.e+10 ; synonymous with 1.e10
1164 \c dq 1.e-10 ; 0.000 000 000 1
1165 \c dt 3.141592653589793238462 ; pi
1167 NASM cannot do compile-time arithmetic on floating-point constants.
1168 This is because NASM is designed to be portable - although it always
1169 generates code to run on x86 processors, the assembler itself can
1170 run on any system with an ANSI C compiler. Therefore, the assembler
1171 cannot guarantee the presence of a floating-point unit capable of
1172 handling the \i{Intel number formats}, and so for NASM to be able to
1173 do floating arithmetic it would have to include its own complete set
1174 of floating-point routines, which would significantly increase the
1175 size of the assembler for very little benefit.
1177 \H{expr} \i{Expressions}
1179 Expressions in NASM are similar in syntax to those in C.
1181 NASM does not guarantee the size of the integers used to evaluate
1182 expressions at compile time: since NASM can compile and run on
1183 64-bit systems quite happily, don't assume that expressions are
1184 evaluated in 32-bit registers and so try to make deliberate use of
1185 \i{integer overflow}. It might not always work. The only thing NASM
1186 will guarantee is what's guaranteed by ANSI C: you always have \e{at
1187 least} 32 bits to work in.
1189 NASM supports two special tokens in expressions, allowing
1190 calculations to involve the current assembly position: the
1191 \I{$ here}\c{$} and \i\c{$$} tokens. \c{$} evaluates to the assembly
1192 position at the beginning of the line containing the expression; so
1193 you can code an \i{infinite loop} using \c{JMP $}. \c{$$} evaluates
1194 to the beginning of the current section; so you can tell how far
1195 into the section you are by using \c{($-$$)}.
1197 The arithmetic \i{operators} provided by NASM are listed here, in
1198 increasing order of \i{precedence}.
1200 \S{expor} \i\c{|}: \i{Bitwise OR} Operator
1202 The \c{|} operator gives a bitwise OR, exactly as performed by the
1203 \c{OR} machine instruction. Bitwise OR is the lowest-priority
1204 arithmetic operator supported by NASM.
1206 \S{expxor} \i\c{^}: \i{Bitwise XOR} Operator
1208 \c{^} provides the bitwise XOR operation.
1210 \S{expand} \i\c{&}: \i{Bitwise AND} Operator
1212 \c{&} provides the bitwise AND operation.
1214 \S{expshift} \i\c{<<} and \i\c{>>}: \i{Bit Shift} Operators
1216 \c{<<} gives a bit-shift to the left, just as it does in C. So \c{5<<3}
1217 evaluates to 5 times 8, or 40. \c{>>} gives a bit-shift to the
1218 right; in NASM, such a shift is \e{always} unsigned, so that
1219 the bits shifted in from the left-hand end are filled with zero
1220 rather than a sign-extension of the previous highest bit.
1222 \S{expplmi} \I{+ opaddition}\c{+} and \I{- opsubtraction}\c{-}:
1223 \i{Addition} and \i{Subtraction} Operators
1225 The \c{+} and \c{-} operators do perfectly ordinary addition and
1228 \S{expmul} \i\c{*}, \i\c{/}, \i\c{//}, \i\c{%} and \i\c{%%}:
1229 \i{Multiplication} and \i{Division}
1231 \c{*} is the multiplication operator. \c{/} and \c{//} are both
1232 division operators: \c{/} is \i{unsigned division} and \c{//} is
1233 \i{signed division}. Similarly, \c{%} and \c{%%} provide \I{unsigned
1234 modulo}\I{modulo operators}unsigned and
1235 \i{signed modulo} operators respectively.
1237 NASM, like ANSI C, provides no guarantees about the sensible
1238 operation of the signed modulo operator.
1240 Since the \c{%} character is used extensively by the macro
1241 \i{preprocessor}, you should ensure that both the signed and unsigned
1242 modulo operators are followed by white space wherever they appear.
1244 \S{expmul} \i{Unary Operators}: \I{+ opunary}\c{+}, \I{- opunary}\c{-},
1245 \i\c{~} and \i\c{SEG}
1247 The highest-priority operators in NASM's expression grammar are
1248 those which only apply to one argument. \c{-} negates its operand,
1249 \c{+} does nothing (it's provided for symmetry with \c{-}), \c{~}
1250 computes the \i{one's complement} of its operand, and \c{SEG}
1251 provides the \i{segment address} of its operand (explained in more
1252 detail in \k{segwrt}).
1254 \H{segwrt} \i\c{SEG} and \i\c{WRT}
1256 When writing large 16-bit programs, which must be split into
1257 multiple \i{segments}, it is often necessary to be able to refer to
1258 the \I{segment address}segment part of the address of a symbol. NASM
1259 supports the \c{SEG} operator to perform this function.
1261 The \c{SEG} operator returns the \i\e{preferred} segment base of a
1262 symbol, defined as the segment base relative to which the offset of
1263 the symbol makes sense. So the code
1265 \c mov ax,seg symbol
1269 will load \c{ES:BX} with a valid pointer to the symbol \c{symbol}.
1271 Things can be more complex than this: since 16-bit segments and
1272 \i{groups} may \I{overlapping segments}overlap, you might occasionally
1273 want to refer to some symbol using a different segment base from the
1274 preferred one. NASM lets you do this, by the use of the \c{WRT}
1275 (With Reference To) keyword. So you can do things like
1277 \c mov ax,weird_seg ; weird_seg is a segment base
1279 \c mov bx,symbol wrt weird_seg
1281 to load \c{ES:BX} with a different, but functionally equivalent,
1282 pointer to the symbol \c{symbol}.
1284 NASM supports far (inter-segment) calls and jumps by means of the
1285 syntax \c{call segment:offset}, where \c{segment} and \c{offset}
1286 both represent immediate values. So to call a far procedure, you
1287 could code either of
1289 \c call (seg procedure):procedure
1290 \c call weird_seg:(procedure wrt weird_seg)
1292 (The parentheses are included for clarity, to show the intended
1293 parsing of the above instructions. They are not necessary in
1296 NASM supports the syntax \I\c{CALL FAR}\c{call far procedure} as a
1297 synonym for the first of the above usages. \c{JMP} works identically
1298 to \c{CALL} in these examples.
1300 To declare a \i{far pointer} to a data item in a data segment, you
1303 \c dw symbol, seg symbol
1305 NASM supports no convenient synonym for this, though you can always
1306 invent one using the macro processor.
1308 \H{crit} \i{Critical Expressions}
1310 A limitation of NASM is that it is a \i{two-pass assembler}; unlike
1311 TASM and others, it will always do exactly two \I{passes}\i{assembly
1312 passes}. Therefore it is unable to cope with source files that are
1313 complex enough to require three or more passes.
1315 The first pass is used to determine the size of all the assembled
1316 code and data, so that the second pass, when generating all the
1317 code, knows all the symbol addresses the code refers to. So one
1318 thing NASM can't handle is code whose size depends on the value of a
1319 symbol declared after the code in question. For example,
1321 \c times (label-$) db 0
1322 \c label: db 'Where am I?'
1324 The argument to \i\c{TIMES} in this case could equally legally
1325 evaluate to anything at all; NASM will reject this example because
1326 it cannot tell the size of the \c{TIMES} line when it first sees it.
1327 It will just as firmly reject the slightly \I{paradox}paradoxical
1330 \c times (label-$+1) db 0
1331 \c label: db 'NOW where am I?'
1333 in which \e{any} value for the \c{TIMES} argument is by definition
1336 NASM rejects these examples by means of a concept called a
1337 \e{critical expression}, which is defined to be an expression whose
1338 value is required to be computable in the first pass, and which must
1339 therefore depend only on symbols defined before it. The argument to
1340 the \c{TIMES} prefix is a critical expression; for the same reason,
1341 the arguments to the \i\c{RESB} family of pseudo-instructions are
1342 also critical expressions.
1344 Critical expressions can crop up in other contexts as well: consider
1348 \c symbol1 equ symbol2
1351 On the first pass, NASM cannot determine the value of \c{symbol1},
1352 because \c{symbol1} is defined to be equal to \c{symbol2} which NASM
1353 hasn't seen yet. On the second pass, therefore, when it encounters
1354 the line \c{mov ax,symbol1}, it is unable to generate the code for
1355 it because it still doesn't know the value of \c{symbol1}. On the
1356 next line, it would see the \i\c{EQU} again and be able to determine
1357 the value of \c{symbol1}, but by then it would be too late.
1359 NASM avoids this problem by defining the right-hand side of an
1360 \c{EQU} statement to be a critical expression, so the definition of
1361 \c{symbol1} would be rejected in the first pass.
1363 There is a related issue involving \i{forward references}: consider
1366 \c mov eax,[ebx+offset]
1369 NASM, on pass one, must calculate the size of the instruction \c{mov
1370 eax,[ebx+offset]} without knowing the value of \c{offset}. It has no
1371 way of knowing that \c{offset} is small enough to fit into a
1372 one-byte offset field and that it could therefore get away with
1373 generating a shorter form of the \i{effective-address} encoding; for
1374 all it knows, in pass one, \c{offset} could be a symbol in the code
1375 segment, and it might need the full four-byte form. So it is forced
1376 to compute the size of the instruction to accommodate a four-byte
1377 address part. In pass two, having made this decision, it is now
1378 forced to honour it and keep the instruction large, so the code
1379 generated in this case is not as small as it could have been. This
1380 problem can be solved by defining \c{offset} before using it, or by
1381 forcing byte size in the effective address by coding \c{[byte
1384 \H{locallab} \i{Local Labels}
1386 NASM gives special treatment to symbols beginning with a \i{period}.
1387 A label beginning with a single period is treated as a \e{local}
1388 label, which means that it is associated with the previous non-local
1389 label. So, for example:
1391 \c label1 ; some code
1392 \c .loop ; some more code
1395 \c label2 ; some code
1396 \c .loop ; some more code
1400 In the above code fragment, each \c{JNE} instruction jumps to the
1401 line immediately before it, because the two definitions of \c{.loop}
1402 are kept separate by virtue of each being associated with the
1403 previous non-local label.
1405 This form of local label handling is borrowed from the old Amiga
1406 assembler \i{DevPac}; however, NASM goes one step further, in
1407 allowing access to local labels from other parts of the code. This
1408 is achieved by means of \e{defining} a local label in terms of the
1409 previous non-local label: the first definition of \c{.loop} above is
1410 really defining a symbol called \c{label1.loop}, and the second
1411 defines a symbol called \c{label2.loop}. So, if you really needed
1414 \c label3 ; some more code
1418 Sometimes it is useful - in a macro, for instance - to be able to
1419 define a label which can be referenced from anywhere but which
1420 doesn't interfere with the normal local-label mechanism. Such a
1421 label can't be non-local because it would interfere with subsequent
1422 definitions of, and references to, local labels; and it can't be
1423 local because the macro that defined it wouldn't know the label's
1424 full name. NASM therefore introduces a third type of label, which is
1425 probably only useful in macro definitions: if a label begins with
1426 the \I{label prefix}special prefix \i\c{..@}, then it does nothing
1427 to the local label mechanism. So you could code
1429 \c label1: ; a non-local label
1430 \c .local: ; this is really label1.local
1431 \c ..@foo: ; this is a special symbol
1432 \c label2: ; another non-local label
1433 \c .local: ; this is really label2.local
1434 \c jmp ..@foo ; this will jump three lines up
1436 NASM has the capacity to define other special symbols beginning with
1437 a double period: for example, \c{..start} is used to specify the
1438 entry point in the \c{obj} output format (see \k{dotdotstart}).
1440 \C{preproc} The NASM \i{Preprocessor}
1442 NASM contains a powerful \i{macro processor}, which supports
1443 conditional assembly, multi-level file inclusion, two forms of macro
1444 (single-line and multi-line), and a `context stack' mechanism for
1445 extra macro power. Preprocessor directives all begin with a \c{%}
1448 \H{slmacro} \i{Single-Line Macros}
1450 \S{define} The Normal Way: \I\c{%idefine}\i\c{%define}
1452 Single-line macros are defined using the \c{%define} preprocessor
1453 directive. The definitions work in a similar way to C; so you can do
1456 \c %define ctrl 0x1F &
1457 \c %define param(a,b) ((a)+(a)*(b))
1458 \c mov byte [param(2,ebx)], ctrl 'D'
1460 which will expand to
1462 \c mov byte [(2)+(2)*(ebx)], 0x1F & 'D'
1464 When the expansion of a single-line macro contains tokens which
1465 invoke another macro, the expansion is performed at invocation time,
1466 not at definition time. Thus the code
1468 \c %define a(x) 1+b(x)
1472 will evaluate in the expected way to \c{mov ax,1+2*8}, even though
1473 the macro \c{b} wasn't defined at the time of definition of \c{a}.
1475 Macros defined with \c{%define} are \i{case sensitive}: after
1476 \c{%define foo bar}, only \c{foo} will expand to \c{bar}: \c{Foo} or
1477 \c{FOO} will not. By using \c{%idefine} instead of \c{%define} (the
1478 `i' stands for `insensitive') you can define all the case variants
1479 of a macro at once, so that \c{%idefine foo bar} would cause
1480 \c{foo}, \c{Foo}, \c{FOO}, \c{fOO} and so on all to expand to
1483 There is a mechanism which detects when a macro call has occurred as
1484 a result of a previous expansion of the same macro, to guard against
1485 \i{circular references} and infinite loops. If this happens, the
1486 preprocessor will only expand the first occurrence of the macro.
1489 \c %define a(x) 1+a(x)
1492 the macro \c{a(3)} will expand once, becoming \c{1+a(3)}, and will
1493 then expand no further. This behaviour can be useful: see \k{32c}
1494 for an example of its use.
1496 You can \I{overloading, single-line macros}overload single-line
1497 macros: if you write
1499 \c %define foo(x) 1+x
1500 \c %define foo(x,y) 1+x*y
1502 the preprocessor will be able to handle both types of macro call,
1503 by counting the parameters you pass; so \c{foo(3)} will become
1504 \c{1+3} whereas \c{foo(ebx,2)} will become \c{1+ebx*2}. However, if
1509 then no other definition of \c{foo} will be accepted: a macro with
1510 no parameters prohibits the definition of the same name as a macro
1511 \e{with} parameters, and vice versa.
1513 This doesn't prevent single-line macros being \e{redefined}: you can
1514 perfectly well define a macro with
1518 and then re-define it later in the same source file with
1522 Then everywhere the macro \c{foo} is invoked, it will be expanded
1523 according to the most recent definition. This is particularly useful
1524 when defining single-line macros with \c{%assign} (see \k{assign}).
1526 You can \i{pre-define} single-line macros using the `-d' option on
1527 the NASM command line: see \k{opt-d}.
1529 \S{undef} Undefining macros: \i\c{%undef}
1531 Single-line macros can be removed with the \c{%undef} command. For
1532 example, the following sequence:
1538 will expand to the instruction \c{mov eax, foo}, since after
1539 \c{%undef} the macro \c{foo} is no longer defined.
1541 Macros that would otherwise be pre-defined can be undefined on the
1542 command-line using the `-u' option on the NASM command line: see
1545 \S{assign} \i{Preprocessor Variables}: \i\c{%assign}
1547 An alternative way to define single-line macros is by means of the
1548 \c{%assign} command (and its \i{case sensitive}case-insensitive
1549 counterpart \i\c{%iassign}, which differs from \c{%assign} in
1550 exactly the same way that \c{%idefine} differs from \c{%define}).
1552 \c{%assign} is used to define single-line macros which take no
1553 parameters and have a numeric value. This value can be specified in
1554 the form of an expression, and it will be evaluated once, when the
1555 \c{%assign} directive is processed.
1557 Like \c{%define}, macros defined using \c{%assign} can be re-defined
1558 later, so you can do things like
1562 to increment the numeric value of a macro.
1564 \c{%assign} is useful for controlling the termination of \c{%rep}
1565 preprocessor loops: see \k{rep} for an example of this. Another
1566 use for \c{%assign} is given in \k{16c} and \k{32c}.
1568 The expression passed to \c{%assign} is a \i{critical expression}
1569 (see \k{crit}), and must also evaluate to a pure number (rather than
1570 a relocatable reference such as a code or data address, or anything
1571 involving a register).
1573 \H{strlen} \i{String Handling in Macros}: \i\c{%strlen} and \i\c{%substr}
1575 It's often useful to be able to handle strings in macros. NASM
1576 supports two simple string handling macro operators from which
1577 more complex operations can be constructed.
1579 \S{strlen} \i{String Length}: \i\c{%strlen}
1581 The \c{%strlen} macro is like \c{%assign} macro in that it creates
1582 (or redefines) a numeric value to a macro. The difference is that
1583 with \c{%strlen}, the numeric value is the length of a string. An
1584 example of the use of this would be:
1586 \c %strlen charcnt 'my string'
1588 In this example, \c{charcnt} would receive the value 8, just as
1589 if an \c{%assign} had been used. In this example, \c{'my string'}
1590 was a literal string but it could also have been a single-line
1591 macro that expands to a string, as in the following example:
1593 \c %define sometext 'my string'
1594 \c %strlen charcnt sometext
1596 As in the first case, this would result in \c{charcnt} being
1597 assigned the value of 8.
1599 \S{substr} \i{Sub-strings}: \i\c{%substr}
1601 Individual letters in strings can be extracted using \c{%substr}.
1602 An example of its use is probably more useful than the description:
1604 \c %substr mychar 'xyz' 1 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'x'
1605 \c %substr mychar 'xyz' 2 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'y'
1606 \c %substr mychar 'xyz' 3 ; equivalent to %define mychar 'z'
1608 In this example, mychar gets the value of 'y'. As with \c{%strlen}
1609 (see \k{strlen}), the first parameter is the single-line macro to
1610 be created and the second is the string. The third parameter
1611 specifies which character is to be selected. Note that the first
1612 index is 1, not 0 and the last index is equal to the value that
1613 \c{%strlen} would assign given the same string. Index values out
1614 of range result in an empty string.
1616 \H{mlmacro} \i{Multi-Line Macros}: \I\c{%imacro}\i\c{%macro}
1618 Multi-line macros are much more like the type of macro seen in MASM
1619 and TASM: a multi-line macro definition in NASM looks something like
1622 \c %macro prologue 1
1628 This defines a C-like function prologue as a macro: so you would
1629 invoke the macro with a call such as
1631 \c myfunc: prologue 12
1633 which would expand to the three lines of code
1639 The number \c{1} after the macro name in the \c{%macro} line defines
1640 the number of parameters the macro \c{prologue} expects to receive.
1641 The use of \c{%1} inside the macro definition refers to the first
1642 parameter to the macro call. With a macro taking more than one
1643 parameter, subsequent parameters would be referred to as \c{%2},
1646 Multi-line macros, like single-line macros, are \i{case-sensitive},
1647 unless you define them using the alternative directive \c{%imacro}.
1649 If you need to pass a comma as \e{part} of a parameter to a
1650 multi-line macro, you can do that by enclosing the entire parameter
1651 in \I{braces, around macro parameters}braces. So you could code
1657 \c silly 'a', letter_a ; letter_a: db 'a'
1658 \c silly 'ab', string_ab ; string_ab: db 'ab'
1659 \c silly {13,10}, crlf ; crlf: db 13,10
1661 \S{mlmacover} \i{Overloading Multi-Line Macros}
1663 As with single-line macros, multi-line macros can be overloaded by
1664 defining the same macro name several times with different numbers of
1665 parameters. This time, no exception is made for macros with no
1666 parameters at all. So you could define
1668 \c %macro prologue 0
1673 to define an alternative form of the function prologue which
1674 allocates no local stack space.
1676 Sometimes, however, you might want to `overload' a machine
1677 instruction; for example, you might want to define
1684 so that you could code
1686 \c push ebx ; this line is not a macro call
1687 \c push eax,ecx ; but this one is
1689 Ordinarily, NASM will give a warning for the first of the above two
1690 lines, since \c{push} is now defined to be a macro, and is being
1691 invoked with a number of parameters for which no definition has been
1692 given. The correct code will still be generated, but the assembler
1693 will give a warning. This warning can be disabled by the use of the
1694 \c{-w-macro-params} command-line option (see \k{opt-w}).
1696 \S{maclocal} \i{Macro-Local Labels}
1698 NASM allows you to define labels within a multi-line macro
1699 definition in such a way as to make them local to the macro call: so
1700 calling the same macro multiple times will use a different label
1701 each time. You do this by prefixing \i\c{%%} to the label name. So
1702 you can invent an instruction which executes a \c{RET} if the \c{Z}
1703 flag is set by doing this:
1711 You can call this macro as many times as you want, and every time
1712 you call it NASM will make up a different `real' name to substitute
1713 for the label \c{%%skip}. The names NASM invents are of the form
1714 \c{..@2345.skip}, where the number 2345 changes with every macro
1715 call. The \i\c{..@} prefix prevents macro-local labels from
1716 interfering with the local label mechanism, as described in
1717 \k{locallab}. You should avoid defining your own labels in this form
1718 (the \c{..@} prefix, then a number, then another period) in case
1719 they interfere with macro-local labels.
1721 \S{mlmacgre} \i{Greedy Macro Parameters}
1723 Occasionally it is useful to define a macro which lumps its entire
1724 command line into one parameter definition, possibly after
1725 extracting one or two smaller parameters from the front. An example
1726 might be a macro to write a text string to a file in MS-DOS, where
1727 you might want to be able to write
1729 \c writefile [filehandle],"hello, world",13,10
1731 NASM allows you to define the last parameter of a macro to be
1732 \e{greedy}, meaning that if you invoke the macro with more
1733 parameters than it expects, all the spare parameters get lumped into
1734 the last defined one along with the separating commas. So if you
1737 \c %macro writefile 2+
1740 \c %%endstr: mov dx,%%str
1741 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
1747 then the example call to \c{writefile} above will work as expected:
1748 the text before the first comma, \c{[filehandle]}, is used as the
1749 first macro parameter and expanded when \c{%1} is referred to, and
1750 all the subsequent text is lumped into \c{%2} and placed after the
1753 The greedy nature of the macro is indicated to NASM by the use of
1754 the \I{+ modifier}\c{+} sign after the parameter count on the
1757 If you define a greedy macro, you are effectively telling NASM how
1758 it should expand the macro given \e{any} number of parameters from
1759 the actual number specified up to infinity; in this case, for
1760 example, NASM now knows what to do when it sees a call to
1761 \c{writefile} with 2, 3, 4 or more parameters. NASM will take this
1762 into account when overloading macros, and will not allow you to
1763 define another form of \c{writefile} taking 4 parameters (for
1766 Of course, the above macro could have been implemented as a
1767 non-greedy macro, in which case the call to it would have had to
1770 \c writefile [filehandle], {"hello, world",13,10}
1772 NASM provides both mechanisms for putting \i{commas in macro
1773 parameters}, and you choose which one you prefer for each macro
1776 See \k{sectmac} for a better way to write the above macro.
1778 \S{mlmacdef} \i{Default Macro Parameters}
1780 NASM also allows you to define a multi-line macro with a \e{range}
1781 of allowable parameter counts. If you do this, you can specify
1782 defaults for \i{omitted parameters}. So, for example:
1784 \c %macro die 0-1 "Painful program death has occurred."
1790 This macro (which makes use of the \c{writefile} macro defined in
1791 \k{mlmacgre}) can be called with an explicit error message, which it
1792 will display on the error output stream before exiting, or it can be
1793 called with no parameters, in which case it will use the default
1794 error message supplied in the macro definition.
1796 In general, you supply a minimum and maximum number of parameters
1797 for a macro of this type; the minimum number of parameters are then
1798 required in the macro call, and then you provide defaults for the
1799 optional ones. So if a macro definition began with the line
1801 \c %macro foobar 1-3 eax,[ebx+2]
1803 then it could be called with between one and three parameters, and
1804 \c{%1} would always be taken from the macro call. \c{%2}, if not
1805 specified by the macro call, would default to \c{eax}, and \c{%3} if
1806 not specified would default to \c{[ebx+2]}.
1808 You may omit parameter defaults from the macro definition, in which
1809 case the parameter default is taken to be blank. This can be useful
1810 for macros which can take a variable number of parameters, since the
1811 \i\c{%0} token (see \k{percent0}) allows you to determine how many
1812 parameters were really passed to the macro call.
1814 This defaulting mechanism can be combined with the greedy-parameter
1815 mechanism; so the \c{die} macro above could be made more powerful,
1816 and more useful, by changing the first line of the definition to
1818 \c %macro die 0-1+ "Painful program death has occurred.",13,10
1820 The maximum parameter count can be infinite, denoted by \c{*}. In
1821 this case, of course, it is impossible to provide a \e{full} set of
1822 default parameters. Examples of this usage are shown in \k{rotate}.
1824 \S{percent0} \i\c{%0}: \I{counting macro parameters}Macro Parameter Counter
1826 For a macro which can take a variable number of parameters, the
1827 parameter reference \c{%0} will return a numeric constant giving the
1828 number of parameters passed to the macro. This can be used as an
1829 argument to \c{%rep} (see \k{rep}) in order to iterate through all
1830 the parameters of a macro. Examples are given in \k{rotate}.
1832 \S{rotate} \i\c{%rotate}: \i{Rotating Macro Parameters}
1834 Unix shell programmers will be familiar with the \I{shift
1835 command}\c{shift} shell command, which allows the arguments passed
1836 to a shell script (referenced as \c{$1}, \c{$2} and so on) to be
1837 moved left by one place, so that the argument previously referenced
1838 as \c{$2} becomes available as \c{$1}, and the argument previously
1839 referenced as \c{$1} is no longer available at all.
1841 NASM provides a similar mechanism, in the form of \c{%rotate}. As
1842 its name suggests, it differs from the Unix \c{shift} in that no
1843 parameters are lost: parameters rotated off the left end of the
1844 argument list reappear on the right, and vice versa.
1846 \c{%rotate} is invoked with a single numeric argument (which may be
1847 an expression). The macro parameters are rotated to the left by that
1848 many places. If the argument to \c{%rotate} is negative, the macro
1849 parameters are rotated to the right.
1851 \I{iterating over macro parameters}So a pair of macros to save and
1852 restore a set of registers might work as follows:
1854 \c %macro multipush 1-*
1861 This macro invokes the \c{PUSH} instruction on each of its arguments
1862 in turn, from left to right. It begins by pushing its first
1863 argument, \c{%1}, then invokes \c{%rotate} to move all the arguments
1864 one place to the left, so that the original second argument is now
1865 available as \c{%1}. Repeating this procedure as many times as there
1866 were arguments (achieved by supplying \c{%0} as the argument to
1867 \c{%rep}) causes each argument in turn to be pushed.
1869 Note also the use of \c{*} as the maximum parameter count,
1870 indicating that there is no upper limit on the number of parameters
1871 you may supply to the \i\c{multipush} macro.
1873 It would be convenient, when using this macro, to have a \c{POP}
1874 equivalent, which \e{didn't} require the arguments to be given in
1875 reverse order. Ideally, you would write the \c{multipush} macro
1876 call, then cut-and-paste the line to where the pop needed to be
1877 done, and change the name of the called macro to \c{multipop}, and
1878 the macro would take care of popping the registers in the opposite
1879 order from the one in which they were pushed.
1881 This can be done by the following definition:
1883 \c %macro multipop 1-*
1890 This macro begins by rotating its arguments one place to the
1891 \e{right}, so that the original \e{last} argument appears as \c{%1}.
1892 This is then popped, and the arguments are rotated right again, so
1893 the second-to-last argument becomes \c{%1}. Thus the arguments are
1894 iterated through in reverse order.
1896 \S{concat} \i{Concatenating Macro Parameters}
1898 NASM can concatenate macro parameters on to other text surrounding
1899 them. This allows you to declare a family of symbols, for example,
1900 in a macro definition. If, for example, you wanted to generate a
1901 table of key codes along with offsets into the table, you could code
1904 \c %macro keytab_entry 2
1905 \c keypos%1 equ $-keytab
1909 \c keytab_entry F1,128+1
1910 \c keytab_entry F2,128+2
1911 \c keytab_entry Return,13
1913 which would expand to
1916 \c keyposF1 equ $-keytab
1918 \c keyposF2 equ $-keytab
1920 \c keyposReturn equ $-keytab
1923 You can just as easily concatenate text on to the other end of a
1924 macro parameter, by writing \c{%1foo}.
1926 If you need to append a \e{digit} to a macro parameter, for example
1927 defining labels \c{foo1} and \c{foo2} when passed the parameter
1928 \c{foo}, you can't code \c{%11} because that would be taken as the
1929 eleventh macro parameter. Instead, you must code
1930 \I{braces, after % sign}\c{%\{1\}1}, which will separate the first
1931 \c{1} (giving the number of the macro parameter) from the second
1932 (literal text to be concatenated to the parameter).
1934 This concatenation can also be applied to other preprocessor in-line
1935 objects, such as macro-local labels (\k{maclocal}) and context-local
1936 labels (\k{ctxlocal}). In all cases, ambiguities in syntax can be
1937 resolved by enclosing everything after the \c{%} sign and before the
1938 literal text in braces: so \c{%\{%foo\}bar} concatenates the text
1939 \c{bar} to the end of the real name of the macro-local label
1940 \c{%%foo}. (This is unnecessary, since the form NASM uses for the
1941 real names of macro-local labels means that the two usages
1942 \c{%\{%foo\}bar} and \c{%%foobar} would both expand to the same
1943 thing anyway; nevertheless, the capability is there.)
1945 \S{mlmaccc} \i{Condition Codes as Macro Parameters}
1947 NASM can give special treatment to a macro parameter which contains
1948 a condition code. For a start, you can refer to the macro parameter
1949 \c{%1} by means of the alternative syntax \i\c{%+1}, which informs
1950 NASM that this macro parameter is supposed to contain a condition
1951 code, and will cause the preprocessor to report an error message if
1952 the macro is called with a parameter which is \e{not} a valid
1955 Far more usefully, though, you can refer to the macro parameter by
1956 means of \i\c{%-1}, which NASM will expand as the \e{inverse}
1957 condition code. So the \c{retz} macro defined in \k{maclocal} can be
1958 replaced by a general \i{conditional-return macro} like this:
1966 This macro can now be invoked using calls like \c{retc ne}, which
1967 will cause the conditional-jump instruction in the macro expansion
1968 to come out as \c{JE}, or \c{retc po} which will make the jump a
1971 The \c{%+1} macro-parameter reference is quite happy to interpret
1972 the arguments \c{CXZ} and \c{ECXZ} as valid condition codes;
1973 however, \c{%-1} will report an error if passed either of these,
1974 because no inverse condition code exists.
1976 \S{nolist} \i{Disabling Listing Expansion}\I\c{.nolist}
1978 When NASM is generating a listing file from your program, it will
1979 generally expand multi-line macros by means of writing the macro
1980 call and then listing each line of the expansion. This allows you to
1981 see which instructions in the macro expansion are generating what
1982 code; however, for some macros this clutters the listing up
1985 NASM therefore provides the \c{.nolist} qualifier, which you can
1986 include in a macro definition to inhibit the expansion of the macro
1987 in the listing file. The \c{.nolist} qualifier comes directly after
1988 the number of parameters, like this:
1990 \c %macro foo 1.nolist
1994 \c %macro bar 1-5+.nolist a,b,c,d,e,f,g,h
1996 \H{condasm} \i{Conditional Assembly}\I\c{%if}
1998 Similarly to the C preprocessor, NASM allows sections of a source
1999 file to be assembled only if certain conditions are met. The general
2000 syntax of this feature looks like this:
2003 \c ; some code which only appears if <condition> is met
2004 \c %elif<condition2>
2005 \c ; only appears if <condition> is not met but <condition2> is
2007 \c ; this appears if neither <condition> nor <condition2> was met
2010 The \i\c{%else} clause is optional, as is the \i\c{%elif} clause.
2011 You can have more than one \c{%elif} clause as well.
2013 \S{ifdef} \i\c{%ifdef}: \i{Testing Single-Line Macro Existence}
2015 Beginning a conditional-assembly block with the line \c{%ifdef
2016 MACRO} will assemble the subsequent code if, and only if, a
2017 single-line macro called \c{MACRO} is defined. If not, then the
2018 \c{%elif} and \c{%else} blocks (if any) will be processed instead.
2020 For example, when debugging a program, you might want to write code
2023 \c ; perform some function
2025 \c writefile 2,"Function performed successfully",13,10
2027 \c ; go and do something else
2029 Then you could use the command-line option \c{-dDEBUG} to create a
2030 version of the program which produced debugging messages, and remove
2031 the option to generate the final release version of the program.
2033 You can test for a macro \e{not} being defined by using
2034 \i\c{%ifndef} instead of \c{%ifdef}. You can also test for macro
2035 definitions in \c{%elif} blocks by using \i\c{%elifdef} and
2038 \S{ifctx} \i\c{%ifctx}: \i{Testing the Context Stack}
2040 The conditional-assembly construct \c{%ifctx ctxname} will cause the
2041 subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the top context on
2042 the preprocessor's context stack has the name \c{ctxname}. As with
2043 \c{%ifdef}, the inverse and \c{%elif} forms \i\c{%ifnctx},
2044 \i\c{%elifctx} and \i\c{%elifnctx} are also supported.
2046 For more details of the context stack, see \k{ctxstack}. For a
2047 sample use of \c{%ifctx}, see \k{blockif}.
2049 \S{if} \i\c{%if}: \i{Testing Arbitrary Numeric Expressions}
2051 The conditional-assembly construct \c{%if expr} will cause the
2052 subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the value of the
2053 numeric expression \c{expr} is non-zero. An example of the use of
2054 this feature is in deciding when to break out of a \c{%rep}
2055 preprocessor loop: see \k{rep} for a detailed example.
2057 The expression given to \c{%if}, and its counterpart \i\c{%elif}, is
2058 a critical expression (see \k{crit}).
2060 \c{%if} extends the normal NASM expression syntax, by providing a
2061 set of \i{relational operators} which are not normally available in
2062 expressions. The operators \i\c{=}, \i\c{<}, \i\c{>}, \i\c{<=},
2063 \i\c{>=} and \i\c{<>} test equality, less-than, greater-than,
2064 less-or-equal, greater-or-equal and not-equal respectively. The
2065 C-like forms \i\c{==} and \i\c{!=} are supported as alternative
2066 forms of \c{=} and \c{<>}. In addition, low-priority logical
2067 operators \i\c{&&}, \i\c{^^} and \i\c{||} are provided, supplying
2068 \i{logical AND}, \i{logical XOR} and \i{logical OR}. These work like
2069 the C logical operators (although C has no logical XOR), in that
2070 they always return either 0 or 1, and treat any non-zero input as 1
2071 (so that \c{^^}, for example, returns 1 if exactly one of its inputs
2072 is zero, and 0 otherwise). The relational operators also return 1
2073 for true and 0 for false.
2075 \S{ifidn} \i\c{%ifidn} and \i\c{%ifidni}: \i{Testing Exact Text
2078 The construct \c{%ifidn text1,text2} will cause the subsequent code
2079 to be assembled if and only if \c{text1} and \c{text2}, after
2080 expanding single-line macros, are identical pieces of text.
2081 Differences in white space are not counted.
2083 \c{%ifidni} is similar to \c{%ifidn}, but is \i{case-insensitive}.
2085 For example, the following macro pushes a register or number on the
2086 stack, and allows you to treat \c{IP} as a real register:
2088 \c %macro pushparam 1
2097 Like most other \c{%if} constructs, \c{%ifidn} has a counterpart
2098 \i\c{%elifidn}, and negative forms \i\c{%ifnidn} and \i\c{%elifnidn}.
2099 Similarly, \c{%ifidni} has counterparts \i\c{%elifidni},
2100 \i\c{%ifnidni} and \i\c{%elifnidni}.
2102 \S{iftyp} \i\c{%ifid}, \i\c{%ifnum}, \i\c{%ifstr}: \i{Testing Token
2105 Some macros will want to perform different tasks depending on
2106 whether they are passed a number, a string, or an identifier. For
2107 example, a string output macro might want to be able to cope with
2108 being passed either a string constant or a pointer to an existing
2111 The conditional assembly construct \c{%ifid}, taking one parameter
2112 (which may be blank), assembles the subsequent code if and only if
2113 the first token in the parameter exists and is an identifier.
2114 \c{%ifnum} works similarly, but tests for the token being a numeric
2115 constant; \c{%ifstr} tests for it being a string.
2117 For example, the \c{writefile} macro defined in \k{mlmacgre} can be
2118 extended to take advantage of \c{%ifstr} in the following fashion:
2120 \c %macro writefile 2-3+
2128 \c %%endstr: mov dx,%%str
2129 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
2139 Then the \c{writefile} macro can cope with being called in either of
2140 the following two ways:
2142 \c writefile [file], strpointer, length
2143 \c writefile [file], "hello", 13, 10
2145 In the first, \c{strpointer} is used as the address of an
2146 already-declared string, and \c{length} is used as its length; in
2147 the second, a string is given to the macro, which therefore declares
2148 it itself and works out the address and length for itself.
2150 Note the use of \c{%if} inside the \c{%ifstr}: this is to detect
2151 whether the macro was passed two arguments (so the string would be a
2152 single string constant, and \c{db %2} would be adequate) or more (in
2153 which case, all but the first two would be lumped together into
2154 \c{%3}, and \c{db %2,%3} would be required).
2156 \I\c{%ifnid}\I\c{%elifid}\I\c{%elifnid}\I\c{%ifnnum}\I\c{%elifnum}\I\c{%elifnnum}\I\c{%ifnstr}\I\c{%elifstr}\I\c{%elifnstr}
2157 The usual \c{%elifXXX}, \c{%ifnXXX} and \c{%elifnXXX} versions exist
2158 for each of \c{%ifid}, \c{%ifnum} and \c{%ifstr}.
2160 \S{pperror} \i\c{%error}: Reporting \i{User-Defined Errors}
2162 The preprocessor directive \c{%error} will cause NASM to report an
2163 error if it occurs in assembled code. So if other users are going to
2164 try to assemble your source files, you can ensure that they define
2165 the right macros by means of code like this:
2167 \c %ifdef SOME_MACRO
2169 \c %elifdef SOME_OTHER_MACRO
2170 \c ; do some different setup
2172 \c %error Neither SOME_MACRO nor SOME_OTHER_MACRO was defined.
2175 Then any user who fails to understand the way your code is supposed
2176 to be assembled will be quickly warned of their mistake, rather than
2177 having to wait until the program crashes on being run and then not
2178 knowing what went wrong.
2180 \H{rep} \i{Preprocessor Loops}\I{repeating code}: \i\c{%rep}
2182 NASM's \c{TIMES} prefix, though useful, cannot be used to invoke a
2183 multi-line macro multiple times, because it is processed by NASM
2184 after macros have already been expanded. Therefore NASM provides
2185 another form of loop, this time at the preprocessor level: \c{%rep}.
2187 The directives \c{%rep} and \i\c{%endrep} (\c{%rep} takes a numeric
2188 argument, which can be an expression; \c{%endrep} takes no
2189 arguments) can be used to enclose a chunk of code, which is then
2190 replicated as many times as specified by the preprocessor:
2194 \c inc word [table+2*i]
2198 This will generate a sequence of 64 \c{INC} instructions,
2199 incrementing every word of memory from \c{[table]} to
2202 For more complex termination conditions, or to break out of a repeat
2203 loop part way along, you can use the \i\c{%exitrep} directive to
2204 terminate the loop, like this:
2218 \c fib_number equ ($-fibonacci)/2
2220 This produces a list of all the Fibonacci numbers that will fit in
2221 16 bits. Note that a maximum repeat count must still be given to
2222 \c{%rep}. This is to prevent the possibility of NASM getting into an
2223 infinite loop in the preprocessor, which (on multitasking or
2224 multi-user systems) would typically cause all the system memory to
2225 be gradually used up and other applications to start crashing.
2227 \H{include} \i{Including Other Files}
2229 Using, once again, a very similar syntax to the C preprocessor,
2230 NASM's preprocessor lets you include other source files into your
2231 code. This is done by the use of the \i\c{%include} directive:
2233 \c %include "macros.mac"
2235 will include the contents of the file \c{macros.mac} into the source
2236 file containing the \c{%include} directive.
2238 Include files are \I{searching for include files}searched for in the
2239 current directory (the directory you're in when you run NASM, as
2240 opposed to the location of the NASM executable or the location of
2241 the source file), plus any directories specified on the NASM command
2242 line using the \c{-i} option.
2244 The standard C idiom for preventing a file being included more than
2245 once is just as applicable in NASM: if the file \c{macros.mac} has
2248 \c %ifndef MACROS_MAC
2249 \c %define MACROS_MAC
2250 \c ; now define some macros
2253 then including the file more than once will not cause errors,
2254 because the second time the file is included nothing will happen
2255 because the macro \c{MACROS_MAC} will already be defined.
2257 You can force a file to be included even if there is no \c{%include}
2258 directive that explicitly includes it, by using the \i\c{-p} option
2259 on the NASM command line (see \k{opt-p}).
2261 \H{ctxstack} The \i{Context Stack}
2263 Having labels that are local to a macro definition is sometimes not
2264 quite powerful enough: sometimes you want to be able to share labels
2265 between several macro calls. An example might be a \c{REPEAT} ...
2266 \c{UNTIL} loop, in which the expansion of the \c{REPEAT} macro
2267 would need to be able to refer to a label which the \c{UNTIL} macro
2268 had defined. However, for such a macro you would also want to be
2269 able to nest these loops.
2271 NASM provides this level of power by means of a \e{context stack}.
2272 The preprocessor maintains a stack of \e{contexts}, each of which is
2273 characterised by a name. You add a new context to the stack using
2274 the \i\c{%push} directive, and remove one using \i\c{%pop}. You can
2275 define labels that are local to a particular context on the stack.
2277 \S{pushpop} \i\c{%push} and \i\c{%pop}: \I{creating
2278 contexts}\I{removing contexts}Creating and Removing Contexts
2280 The \c{%push} directive is used to create a new context and place it
2281 on the top of the context stack. \c{%push} requires one argument,
2282 which is the name of the context. For example:
2286 This pushes a new context called \c{foobar} on the stack. You can
2287 have several contexts on the stack with the same name: they can
2288 still be distinguished.
2290 The directive \c{%pop}, requiring no arguments, removes the top
2291 context from the context stack and destroys it, along with any
2292 labels associated with it.
2294 \S{ctxlocal} \i{Context-Local Labels}
2296 Just as the usage \c{%%foo} defines a label which is local to the
2297 particular macro call in which it is used, the usage \I{%$}\c{%$foo}
2298 is used to define a label which is local to the context on the top
2299 of the context stack. So the \c{REPEAT} and \c{UNTIL} example given
2300 above could be implemented by means of:
2312 and invoked by means of, for example,
2320 which would scan every fourth byte of a string in search of the byte
2323 If you need to define, or access, labels local to the context
2324 \e{below} the top one on the stack, you can use \I{%$$}\c{%$$foo}, or
2325 \c{%$$$foo} for the context below that, and so on.
2327 \S{ctxdefine} \i{Context-Local Single-Line Macros}
2329 NASM also allows you to define single-line macros which are local to
2330 a particular context, in just the same way:
2332 \c %define %$localmac 3
2334 will define the single-line macro \c{%$localmac} to be local to the
2335 top context on the stack. Of course, after a subsequent \c{%push},
2336 it can then still be accessed by the name \c{%$$localmac}.
2338 \S{ctxrepl} \i\c{%repl}: \I{renaming contexts}Renaming a Context
2340 If you need to change the name of the top context on the stack (in
2341 order, for example, to have it respond differently to \c{%ifctx}),
2342 you can execute a \c{%pop} followed by a \c{%push}; but this will
2343 have the side effect of destroying all context-local labels and
2344 macros associated with the context that was just popped.
2346 NASM provides the directive \c{%repl}, which \e{replaces} a context
2347 with a different name, without touching the associated macros and
2348 labels. So you could replace the destructive code
2353 with the non-destructive version \c{%repl newname}.
2355 \S{blockif} Example Use of the \i{Context Stack}: \i{Block IFs}
2357 This example makes use of almost all the context-stack features,
2358 including the conditional-assembly construct \i\c{%ifctx}, to
2359 implement a block IF statement as a set of macros.
2372 \c %error "expected `if' before `else'"
2384 \c %error "expected `if' or `else' before `endif'"
2388 This code is more robust than the \c{REPEAT} and \c{UNTIL} macros
2389 given in \k{ctxlocal}, because it uses conditional assembly to check
2390 that the macros are issued in the right order (for example, not
2391 calling \c{endif} before \c{if}) and issues a \c{%error} if they're
2394 In addition, the \c{endif} macro has to be able to cope with the two
2395 distinct cases of either directly following an \c{if}, or following
2396 an \c{else}. It achieves this, again, by using conditional assembly
2397 to do different things depending on whether the context on top of
2398 the stack is \c{if} or \c{else}.
2400 The \c{else} macro has to preserve the context on the stack, in
2401 order to have the \c{%$ifnot} referred to by the \c{if} macro be the
2402 same as the one defined by the \c{endif} macro, but has to change
2403 the context's name so that \c{endif} will know there was an
2404 intervening \c{else}. It does this by the use of \c{%repl}.
2406 A sample usage of these macros might look like:
2423 The block-\c{IF} macros handle nesting quite happily, by means of
2424 pushing another context, describing the inner \c{if}, on top of the
2425 one describing the outer \c{if}; thus \c{else} and \c{endif} always
2426 refer to the last unmatched \c{if} or \c{else}.
2428 \H{stdmac} \i{Standard Macros}
2430 NASM defines a set of standard macros, which are already defined
2431 when it starts to process any source file. If you really need a
2432 program to be assembled with no pre-defined macros, you can use the
2433 \i\c{%clear} directive to empty the preprocessor of everything.
2435 Most \i{user-level assembler directives} (see \k{directive}) are
2436 implemented as macros which invoke primitive directives; these are
2437 described in \k{directive}. The rest of the standard macro set is
2440 \S{stdmacver} \i\c{__NASM_MAJOR__} and \i\c{__NASM_MINOR__}: \i{NASM
2443 The single-line macros \c{__NASM_MAJOR__} and \c{__NASM_MINOR__}
2444 expand to the major and minor parts of the \i{version number of
2445 NASM} being used. So, under NASM 0.96 for example,
2446 \c{__NASM_MAJOR__} would be defined to be 0 and \c{__NASM_MINOR__}
2447 would be defined as 96.
2449 \S{fileline} \i\c{__FILE__} and \i\c{__LINE__}: File Name and Line Number
2451 Like the C preprocessor, NASM allows the user to find out the file
2452 name and line number containing the current instruction. The macro
2453 \c{__FILE__} expands to a string constant giving the name of the
2454 current input file (which may change through the course of assembly
2455 if \c{%include} directives are used), and \c{__LINE__} expands to a
2456 numeric constant giving the current line number in the input file.
2458 These macros could be used, for example, to communicate debugging
2459 information to a macro, since invoking \c{__LINE__} inside a macro
2460 definition (either single-line or multi-line) will return the line
2461 number of the macro \e{call}, rather than \e{definition}. So to
2462 determine where in a piece of code a crash is occurring, for
2463 example, one could write a routine \c{stillhere}, which is passed a
2464 line number in \c{EAX} and outputs something like `line 155: still
2465 here'. You could then write a macro
2467 \c %macro notdeadyet 0
2474 and then pepper your code with calls to \c{notdeadyet} until you
2475 find the crash point.
2477 \S{struc} \i\c{STRUC} and \i\c{ENDSTRUC}: \i{Declaring Structure} Data Types
2479 The core of NASM contains no intrinsic means of defining data
2480 structures; instead, the preprocessor is sufficiently powerful that
2481 data structures can be implemented as a set of macros. The macros
2482 \c{STRUC} and \c{ENDSTRUC} are used to define a structure data type.
2484 \c{STRUC} takes one parameter, which is the name of the data type.
2485 This name is defined as a symbol with the value zero, and also has
2486 the suffix \c{_size} appended to it and is then defined as an
2487 \c{EQU} giving the size of the structure. Once \c{STRUC} has been
2488 issued, you are defining the structure, and should define fields
2489 using the \c{RESB} family of pseudo-instructions, and then invoke
2490 \c{ENDSTRUC} to finish the definition.
2492 For example, to define a structure called \c{mytype} containing a
2493 longword, a word, a byte and a string of bytes, you might code
2502 The above code defines six symbols: \c{mt_long} as 0 (the offset
2503 from the beginning of a \c{mytype} structure to the longword field),
2504 \c{mt_word} as 4, \c{mt_byte} as 6, \c{mt_str} as 7, \c{mytype_size}
2505 as 39, and \c{mytype} itself as zero.
2507 The reason why the structure type name is defined at zero is a side
2508 effect of allowing structures to work with the local label
2509 mechanism: if your structure members tend to have the same names in
2510 more than one structure, you can define the above structure like this:
2519 This defines the offsets to the structure fields as \c{mytype.long},
2520 \c{mytype.word}, \c{mytype.byte} and \c{mytype.str}.
2522 NASM, since it has no \e{intrinsic} structure support, does not
2523 support any form of period notation to refer to the elements of a
2524 structure once you have one (except the above local-label notation),
2525 so code such as \c{mov ax,[mystruc.mt_word]} is not valid.
2526 \c{mt_word} is a constant just like any other constant, so the
2527 correct syntax is \c{mov ax,[mystruc+mt_word]} or \c{mov
2528 ax,[mystruc+mytype.word]}.
2530 \S{istruc} \i\c{ISTRUC}, \i\c{AT} and \i\c{IEND}: Declaring
2531 \i{Instances of Structures}
2533 Having defined a structure type, the next thing you typically want
2534 to do is to declare instances of that structure in your data
2535 segment. NASM provides an easy way to do this in the \c{ISTRUC}
2536 mechanism. To declare a structure of type \c{mytype} in a program,
2537 you code something like this:
2539 \c mystruc: istruc mytype
2540 \c at mt_long, dd 123456
2541 \c at mt_word, dw 1024
2542 \c at mt_byte, db 'x'
2543 \c at mt_str, db 'hello, world', 13, 10, 0
2546 The function of the \c{AT} macro is to make use of the \c{TIMES}
2547 prefix to advance the assembly position to the correct point for the
2548 specified structure field, and then to declare the specified data.
2549 Therefore the structure fields must be declared in the same order as
2550 they were specified in the structure definition.
2552 If the data to go in a structure field requires more than one source
2553 line to specify, the remaining source lines can easily come after
2554 the \c{AT} line. For example:
2556 \c at mt_str, db 123,134,145,156,167,178,189
2559 Depending on personal taste, you can also omit the code part of the
2560 \c{AT} line completely, and start the structure field on the next
2564 \c db 'hello, world'
2567 \S{align} \i\c{ALIGN} and \i\c{ALIGNB}: Data Alignment
2569 The \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} macros provides a convenient way to
2570 align code or data on a word, longword, paragraph or other boundary.
2571 (Some assemblers call this directive \i\c{EVEN}.) The syntax of the
2572 \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} macros is
2574 \c align 4 ; align on 4-byte boundary
2575 \c align 16 ; align on 16-byte boundary
2576 \c align 8,db 0 ; pad with 0s rather than NOPs
2577 \c align 4,resb 1 ; align to 4 in the BSS
2578 \c alignb 4 ; equivalent to previous line
2580 Both macros require their first argument to be a power of two; they
2581 both compute the number of additional bytes required to bring the
2582 length of the current section up to a multiple of that power of two,
2583 and then apply the \c{TIMES} prefix to their second argument to
2584 perform the alignment.
2586 If the second argument is not specified, the default for \c{ALIGN}
2587 is \c{NOP}, and the default for \c{ALIGNB} is \c{RESB 1}. So if the
2588 second argument is specified, the two macros are equivalent.
2589 Normally, you can just use \c{ALIGN} in code and data sections and
2590 \c{ALIGNB} in BSS sections, and never need the second argument
2591 except for special purposes.
2593 \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB}, being simple macros, perform no error
2594 checking: they cannot warn you if their first argument fails to be a
2595 power of two, or if their second argument generates more than one
2596 byte of code. In each of these cases they will silently do the wrong
2599 \c{ALIGNB} (or \c{ALIGN} with a second argument of \c{RESB 1}) can
2600 be used within structure definitions:
2611 This will ensure that the structure members are sensibly aligned
2612 relative to the base of the structure.
2614 A final caveat: \c{ALIGN} and \c{ALIGNB} work relative to the
2615 beginning of the \e{section}, not the beginning of the address space
2616 in the final executable. Aligning to a 16-byte boundary when the
2617 section you're in is only guaranteed to be aligned to a 4-byte
2618 boundary, for example, is a waste of effort. Again, NASM does not
2619 check that the section's alignment characteristics are sensible for
2620 the use of \c{ALIGN} or \c{ALIGNB}.
2622 \H{tasmcompat} \i{TASM Compatible Preprocessor Directives}
2624 The following preprocessor directives may only be used when TASM
2625 compatibility is turned on using the \c{-t} command line switch
2626 (This switch is described in \k{opt-t}.)
2628 \b\c{%arg} (see \k{arg})
2630 \b\c{%stacksize} (see \k{stacksize})
2632 \b\c{%local} (see \k{local})
2634 \S{arg} \i\c{%arg} Directive
2636 The \c{%arg} directive is used to simplify the handling of
2637 parameters passed on the stack. Stack based parameter passing
2638 is used by many high level languages, including C, C++ and Pascal.
2640 While NASM comes with macros which attempt to duplicate this
2641 functionality (see \k{16cmacro}), the syntax is not particularly
2642 convenient to use and is not TASM compatible. Here is an example
2643 which shows the use of \c{%arg} without any external macros:
2646 \c %push mycontext ; save the current context
2647 \c %stacksize large ; tell NASM to use bp
2648 \c %arg i:word, j_ptr:word
2653 \c %pop ; restore original context
2655 This is similar to the procedure defined in \k{16cmacro} and adds
2656 the value in i to the value pointed to by j_ptr and returns the
2657 sum in the ax register. See \k{pushpop} for an explanation of
2658 \c{push} and \c{pop} and the use of context stacks.
2660 \S{stacksize} \i\c{%stacksize} Directive
2662 The \c{%stacksize} directive is used in conjunction with the
2663 \c{%arg} (see \k{arg}) and the \c{%local} (see \k{local}) directives.
2664 It tells NASM the default size to use for subsequent \c{%arg} and
2665 \c{%local} directives. The \c{%stacksize} directive takes one
2666 required argument which is one of \c{flat}, \c{large} or \c{small}.
2670 This form causes NASM to use stack-based parameter addressing
2671 relative to \c{ebp} and it assumes that a near form of call was used
2672 to get to this label (i.e. that \c{eip} is on the stack).
2676 This form uses \c{bp} to do stack-based parameter addressing and
2677 assumes that a far form of call was used to get to this address
2678 (i.e. that \c{ip} and \c{cs} are on the stack).
2682 This form also uses \c{bp} to address stack parameters, but it is
2683 different from \c{large} because it also assumes that the old value
2684 of bp is pushed onto the stack (i.e. it expects an \c{ENTER}
2685 instruction). In other words, it expects that \c{bp}, \c{ip} and
2686 \c{cs} are on the top of the stack, underneath any local space which
2687 may have been allocated by \c{ENTER}. This form is probably most
2688 useful when used in combination with the \c{%local} directive
2691 \S{local} \i\c{%local} Directive
2693 The \c{%local} directive is used to simplify the use of local
2694 temporary stack variables allocated in a stack frame. Automatic
2695 local variables in C are an example of this kind of variable. The
2696 \c{%local} directive is most useful when used with the \c{%stacksize}
2697 (see \k{stacksize} and is also compatible with the \c{%arg} directive
2698 (see \k{arg}). It allows simplified reference to variables on the
2699 stack which have been allocated typically by using the \c{ENTER}
2700 instruction (see \k{insENTER} for a description of that instruction).
2701 An example of its use is the following:
2704 \c %push mycontext ; save the current context
2705 \c %stacksize small ; tell NASM to use bp
2706 \c %assign %$localsize 0 ; see text for explanation
2707 \c %local old_ax:word, old_dx:word
2708 \c enter %$localsize,0 ; see text for explanation
2709 \c mov [old_ax],ax ; swap ax & bx
2710 \c mov [old_dx],dx ; and swap dx & cx
2715 \c leave ; restore old bp
2717 \c %pop ; restore original context
2719 The \c{%$localsize} variable is used internally by the
2720 \c{%local} directive and \e{must} be defined within the
2721 current context before the \c{%local} directive may be used.
2722 Failure to do so will result in one expression syntax error for
2723 each \c{%local} variable declared. It then may be used in
2724 the construction of an appropriately sized ENTER instruction
2725 as shown in the example.
2727 \C{directive} \i{Assembler Directives}
2729 NASM, though it attempts to avoid the bureaucracy of assemblers like
2730 MASM and TASM, is nevertheless forced to support a \e{few}
2731 directives. These are described in this chapter.
2733 NASM's directives come in two types: \i{user-level
2734 directives}\e{user-level} directives and \i{primitive
2735 directives}\e{primitive} directives. Typically, each directive has a
2736 user-level form and a primitive form. In almost all cases, we
2737 recommend that users use the user-level forms of the directives,
2738 which are implemented as macros which call the primitive forms.
2740 Primitive directives are enclosed in square brackets; user-level
2743 In addition to the universal directives described in this chapter,
2744 each object file format can optionally supply extra directives in
2745 order to control particular features of that file format. These
2746 \i{format-specific directives}\e{format-specific} directives are
2747 documented along with the formats that implement them, in \k{outfmt}.
2749 \H{bits} \i\c{BITS}: Specifying Target \i{Processor Mode}
2751 The \c{BITS} directive specifies whether NASM should generate code
2752 \I{16-bit mode, versus 32-bit mode}designed to run on a processor
2753 operating in 16-bit mode, or code designed to run on a processor
2754 operating in 32-bit mode. The syntax is \c{BITS 16} or \c{BITS 32}.
2756 In most cases, you should not need to use \c{BITS} explicitly. The
2757 \c{aout}, \c{coff}, \c{elf} and \c{win32} object formats, which are
2758 designed for use in 32-bit operating systems, all cause NASM to
2759 select 32-bit mode by default. The \c{obj} object format allows you
2760 to specify each segment you define as either \c{USE16} or \c{USE32},
2761 and NASM will set its operating mode accordingly, so the use of the
2762 \c{BITS} directive is once again unnecessary.
2764 The most likely reason for using the \c{BITS} directive is to write
2765 32-bit code in a flat binary file; this is because the \c{bin}
2766 output format defaults to 16-bit mode in anticipation of it being
2767 used most frequently to write DOS \c{.COM} programs, DOS \c{.SYS}
2768 device drivers and boot loader software.
2770 You do \e{not} need to specify \c{BITS 32} merely in order to use
2771 32-bit instructions in a 16-bit DOS program; if you do, the
2772 assembler will generate incorrect code because it will be writing
2773 code targeted at a 32-bit platform, to be run on a 16-bit one.
2775 When NASM is in \c{BITS 16} state, instructions which use 32-bit
2776 data are prefixed with an 0x66 byte, and those referring to 32-bit
2777 addresses have an 0x67 prefix. In \c{BITS 32} state, the reverse is
2778 true: 32-bit instructions require no prefixes, whereas instructions
2779 using 16-bit data need an 0x66 and those working in 16-bit addresses
2782 The \c{BITS} directive has an exactly equivalent primitive form,
2783 \c{[BITS 16]} and \c{[BITS 32]}. The user-level form is a macro
2784 which has no function other than to call the primitive form.
2786 \H{section} \i\c{SECTION} or \i\c{SEGMENT}: Changing and \i{Defining
2789 \I{changing sections}\I{switching between sections}The \c{SECTION}
2790 directive (\c{SEGMENT} is an exactly equivalent synonym) changes
2791 which section of the output file the code you write will be
2792 assembled into. In some object file formats, the number and names of
2793 sections are fixed; in others, the user may make up as many as they
2794 wish. Hence \c{SECTION} may sometimes give an error message, or may
2795 define a new section, if you try to switch to a section that does
2798 The Unix object formats, and the \c{bin} object format, all support
2799 the \i{standardised section names} \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}
2800 for the code, data and uninitialised-data sections. The \c{obj}
2801 format, by contrast, does not recognise these section names as being
2802 special, and indeed will strip off the leading period of any section
2805 \S{sectmac} The \i\c{__SECT__} Macro
2807 The \c{SECTION} directive is unusual in that its user-level form
2808 functions differently from its primitive form. The primitive form,
2809 \c{[SECTION xyz]}, simply switches the current target section to the
2810 one given. The user-level form, \c{SECTION xyz}, however, first
2811 defines the single-line macro \c{__SECT__} to be the primitive
2812 \c{[SECTION]} directive which it is about to issue, and then issues
2813 it. So the user-level directive
2817 expands to the two lines
2819 \c %define __SECT__ [SECTION .text]
2822 Users may find it useful to make use of this in their own macros.
2823 For example, the \c{writefile} macro defined in \k{mlmacgre} can be
2824 usefully rewritten in the following more sophisticated form:
2826 \c %macro writefile 2+
2832 \c mov cx,%%endstr-%%str
2838 This form of the macro, once passed a string to output, first
2839 switches temporarily to the data section of the file, using the
2840 primitive form of the \c{SECTION} directive so as not to modify
2841 \c{__SECT__}. It then declares its string in the data section, and
2842 then invokes \c{__SECT__} to switch back to \e{whichever} section
2843 the user was previously working in. It thus avoids the need, in the
2844 previous version of the macro, to include a \c{JMP} instruction to
2845 jump over the data, and also does not fail if, in a complicated
2846 \c{OBJ} format module, the user could potentially be assembling the
2847 code in any of several separate code sections.
2849 \H{absolute} \i\c{ABSOLUTE}: Defining Absolute Labels
2851 The \c{ABSOLUTE} directive can be thought of as an alternative form
2852 of \c{SECTION}: it causes the subsequent code to be directed at no
2853 physical section, but at the hypothetical section starting at the
2854 given absolute address. The only instructions you can use in this
2855 mode are the \c{RESB} family.
2857 \c{ABSOLUTE} is used as follows:
2864 This example describes a section of the PC BIOS data area, at
2865 segment address 0x40: the above code defines \c{kbuf_chr} to be
2866 0x1A, \c{kbuf_free} to be 0x1C, and \c{kbuf} to be 0x1E.
2868 The user-level form of \c{ABSOLUTE}, like that of \c{SECTION},
2869 redefines the \i\c{__SECT__} macro when it is invoked.
2871 \i\c{STRUC} and \i\c{ENDSTRUC} are defined as macros which use
2872 \c{ABSOLUTE} (and also \c{__SECT__}).
2874 \c{ABSOLUTE} doesn't have to take an absolute constant as an
2875 argument: it can take an expression (actually, a \i{critical
2876 expression}: see \k{crit}) and it can be a value in a segment. For
2877 example, a TSR can re-use its setup code as run-time BSS like this:
2879 \c org 100h ; it's a .COM program
2880 \c jmp setup ; setup code comes last
2881 \c ; the resident part of the TSR goes here
2882 \c setup: ; now write the code that installs the TSR here
2884 \c runtimevar1 resw 1
2885 \c runtimevar2 resd 20
2888 This defines some variables `on top of' the setup code, so that
2889 after the setup has finished running, the space it took up can be
2890 re-used as data storage for the running TSR. The symbol `tsr_end'
2891 can be used to calculate the total size of the part of the TSR that
2892 needs to be made resident.
2894 \H{extern} \i\c{EXTERN}: \i{Importing Symbols} from Other Modules
2896 \c{EXTERN} is similar to the MASM directive \c{EXTRN} and the C
2897 keyword \c{extern}: it is used to declare a symbol which is not
2898 defined anywhere in the module being assembled, but is assumed to be
2899 defined in some other module and needs to be referred to by this
2900 one. Not every object-file format can support external variables:
2901 the \c{bin} format cannot.
2903 The \c{EXTERN} directive takes as many arguments as you like. Each
2904 argument is the name of a symbol:
2907 \c extern _sscanf,_fscanf
2909 Some object-file formats provide extra features to the \c{EXTERN}
2910 directive. In all cases, the extra features are used by suffixing a
2911 colon to the symbol name followed by object-format specific text.
2912 For example, the \c{obj} format allows you to declare that the
2913 default segment base of an external should be the group \c{dgroup}
2914 by means of the directive
2916 \c extern _variable:wrt dgroup
2918 The primitive form of \c{EXTERN} differs from the user-level form
2919 only in that it can take only one argument at a time: the support
2920 for multiple arguments is implemented at the preprocessor level.
2922 You can declare the same variable as \c{EXTERN} more than once: NASM
2923 will quietly ignore the second and later redeclarations. You can't
2924 declare a variable as \c{EXTERN} as well as something else, though.
2926 \H{global} \i\c{GLOBAL}: \i{Exporting Symbols} to Other Modules
2928 \c{GLOBAL} is the other end of \c{EXTERN}: if one module declares a
2929 symbol as \c{EXTERN} and refers to it, then in order to prevent
2930 linker errors, some other module must actually \e{define} the
2931 symbol and declare it as \c{GLOBAL}. Some assemblers use the name
2932 \i\c{PUBLIC} for this purpose.
2934 The \c{GLOBAL} directive applying to a symbol must appear \e{before}
2935 the definition of the symbol.
2937 \c{GLOBAL} uses the same syntax as \c{EXTERN}, except that it must
2938 refer to symbols which \e{are} defined in the same module as the
2939 \c{GLOBAL} directive. For example:
2942 \c _main: ; some code
2944 \c{GLOBAL}, like \c{EXTERN}, allows object formats to define private
2945 extensions by means of a colon. The \c{elf} object format, for
2946 example, lets you specify whether global data items are functions or
2949 \c global hashlookup:function, hashtable:data
2951 Like \c{EXTERN}, the primitive form of \c{GLOBAL} differs from the
2952 user-level form only in that it can take only one argument at a
2955 \H{common} \i\c{COMMON}: Defining Common Data Areas
2957 The \c{COMMON} directive is used to declare \i\e{common variables}.
2958 A common variable is much like a global variable declared in the
2959 uninitialised data section, so that
2963 is similar in function to
2969 The difference is that if more than one module defines the same
2970 common variable, then at link time those variables will be
2971 \e{merged}, and references to \c{intvar} in all modules will point
2972 at the same piece of memory.
2974 Like \c{GLOBAL} and \c{EXTERN}, \c{COMMON} supports object-format
2975 specific extensions. For example, the \c{obj} format allows common
2976 variables to be NEAR or FAR, and the \c{elf} format allows you to
2977 specify the alignment requirements of a common variable:
2979 \c common commvar 4:near ; works in OBJ
2980 \c common intarray 100:4 ; works in ELF: 4 byte aligned
2982 Once again, like \c{EXTERN} and \c{GLOBAL}, the primitive form of
2983 \c{COMMON} differs from the user-level form only in that it can take
2984 only one argument at a time.
2986 \C{outfmt} \i{Output Formats}
2988 NASM is a portable assembler, designed to be able to compile on any
2989 ANSI C-supporting platform and produce output to run on a variety of
2990 Intel x86 operating systems. For this reason, it has a large number
2991 of available output formats, selected using the \i\c{-f} option on
2992 the NASM \i{command line}. Each of these formats, along with its
2993 extensions to the base NASM syntax, is detailed in this chapter.
2995 As stated in \k{opt-o}, NASM chooses a \i{default name} for your
2996 output file based on the input file name and the chosen output
2997 format. This will be generated by removing the \i{extension}
2998 (\c{.asm}, \c{.s}, or whatever you like to use) from the input file
2999 name, and substituting an extension defined by the output format.
3000 The extensions are given with each format below.
3002 \H{binfmt} \i\c{bin}: \i{Flat-Form Binary}\I{pure binary} Output
3004 The \c{bin} format does not produce object files: it generates
3005 nothing in the output file except the code you wrote. Such `pure
3006 binary' files are used by \i{MS-DOS}: \i\c{.COM} executables and
3007 \i\c{.SYS} device drivers are pure binary files. Pure binary output
3008 is also useful for \i{operating-system} and \i{boot loader}
3011 \c{bin} supports the three \i{standardised section names} \i\c{.text},
3012 \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss} only. The file NASM outputs will contain the
3013 contents of the \c{.text} section first, followed by the contents of
3014 the \c{.data} section, aligned on a four-byte boundary. The \c{.bss}
3015 section is not stored in the output file at all, but is assumed to
3016 appear directly after the end of the \c{.data} section, again
3017 aligned on a four-byte boundary.
3019 If you specify no explicit \c{SECTION} directive, the code you write
3020 will be directed by default into the \c{.text} section.
3022 Using the \c{bin} format puts NASM by default into 16-bit mode (see
3023 \k{bits}). In order to use \c{bin} to write 32-bit code such as an
3024 OS kernel, you need to explicitly issue the \I\c{BITS}\c{BITS 32}
3027 \c{bin} has no default output file name extension: instead, it
3028 leaves your file name as it is once the original extension has been
3029 removed. Thus, the default is for NASM to assemble \c{binprog.asm}
3030 into a binary file called \c{binprog}.
3032 \S{org} \i\c{ORG}: Binary File \i{Program Origin}
3034 The \c{bin} format provides an additional directive to the list
3035 given in \k{directive}: \c{ORG}. The function of the \c{ORG}
3036 directive is to specify the origin address which NASM will assume
3037 the program begins at when it is loaded into memory.
3039 For example, the following code will generate the longword
3046 Unlike the \c{ORG} directive provided by MASM-compatible assemblers,
3047 which allows you to jump around in the object file and overwrite
3048 code you have already generated, NASM's \c{ORG} does exactly what
3049 the directive says: \e{origin}. Its sole function is to specify one
3050 offset which is added to all internal address references within the
3051 file; it does not permit any of the trickery that MASM's version
3052 does. See \k{proborg} for further comments.
3054 \S{binseg} \c{bin} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
3055 Directive\I{SECTION, bin extensions to}
3057 The \c{bin} output format extends the \c{SECTION} (or \c{SEGMENT})
3058 directive to allow you to specify the alignment requirements of
3059 segments. This is done by appending the \i\c{ALIGN} qualifier to the
3060 end of the section-definition line. For example,
3062 \c section .data align=16
3064 switches to the section \c{.data} and also specifies that it must be
3065 aligned on a 16-byte boundary.
3067 The parameter to \c{ALIGN} specifies how many low bits of the
3068 section start address must be forced to zero. The alignment value
3069 given may be any power of two.\I{section alignment, in
3070 bin}\I{segment alignment, in bin}\I{alignment, in bin sections}
3072 \H{objfmt} \i\c{obj}: \i{Microsoft OMF}\I{OMF} Object Files
3074 The \c{obj} file format (NASM calls it \c{obj} rather than \c{omf}
3075 for historical reasons) is the one produced by \i{MASM} and
3076 \i{TASM}, which is typically fed to 16-bit DOS linkers to produce
3077 \i\c{.EXE} files. It is also the format used by \i{OS/2}.
3079 \c{obj} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.obj}.
3081 \c{obj} is not exclusively a 16-bit format, though: NASM has full
3082 support for the 32-bit extensions to the format. In particular,
3083 32-bit \c{obj} format files are used by \i{Borland's Win32
3084 compilers}, instead of using Microsoft's newer \i\c{win32} object
3087 The \c{obj} format does not define any special segment names: you
3088 can call your segments anything you like. Typical names for segments
3089 in \c{obj} format files are \c{CODE}, \c{DATA} and \c{BSS}.
3091 If your source file contains code before specifying an explicit
3092 \c{SEGMENT} directive, then NASM will invent its own segment called
3093 \i\c{__NASMDEFSEG} for you.
3095 When you define a segment in an \c{obj} file, NASM defines the
3096 segment name as a symbol as well, so that you can access the segment
3097 address of the segment. So, for example:
3102 \c function: mov ax,data ; get segment address of data
3103 \c mov ds,ax ; and move it into DS
3104 \c inc word [dvar] ; now this reference will work
3107 The \c{obj} format also enables the use of the \i\c{SEG} and
3108 \i\c{WRT} operators, so that you can write code which does things
3112 \c mov ax,seg foo ; get preferred segment of foo
3114 \c mov ax,data ; a different segment
3116 \c mov ax,[ds:foo] ; this accesses `foo'
3117 \c mov [es:foo wrt data],bx ; so does this
3119 \S{objseg} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{SEGMENT}
3120 Directive\I{SEGMENT, obj extensions to}
3122 The \c{obj} output format extends the \c{SEGMENT} (or \c{SECTION})
3123 directive to allow you to specify various properties of the segment
3124 you are defining. This is done by appending extra qualifiers to the
3125 end of the segment-definition line. For example,
3127 \c segment code private align=16
3129 defines the segment \c{code}, but also declares it to be a private
3130 segment, and requires that the portion of it described in this code
3131 module must be aligned on a 16-byte boundary.
3133 The available qualifiers are:
3135 \b \i\c{PRIVATE}, \i\c{PUBLIC}, \i\c{COMMON} and \i\c{STACK} specify
3136 the combination characteristics of the segment. \c{PRIVATE} segments
3137 do not get combined with any others by the linker; \c{PUBLIC} and
3138 \c{STACK} segments get concatenated together at link time; and
3139 \c{COMMON} segments all get overlaid on top of each other rather
3140 than stuck end-to-end.
3142 \b \i\c{ALIGN} is used, as shown above, to specify how many low bits
3143 of the segment start address must be forced to zero. The alignment
3144 value given may be any power of two from 1 to 4096; in reality, the
3145 only values supported are 1, 2, 4, 16, 256 and 4096, so if 8 is
3146 specified it will be rounded up to 16, and 32, 64 and 128 will all
3147 be rounded up to 256, and so on. Note that alignment to 4096-byte
3148 boundaries is a \i{PharLap} extension to the format and may not be
3149 supported by all linkers.\I{section alignment, in OBJ}\I{segment
3150 alignment, in OBJ}\I{alignment, in OBJ sections}
3152 \b \i\c{CLASS} can be used to specify the segment class; this feature
3153 indicates to the linker that segments of the same class should be
3154 placed near each other in the output file. The class name can be any
3155 word, e.g. \c{CLASS=CODE}.
3157 \b \i\c{OVERLAY}, like \c{CLASS}, is specified with an arbitrary word
3158 as an argument, and provides overlay information to an
3159 overlay-capable linker.
3161 \b Segments can be declared as \i\c{USE16} or \i\c{USE32}, which has
3162 the effect of recording the choice in the object file and also
3163 ensuring that NASM's default assembly mode when assembling in that
3164 segment is 16-bit or 32-bit respectively.
3166 \b When writing \i{OS/2} object files, you should declare 32-bit
3167 segments as \i\c{FLAT}, which causes the default segment base for
3168 anything in the segment to be the special group \c{FLAT}, and also
3169 defines the group if it is not already defined.
3171 \b The \c{obj} file format also allows segments to be declared as
3172 having a pre-defined absolute segment address, although no linkers
3173 are currently known to make sensible use of this feature;
3174 nevertheless, NASM allows you to declare a segment such as
3175 \c{SEGMENT SCREEN ABSOLUTE=0xB800} if you need to. The \i\c{ABSOLUTE}
3176 and \c{ALIGN} keywords are mutually exclusive.
3178 NASM's default segment attributes are \c{PUBLIC}, \c{ALIGN=1}, no
3179 class, no overlay, and \c{USE16}.
3181 \S{group} \i\c{GROUP}: Defining Groups of Segments\I{segments, groups of}
3183 The \c{obj} format also allows segments to be grouped, so that a
3184 single segment register can be used to refer to all the segments in
3185 a group. NASM therefore supplies the \c{GROUP} directive, whereby
3191 \c ; some uninitialised data
3192 \c group dgroup data bss
3194 which will define a group called \c{dgroup} to contain the segments
3195 \c{data} and \c{bss}. Like \c{SEGMENT}, \c{GROUP} causes the group
3196 name to be defined as a symbol, so that you can refer to a variable
3197 \c{var} in the \c{data} segment as \c{var wrt data} or as \c{var wrt
3198 dgroup}, depending on which segment value is currently in your
3201 If you just refer to \c{var}, however, and \c{var} is declared in a
3202 segment which is part of a group, then NASM will default to giving
3203 you the offset of \c{var} from the beginning of the \e{group}, not
3204 the \e{segment}. Therefore \c{SEG var}, also, will return the group
3205 base rather than the segment base.
3207 NASM will allow a segment to be part of more than one group, but
3208 will generate a warning if you do this. Variables declared in a
3209 segment which is part of more than one group will default to being
3210 relative to the first group that was defined to contain the segment.
3212 A group does not have to contain any segments; you can still make
3213 \c{WRT} references to a group which does not contain the variable
3214 you are referring to. OS/2, for example, defines the special group
3215 \c{FLAT} with no segments in it.
3217 \S{uppercase} \i\c{UPPERCASE}: Disabling Case Sensitivity in Output
3219 Although NASM itself is \i{case sensitive}, some OMF linkers are
3220 not; therefore it can be useful for NASM to output single-case
3221 object files. The \c{UPPERCASE} format-specific directive causes all
3222 segment, group and symbol names that are written to the object file
3223 to be forced to upper case just before being written. Within a
3224 source file, NASM is still case-sensitive; but the object file can
3225 be written entirely in upper case if desired.
3227 \c{UPPERCASE} is used alone on a line; it requires no parameters.
3229 \S{import} \i\c{IMPORT}: Importing DLL Symbols\I{DLL symbols,
3230 importing}\I{symbols, importing from DLLs}
3232 The \c{IMPORT} format-specific directive defines a symbol to be
3233 imported from a DLL, for use if you are writing a DLL's \i{import
3234 library} in NASM. You still need to declare the symbol as \c{EXTERN}
3235 as well as using the \c{IMPORT} directive.
3237 The \c{IMPORT} directive takes two required parameters, separated by
3238 white space, which are (respectively) the name of the symbol you
3239 wish to import and the name of the library you wish to import it
3242 \c import WSAStartup wsock32.dll
3244 A third optional parameter gives the name by which the symbol is
3245 known in the library you are importing it from, in case this is not
3246 the same as the name you wish the symbol to be known by to your code
3247 once you have imported it. For example:
3249 \c import asyncsel wsock32.dll WSAAsyncSelect
3251 \S{export} \i\c{EXPORT}: Exporting DLL Symbols\I{DLL symbols,
3252 exporting}\I{symbols, exporting from DLLs}
3254 The \c{EXPORT} format-specific directive defines a global symbol to
3255 be exported as a DLL symbol, for use if you are writing a DLL in
3256 NASM. You still need to declare the symbol as \c{GLOBAL} as well as
3257 using the \c{EXPORT} directive.
3259 \c{EXPORT} takes one required parameter, which is the name of the
3260 symbol you wish to export, as it was defined in your source file. An
3261 optional second parameter (separated by white space from the first)
3262 gives the \e{external} name of the symbol: the name by which you
3263 wish the symbol to be known to programs using the DLL. If this name
3264 is the same as the internal name, you may leave the second parameter
3267 Further parameters can be given to define attributes of the exported
3268 symbol. These parameters, like the second, are separated by white
3269 space. If further parameters are given, the external name must also
3270 be specified, even if it is the same as the internal name. The
3271 available attributes are:
3273 \b \c{resident} indicates that the exported name is to be kept
3274 resident by the system loader. This is an optimisation for
3275 frequently used symbols imported by name.
3277 \b \c{nodata} indicates that the exported symbol is a function which
3278 does not make use of any initialised data.
3280 \b \c{parm=NNN}, where \c{NNN} is an integer, sets the number of
3281 parameter words for the case in which the symbol is a call gate
3282 between 32-bit and 16-bit segments.
3284 \b An attribute which is just a number indicates that the symbol
3285 should be exported with an identifying number (ordinal), and gives
3291 \c export myfunc TheRealMoreFormalLookingFunctionName
3292 \c export myfunc myfunc 1234 ; export by ordinal
3293 \c export myfunc myfunc resident parm=23 nodata
3295 \S{dotdotstart} \i\c{..start}: Defining the \i{Program Entry
3298 OMF linkers require exactly one of the object files being linked to
3299 define the program entry point, where execution will begin when the
3300 program is run. If the object file that defines the entry point is
3301 assembled using NASM, you specify the entry point by declaring the
3302 special symbol \c{..start} at the point where you wish execution to
3305 \S{objextern} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{EXTERN}
3306 Directive\I{EXTERN, obj extensions to}
3308 If you declare an external symbol with the directive
3312 then references such as \c{mov ax,foo} will give you the offset of
3313 \c{foo} from its preferred segment base (as specified in whichever
3314 module \c{foo} is actually defined in). So to access the contents of
3315 \c{foo} you will usually need to do something like
3317 \c mov ax,seg foo ; get preferred segment base
3318 \c mov es,ax ; move it into ES
3319 \c mov ax,[es:foo] ; and use offset `foo' from it
3321 This is a little unwieldy, particularly if you know that an external
3322 is going to be accessible from a given segment or group, say
3323 \c{dgroup}. So if \c{DS} already contained \c{dgroup}, you could
3326 \c mov ax,[foo wrt dgroup]
3328 However, having to type this every time you want to access \c{foo}
3329 can be a pain; so NASM allows you to declare \c{foo} in the
3332 \c extern foo:wrt dgroup
3334 This form causes NASM to pretend that the preferred segment base of
3335 \c{foo} is in fact \c{dgroup}; so the expression \c{seg foo} will
3336 now return \c{dgroup}, and the expression \c{foo} is equivalent to
3339 This \I{default-WRT mechanism}default-\c{WRT} mechanism can be used
3340 to make externals appear to be relative to any group or segment in
3341 your program. It can also be applied to common variables: see
3344 \S{objcommon} \c{obj} Extensions to the \c{COMMON}
3345 Directive\I{COMMON, obj extensions to}
3347 The \c{obj} format allows common variables to be either near\I{near
3348 common variables} or far\I{far common variables}; NASM allows you to
3349 specify which your variables should be by the use of the syntax
3351 \c common nearvar 2:near ; `nearvar' is a near common
3352 \c common farvar 10:far ; and `farvar' is far
3354 Far common variables may be greater in size than 64Kb, and so the
3355 OMF specification says that they are declared as a number of
3356 \e{elements} of a given size. So a 10-byte far common variable could
3357 be declared as ten one-byte elements, five two-byte elements, two
3358 five-byte elements or one ten-byte element.
3360 Some OMF linkers require the \I{element size, in common
3361 variables}\I{common variables, element size}element size, as well as
3362 the variable size, to match when resolving common variables declared
3363 in more than one module. Therefore NASM must allow you to specify
3364 the element size on your far common variables. This is done by the
3367 \c common c_5by2 10:far 5 ; two five-byte elements
3368 \c common c_2by5 10:far 2 ; five two-byte elements
3370 If no element size is specified, the default is 1. Also, the \c{FAR}
3371 keyword is not required when an element size is specified, since
3372 only far commons may have element sizes at all. So the above
3373 declarations could equivalently be
3375 \c common c_5by2 10:5 ; two five-byte elements
3376 \c common c_2by5 10:2 ; five two-byte elements
3378 In addition to these extensions, the \c{COMMON} directive in \c{obj}
3379 also supports default-\c{WRT} specification like \c{EXTERN} does
3380 (explained in \k{objextern}). So you can also declare things like
3382 \c common foo 10:wrt dgroup
3383 \c common bar 16:far 2:wrt data
3384 \c common baz 24:wrt data:6
3386 \H{win32fmt} \i\c{win32}: Microsoft Win32 Object Files
3388 The \c{win32} output format generates Microsoft Win32 object files,
3389 suitable for passing to Microsoft linkers such as \i{Visual C++}.
3390 Note that Borland Win32 compilers do not use this format, but use
3391 \c{obj} instead (see \k{objfmt}).
3393 \c{win32} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.obj}.
3395 Note that although Microsoft say that Win32 object files follow the
3396 COFF (Common Object File Format) standard, the object files produced
3397 by Microsoft Win32 compilers are not compatible with COFF linkers
3398 such as DJGPP's, and vice versa. This is due to a difference of
3399 opinion over the precise semantics of PC-relative relocations. To
3400 produce COFF files suitable for DJGPP, use NASM's \c{coff} output
3401 format; conversely, the \c{coff} format does not produce object
3402 files that Win32 linkers can generate correct output from.
3404 \S{win32sect} \c{win32} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
3405 Directive\I{SECTION, win32 extensions to}
3407 Like the \c{obj} format, \c{win32} allows you to specify additional
3408 information on the \c{SECTION} directive line, to control the type
3409 and properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties
3410 are generated automatically by NASM for the \i{standard section names}
3411 \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}, but may still be overridden by
3414 The available qualifiers are:
3416 \b \c{code}, or equivalently \c{text}, defines the section to be a
3417 code section. This marks the section as readable and executable, but
3418 not writable, and also indicates to the linker that the type of the
3421 \b \c{data} and \c{bss} define the section to be a data section,
3422 analogously to \c{code}. Data sections are marked as readable and
3423 writable, but not executable. \c{data} declares an initialised data
3424 section, whereas \c{bss} declares an uninitialised data section.
3426 \b \c{rdata} declares an initialised data section that is readable
3427 but not writable. Microsoft compilers use this section to place
3430 \b \c{info} defines the section to be an \i{informational section},
3431 which is not included in the executable file by the linker, but may
3432 (for example) pass information \e{to} the linker. For example,
3433 declaring an \c{info}-type section called \i\c{.drectve} causes the
3434 linker to interpret the contents of the section as command-line
3437 \b \c{align=}, used with a trailing number as in \c{obj}, gives the
3438 \I{section alignment, in win32}\I{alignment, in win32
3439 sections}alignment requirements of the section. The maximum you may
3440 specify is 64: the Win32 object file format contains no means to
3441 request a greater section alignment than this. If alignment is not
3442 explicitly specified, the defaults are 16-byte alignment for code
3443 sections, 8-byte alignment for rdata sections and 4-byte alignment
3444 for data (and BSS) sections.
3445 Informational sections get a default alignment of 1 byte (no
3446 alignment), though the value does not matter.
3448 The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
3451 \c section .text code align=16
3452 \c section .data data align=4
3453 \c section .rdata rdata align=8
3454 \c section .bss bss align=4
3456 Any other section name is treated by default like \c{.text}.
3458 \H{cofffmt} \i\c{coff}: \i{Common Object File Format}
3460 The \c{coff} output type produces COFF object files suitable for
3461 linking with the \i{DJGPP} linker.
3463 \c{coff} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
3465 The \c{coff} format supports the same extensions to the \c{SECTION}
3466 directive as \c{win32} does, except that the \c{align} qualifier and
3467 the \c{info} section type are not supported.
3469 \H{elffmt} \i\c{elf}: \i{Linux ELF}\I{Executable and Linkable
3472 The \c{elf} output format generates ELF32 (Executable and Linkable
3473 Format) object files, as used by Linux. \c{elf} provides a default
3474 output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
3476 \S{elfsect} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{SECTION}
3477 Directive\I{SECTION, elf extensions to}
3479 Like the \c{obj} format, \c{elf} allows you to specify additional
3480 information on the \c{SECTION} directive line, to control the type
3481 and properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties
3482 are generated automatically by NASM for the \i{standard section
3483 names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}, but may still be
3484 overridden by these qualifiers.
3486 The available qualifiers are:
3488 \b \i\c{alloc} defines the section to be one which is loaded into
3489 memory when the program is run. \i\c{noalloc} defines it to be one
3490 which is not, such as an informational or comment section.
3492 \b \i\c{exec} defines the section to be one which should have execute
3493 permission when the program is run. \i\c{noexec} defines it as one
3496 \b \i\c{write} defines the section to be one which should be writable
3497 when the program is run. \i\c{nowrite} defines it as one which should
3500 \b \i\c{progbits} defines the section to be one with explicit contents
3501 stored in the object file: an ordinary code or data section, for
3502 example, \i\c{nobits} defines the section to be one with no explicit
3503 contents given, such as a BSS section.
3505 \b \c{align=}, used with a trailing number as in \c{obj}, gives the
3506 \I{section alignment, in elf}\I{alignment, in elf sections}alignment
3507 requirements of the section.
3509 The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
3512 \c section .text progbits alloc exec nowrite align=16
3513 \c section .data progbits alloc noexec write align=4
3514 \c section .bss nobits alloc noexec write align=4
3515 \c section other progbits alloc noexec nowrite align=1
3517 (Any section name other than \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss} is
3518 treated by default like \c{other} in the above code.)
3520 \S{elfwrt} \i{Position-Independent Code}\I{PIC}: \c{elf} Special
3521 Symbols and \i\c{WRT}
3523 The ELF specification contains enough features to allow
3524 position-independent code (PIC) to be written, which makes \i{ELF
3525 shared libraries} very flexible. However, it also means NASM has to
3526 be able to generate a variety of strange relocation types in ELF
3527 object files, if it is to be an assembler which can write PIC.
3529 Since ELF does not support segment-base references, the \c{WRT}
3530 operator is not used for its normal purpose; therefore NASM's
3531 \c{elf} output format makes use of \c{WRT} for a different purpose,
3532 namely the PIC-specific \I{relocations, PIC-specific}relocation
3535 \c{elf} defines five special symbols which you can use as the
3536 right-hand side of the \c{WRT} operator to obtain PIC relocation
3537 types. They are \i\c{..gotpc}, \i\c{..gotoff}, \i\c{..got},
3538 \i\c{..plt} and \i\c{..sym}. Their functions are summarised here:
3540 \b Referring to the symbol marking the global offset table base
3541 using \c{wrt ..gotpc} will end up giving the distance from the
3542 beginning of the current section to the global offset table.
3543 (\i\c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_} is the standard symbol name used to
3544 refer to the \i{GOT}.) So you would then need to add \i\c{$$} to the
3545 result to get the real address of the GOT.
3547 \b Referring to a location in one of your own sections using \c{wrt
3548 ..gotoff} will give the distance from the beginning of the GOT to
3549 the specified location, so that adding on the address of the GOT
3550 would give the real address of the location you wanted.
3552 \b Referring to an external or global symbol using \c{wrt ..got}
3553 causes the linker to build an entry \e{in} the GOT containing the
3554 address of the symbol, and the reference gives the distance from the
3555 beginning of the GOT to the entry; so you can add on the address of
3556 the GOT, load from the resulting address, and end up with the
3557 address of the symbol.
3559 \b Referring to a procedure name using \c{wrt ..plt} causes the
3560 linker to build a \i{procedure linkage table} entry for the symbol,
3561 and the reference gives the address of the \i{PLT} entry. You can
3562 only use this in contexts which would generate a PC-relative
3563 relocation normally (i.e. as the destination for \c{CALL} or
3564 \c{JMP}), since ELF contains no relocation type to refer to PLT
3567 \b Referring to a symbol name using \c{wrt ..sym} causes NASM to
3568 write an ordinary relocation, but instead of making the relocation
3569 relative to the start of the section and then adding on the offset
3570 to the symbol, it will write a relocation record aimed directly at
3571 the symbol in question. The distinction is a necessary one due to a
3572 peculiarity of the dynamic linker.
3574 A fuller explanation of how to use these relocation types to write
3575 shared libraries entirely in NASM is given in \k{picdll}.
3577 \S{elfglob} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} Directive\I{GLOBAL,
3578 elf extensions to}\I{GLOBAL, aoutb extensions to}
3580 ELF object files can contain more information about a global symbol
3581 than just its address: they can contain the \I{symbol sizes,
3582 specifying}\I{size, of symbols}size of the symbol and its \I{symbol
3583 types, specifying}\I{type, of symbols}type as well. These are not
3584 merely debugger conveniences, but are actually necessary when the
3585 program being written is a \i{shared library}. NASM therefore
3586 supports some extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} directive, allowing you
3587 to specify these features.
3589 You can specify whether a global variable is a function or a data
3590 object by suffixing the name with a colon and the word
3591 \i\c{function} or \i\c{data}. (\i\c{object} is a synonym for
3592 \c{data}.) For example:
3594 \c global hashlookup:function, hashtable:data
3596 exports the global symbol \c{hashlookup} as a function and
3597 \c{hashtable} as a data object.
3599 You can also specify the size of the data associated with the
3600 symbol, as a numeric expression (which may involve labels, and even
3601 forward references) after the type specifier. Like this:
3603 \c global hashtable:data (hashtable.end - hashtable)
3605 \c db this,that,theother ; some data here
3608 This makes NASM automatically calculate the length of the table and
3609 place that information into the ELF symbol table.
3611 Declaring the type and size of global symbols is necessary when
3612 writing shared library code. For more information, see
3615 \S{elfcomm} \c{elf} Extensions to the \c{COMMON} Directive\I{COMMON,
3618 ELF also allows you to specify alignment requirements \I{common
3619 variables, alignment in elf}\I{alignment, of elf common variables}on
3620 common variables. This is done by putting a number (which must be a
3621 power of two) after the name and size of the common variable,
3622 separated (as usual) by a colon. For example, an array of
3623 doublewords would benefit from 4-byte alignment:
3625 \c common dwordarray 128:4
3627 This declares the total size of the array to be 128 bytes, and
3628 requires that it be aligned on a 4-byte boundary.
3630 \H{aoutfmt} \i\c{aout}: Linux \I{a.out, Linux version}\c{a.out} Object Files
3632 The \c{aout} format generates \c{a.out} object files, in the form
3633 used by early Linux systems. (These differ from other \c{a.out}
3634 object files in that the magic number in the first four bytes of the
3635 file is different. Also, some implementations of \c{a.out}, for
3636 example NetBSD's, support position-independent code, which Linux's
3637 implementation doesn't.)
3639 \c{a.out} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
3641 \c{a.out} is a very simple object format. It supports no special
3642 directives, no special symbols, no use of \c{SEG} or \c{WRT}, and no
3643 extensions to any standard directives. It supports only the three
3644 \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
3646 \H{aoutfmt} \i\c{aoutb}: \i{NetBSD}/\i{FreeBSD}/\i{OpenBSD}
3647 \I{a.out, BSD version}\c{a.out} Object Files
3649 The \c{aoutb} format generates \c{a.out} object files, in the form
3650 used by the various free BSD Unix clones, NetBSD, FreeBSD and
3651 OpenBSD. For simple object files, this object format is exactly the
3652 same as \c{aout} except for the magic number in the first four bytes
3653 of the file. However, the \c{aoutb} format supports
3654 \I{PIC}\i{position-independent code} in the same way as the \c{elf}
3655 format, so you can use it to write BSD \i{shared libraries}.
3657 \c{aoutb} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
3659 \c{aoutb} supports no special directives, no special symbols, and
3660 only the three \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data}
3661 and \i\c{.bss}. However, it also supports the same use of \i\c{WRT} as
3662 \c{elf} does, to provide position-independent code relocation types.
3663 See \k{elfwrt} for full documentation of this feature.
3665 \c{aoutb} also supports the same extensions to the \c{GLOBAL}
3666 directive as \c{elf} does: see \k{elfglob} for documentation of
3669 \H{as86fmt} \c{as86}: Linux \i\c{as86} Object Files
3671 The Linux 16-bit assembler \c{as86} has its own non-standard object
3672 file format. Although its companion linker \i\c{ld86} produces
3673 something close to ordinary \c{a.out} binaries as output, the object
3674 file format used to communicate between \c{as86} and \c{ld86} is not
3677 NASM supports this format, just in case it is useful, as \c{as86}.
3678 \c{as86} provides a default output file-name extension of \c{.o}.
3680 \c{as86} is a very simple object format (from the NASM user's point
3681 of view). It supports no special directives, no special symbols, no
3682 use of \c{SEG} or \c{WRT}, and no extensions to any standard
3683 directives. It supports only the three \i{standard section names}
3684 \i\c{.text}, \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
3686 \H{rdffmt} \I{RDOFF}\i\c{rdf}: \i{Relocatable Dynamic Object File
3689 The \c{rdf} output format produces RDOFF object files. RDOFF
3690 (Relocatable Dynamic Object File Format) is a home-grown object-file
3691 format, designed alongside NASM itself and reflecting in its file
3692 format the internal structure of the assembler.
3694 RDOFF is not used by any well-known operating systems. Those writing
3695 their own systems, however, may well wish to use RDOFF as their
3696 object format, on the grounds that it is designed primarily for
3697 simplicity and contains very little file-header bureaucracy.
3699 The Unix NASM archive, and the DOS archive which includes sources,
3700 both contain an \I{rdoff subdirectory}\c{rdoff} subdirectory holding
3701 a set of RDOFF utilities: an RDF linker, an RDF static-library
3702 manager, an RDF file dump utility, and a program which will load and
3703 execute an RDF executable under Linux.
3705 \c{rdf} supports only the \i{standard section names} \i\c{.text},
3706 \i\c{.data} and \i\c{.bss}.
3708 \S{rdflib} Requiring a Library: The \i\c{LIBRARY} Directive
3710 RDOFF contains a mechanism for an object file to demand a given
3711 library to be linked to the module, either at load time or run time.
3712 This is done by the \c{LIBRARY} directive, which takes one argument
3713 which is the name of the module:
3715 \c library mylib.rdl
3717 \S{rdfmod} Specifying a Module Name: The \i\c{MODULE} Directive
3719 Special RDOFF header record is used to store the name of the module.
3720 It can be used, for example, by run-time loader to perform dynamic
3721 linking. \c{MODULE} directive takes one argument which is the name
3726 Note that when you statically link modules and tell linker to strip
3727 the symbols from output file, all module names will be stripped too.
3728 To avoid it, you should start module names with \I{$prefix}\c{$}, like:
3730 \c module $kernel.core
3732 \S{rdfglob} \c{rdf} Extensions to the \c{GLOBAL} directive\I{GLOBAL,
3735 RDOFF global symbols can contain additional information needed by the
3736 static linker. You can mark a global symbol as exported, thus telling
3737 the linker do not strip it from target executable or library file.
3738 Like in ELF, you can also specify whether an exported symbol is a
3739 procedure (function) or data object.
3741 Suffixing the name with a colon and the word \i\c{export} you make the
3744 \c global sys_open:export
3746 To specify that exported symbol is a procedure (function), you add the
3747 word \i\c{proc} or \i\c{function} after declaration:
3749 \c global sys_open:export proc
3751 Similarly, to specify exported data object, add the word \i\c{data}
3752 or \i\c{object} to the directive:
3754 \c global kernel_ticks:export data
3756 \H{dbgfmt} \i\c{dbg}: Debugging Format
3758 The \c{dbg} output format is not built into NASM in the default
3759 configuration. If you are building your own NASM executable from the
3760 sources, you can define \i\c{OF_DBG} in \c{outform.h} or on the
3761 compiler command line, and obtain the \c{dbg} output format.
3763 The \c{dbg} format does not output an object file as such; instead,
3764 it outputs a text file which contains a complete list of all the
3765 transactions between the main body of NASM and the output-format
3766 back end module. It is primarily intended to aid people who want to
3767 write their own output drivers, so that they can get a clearer idea
3768 of the various requests the main program makes of the output driver,
3769 and in what order they happen.
3771 For simple files, one can easily use the \c{dbg} format like this:
3773 \c nasm -f dbg filename.asm
3775 which will generate a diagnostic file called \c{filename.dbg}.
3776 However, this will not work well on files which were designed for a
3777 different object format, because each object format defines its own
3778 macros (usually user-level forms of directives), and those macros
3779 will not be defined in the \c{dbg} format. Therefore it can be
3780 useful to run NASM twice, in order to do the preprocessing with the
3781 native object format selected:
3783 \c nasm -e -f rdf -o rdfprog.i rdfprog.asm
3784 \c nasm -a -f dbg rdfprog.i
3786 This preprocesses \c{rdfprog.asm} into \c{rdfprog.i}, keeping the
3787 \c{rdf} object format selected in order to make sure RDF special
3788 directives are converted into primitive form correctly. Then the
3789 preprocessed source is fed through the \c{dbg} format to generate
3790 the final diagnostic output.
3792 This workaround will still typically not work for programs intended
3793 for \c{obj} format, because the \c{obj} \c{SEGMENT} and \c{GROUP}
3794 directives have side effects of defining the segment and group names
3795 as symbols; \c{dbg} will not do this, so the program will not
3796 assemble. You will have to work around that by defining the symbols
3797 yourself (using \c{EXTERN}, for example) if you really need to get a
3798 \c{dbg} trace of an \c{obj}-specific source file.
3800 \c{dbg} accepts any section name and any directives at all, and logs
3801 them all to its output file.
3803 \C{16bit} Writing 16-bit Code (DOS, Windows 3/3.1)
3805 This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues encountered
3806 when writing 16-bit code to run under MS-DOS or Windows 3.x. It
3807 covers how to link programs to produce \c{.EXE} or \c{.COM} files,
3808 how to write \c{.SYS} device drivers, and how to interface assembly
3809 language code with 16-bit C compilers and with Borland Pascal.
3811 \H{exefiles} Producing \i\c{.EXE} Files
3813 Any large program written under DOS needs to be built as a \c{.EXE}
3814 file: only \c{.EXE} files have the necessary internal structure
3815 required to span more than one 64K segment. \i{Windows} programs,
3816 also, have to be built as \c{.EXE} files, since Windows does not
3817 support the \c{.COM} format.
3819 In general, you generate \c{.EXE} files by using the \c{obj} output
3820 format to produce one or more \i\c{.OBJ} files, and then linking
3821 them together using a linker. However, NASM also supports the direct
3822 generation of simple DOS \c{.EXE} files using the \c{bin} output
3823 format (by using \c{DB} and \c{DW} to construct the \c{.EXE} file
3824 header), and a macro package is supplied to do this. Thanks to
3825 Yann Guidon for contributing the code for this.
3827 NASM may also support \c{.EXE} natively as another output format in
3830 \S{objexe} Using the \c{obj} Format To Generate \c{.EXE} Files
3832 This section describes the usual method of generating \c{.EXE} files
3833 by linking \c{.OBJ} files together.
3835 Most 16-bit programming language packages come with a suitable
3836 linker; if you have none of these, there is a free linker called
3837 \i{VAL}\I{linker, free}, available in \c{LZH} archive format from
3838 \W{ftp://x2ftp.oulu.fi/pub/msdos/programming/lang/}\i\c{x2ftp.oulu.fi}.
3839 An LZH archiver can be found at
3840 \W{ftp://ftp.simtel.net/pub/simtelnet/msdos/arcers}\i\c{ftp.simtel.net}.
3841 There is another `free' linker (though this one doesn't come with
3842 sources) called \i{FREELINK}, available from
3843 \W{http://www.pcorner.com/tpc/old/3-101.html}\i\c{www.pcorner.com}.
3844 A third, \i\c{djlink}, written by DJ Delorie, is available at
3845 \W{http://www.delorie.com/djgpp/16bit/djlink/}\i\c{www.delorie.com}.
3847 When linking several \c{.OBJ} files into a \c{.EXE} file, you should
3848 ensure that exactly one of them has a start point defined (using the
3849 \I{program entry point}\i\c{..start} special symbol defined by the
3850 \c{obj} format: see \k{dotdotstart}). If no module defines a start
3851 point, the linker will not know what value to give the entry-point
3852 field in the output file header; if more than one defines a start
3853 point, the linker will not know \e{which} value to use.
3855 An example of a NASM source file which can be assembled to a
3856 \c{.OBJ} file and linked on its own to a \c{.EXE} is given here. It
3857 demonstrates the basic principles of defining a stack, initialising
3858 the segment registers, and declaring a start point. This file is
3859 also provided in the \I{test subdirectory}\c{test} subdirectory of
3860 the NASM archives, under the name \c{objexe.asm}.
3864 \c ..start: mov ax,data
3870 This initial piece of code sets up \c{DS} to point to the data
3871 segment, and initialises \c{SS} and \c{SP} to point to the top of
3872 the provided stack. Notice that interrupts are implicitly disabled
3873 for one instruction after a move into \c{SS}, precisely for this
3874 situation, so that there's no chance of an interrupt occurring
3875 between the loads of \c{SS} and \c{SP} and not having a stack to
3878 Note also that the special symbol \c{..start} is defined at the
3879 beginning of this code, which means that will be the entry point
3880 into the resulting executable file.
3886 The above is the main program: load \c{DS:DX} with a pointer to the
3887 greeting message (\c{hello} is implicitly relative to the segment
3888 \c{data}, which was loaded into \c{DS} in the setup code, so the
3889 full pointer is valid), and call the DOS print-string function.
3894 This terminates the program using another DOS system call.
3897 \c hello: db 'hello, world', 13, 10, '$'
3899 The data segment contains the string we want to display.
3901 \c segment stack stack
3905 The above code declares a stack segment containing 64 bytes of
3906 uninitialised stack space, and points \c{stacktop} at the top of it.
3907 The directive \c{segment stack stack} defines a segment \e{called}
3908 \c{stack}, and also of \e{type} \c{STACK}. The latter is not
3909 necessary to the correct running of the program, but linkers are
3910 likely to issue warnings or errors if your program has no segment of
3913 The above file, when assembled into a \c{.OBJ} file, will link on
3914 its own to a valid \c{.EXE} file, which when run will print `hello,
3915 world' and then exit.
3917 \S{binexe} Using the \c{bin} Format To Generate \c{.EXE} Files
3919 The \c{.EXE} file format is simple enough that it's possible to
3920 build a \c{.EXE} file by writing a pure-binary program and sticking
3921 a 32-byte header on the front. This header is simple enough that it
3922 can be generated using \c{DB} and \c{DW} commands by NASM itself, so
3923 that you can use the \c{bin} output format to directly generate
3926 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc subdirectory}\c{misc}
3927 subdirectory, is a file \i\c{exebin.mac} of macros. It defines three
3928 macros: \i\c{EXE_begin}, \i\c{EXE_stack} and \i\c{EXE_end}.
3930 To produce a \c{.EXE} file using this method, you should start by
3931 using \c{%include} to load the \c{exebin.mac} macro package into
3932 your source file. You should then issue the \c{EXE_begin} macro call
3933 (which takes no arguments) to generate the file header data. Then
3934 write code as normal for the \c{bin} format - you can use all three
3935 standard sections \c{.text}, \c{.data} and \c{.bss}. At the end of
3936 the file you should call the \c{EXE_end} macro (again, no arguments),
3937 which defines some symbols to mark section sizes, and these symbols
3938 are referred to in the header code generated by \c{EXE_begin}.
3940 In this model, the code you end up writing starts at \c{0x100}, just
3941 like a \c{.COM} file - in fact, if you strip off the 32-byte header
3942 from the resulting \c{.EXE} file, you will have a valid \c{.COM}
3943 program. All the segment bases are the same, so you are limited to a
3944 64K program, again just like a \c{.COM} file. Note that an \c{ORG}
3945 directive is issued by the \c{EXE_begin} macro, so you should not
3946 explicitly issue one of your own.
3948 You can't directly refer to your segment base value, unfortunately,
3949 since this would require a relocation in the header, and things
3950 would get a lot more complicated. So you should get your segment
3951 base by copying it out of \c{CS} instead.
3953 On entry to your \c{.EXE} file, \c{SS:SP} are already set up to
3954 point to the top of a 2Kb stack. You can adjust the default stack
3955 size of 2Kb by calling the \c{EXE_stack} macro. For example, to
3956 change the stack size of your program to 64 bytes, you would call
3959 A sample program which generates a \c{.EXE} file in this way is
3960 given in the \c{test} subdirectory of the NASM archive, as
3963 \H{comfiles} Producing \i\c{.COM} Files
3965 While large DOS programs must be written as \c{.EXE} files, small
3966 ones are often better written as \c{.COM} files. \c{.COM} files are
3967 pure binary, and therefore most easily produced using the \c{bin}
3970 \S{combinfmt} Using the \c{bin} Format To Generate \c{.COM} Files
3972 \c{.COM} files expect to be loaded at offset \c{100h} into their
3973 segment (though the segment may change). Execution then begins at
3974 \I\c{ORG}\c{100h}, i.e. right at the start of the program. So to
3975 write a \c{.COM} program, you would create a source file looking
3980 \c start: ; put your code here
3982 \c ; put data items here
3984 \c ; put uninitialised data here
3986 The \c{bin} format puts the \c{.text} section first in the file, so
3987 you can declare data or BSS items before beginning to write code if
3988 you want to and the code will still end up at the front of the file
3991 The BSS (uninitialised data) section does not take up space in the
3992 \c{.COM} file itself: instead, addresses of BSS items are resolved
3993 to point at space beyond the end of the file, on the grounds that
3994 this will be free memory when the program is run. Therefore you
3995 should not rely on your BSS being initialised to all zeros when you
3998 To assemble the above program, you should use a command line like
4000 \c nasm myprog.asm -fbin -o myprog.com
4002 The \c{bin} format would produce a file called \c{myprog} if no
4003 explicit output file name were specified, so you have to override it
4004 and give the desired file name.
4006 \S{comobjfmt} Using the \c{obj} Format To Generate \c{.COM} Files
4008 If you are writing a \c{.COM} program as more than one module, you
4009 may wish to assemble several \c{.OBJ} files and link them together
4010 into a \c{.COM} program. You can do this, provided you have a linker
4011 capable of outputting \c{.COM} files directly (\i{TLINK} does this),
4012 or alternatively a converter program such as \i\c{EXE2BIN} to
4013 transform the \c{.EXE} file output from the linker into a \c{.COM}
4016 If you do this, you need to take care of several things:
4018 \b The first object file containing code should start its code
4019 segment with a line like \c{RESB 100h}. This is to ensure that the
4020 code begins at offset \c{100h} relative to the beginning of the code
4021 segment, so that the linker or converter program does not have to
4022 adjust address references within the file when generating the
4023 \c{.COM} file. Other assemblers use an \i\c{ORG} directive for this
4024 purpose, but \c{ORG} in NASM is a format-specific directive to the
4025 \c{bin} output format, and does not mean the same thing as it does
4026 in MASM-compatible assemblers.
4028 \b You don't need to define a stack segment.
4030 \b All your segments should be in the same group, so that every time
4031 your code or data references a symbol offset, all offsets are
4032 relative to the same segment base. This is because, when a \c{.COM}
4033 file is loaded, all the segment registers contain the same value.
4035 \H{sysfiles} Producing \i\c{.SYS} Files
4037 \i{MS-DOS device drivers} - \c{.SYS} files - are pure binary files,
4038 similar to \c{.COM} files, except that they start at origin zero
4039 rather than \c{100h}. Therefore, if you are writing a device driver
4040 using the \c{bin} format, you do not need the \c{ORG} directive,
4041 since the default origin for \c{bin} is zero. Similarly, if you are
4042 using \c{obj}, you do not need the \c{RESB 100h} at the start of
4045 \c{.SYS} files start with a header structure, containing pointers to
4046 the various routines inside the driver which do the work. This
4047 structure should be defined at the start of the code segment, even
4048 though it is not actually code.
4050 For more information on the format of \c{.SYS} files, and the data
4051 which has to go in the header structure, a list of books is given in
4052 the Frequently Asked Questions list for the newsgroup
4053 \W{news:comp.os.msdos.programmer}\i\c{comp.os.msdos.programmer}.
4055 \H{16c} Interfacing to 16-bit C Programs
4057 This section covers the basics of writing assembly routines that
4058 call, or are called from, C programs. To do this, you would
4059 typically write an assembly module as a \c{.OBJ} file, and link it
4060 with your C modules to produce a \i{mixed-language program}.
4062 \S{16cunder} External Symbol Names
4064 \I{C symbol names}\I{underscore, in C symbols}C compilers have the
4065 convention that the names of all global symbols (functions or data)
4066 they define are formed by prefixing an underscore to the name as it
4067 appears in the C program. So, for example, the function a C
4068 programmer thinks of as \c{printf} appears to an assembly language
4069 programmer as \c{_printf}. This means that in your assembly
4070 programs, you can define symbols without a leading underscore, and
4071 not have to worry about name clashes with C symbols.
4073 If you find the underscores inconvenient, you can define macros to
4074 replace the \c{GLOBAL} and \c{EXTERN} directives as follows:
4086 (These forms of the macros only take one argument at a time; a
4087 \c{%rep} construct could solve this.)
4089 If you then declare an external like this:
4093 then the macro will expand it as
4096 \c %define printf _printf
4098 Thereafter, you can reference \c{printf} as if it was a symbol, and
4099 the preprocessor will put the leading underscore on where necessary.
4101 The \c{cglobal} macro works similarly. You must use \c{cglobal}
4102 before defining the symbol in question, but you would have had to do
4103 that anyway if you used \c{GLOBAL}.
4105 \S{16cmodels} \i{Memory Models}
4107 NASM contains no mechanism to support the various C memory models
4108 directly; you have to keep track yourself of which one you are
4109 writing for. This means you have to keep track of the following
4112 \b In models using a single code segment (tiny, small and compact),
4113 functions are near. This means that function pointers, when stored
4114 in data segments or pushed on the stack as function arguments, are
4115 16 bits long and contain only an offset field (the \c{CS} register
4116 never changes its value, and always gives the segment part of the
4117 full function address), and that functions are called using ordinary
4118 near \c{CALL} instructions and return using \c{RETN} (which, in
4119 NASM, is synonymous with \c{RET} anyway). This means both that you
4120 should write your own routines to return with \c{RETN}, and that you
4121 should call external C routines with near \c{CALL} instructions.
4123 \b In models using more than one code segment (medium, large and
4124 huge), functions are far. This means that function pointers are 32
4125 bits long (consisting of a 16-bit offset followed by a 16-bit
4126 segment), and that functions are called using \c{CALL FAR} (or
4127 \c{CALL seg:offset}) and return using \c{RETF}. Again, you should
4128 therefore write your own routines to return with \c{RETF} and use
4129 \c{CALL FAR} to call external routines.
4131 \b In models using a single data segment (tiny, small and medium),
4132 data pointers are 16 bits long, containing only an offset field (the
4133 \c{DS} register doesn't change its value, and always gives the
4134 segment part of the full data item address).
4136 \b In models using more than one data segment (compact, large and
4137 huge), data pointers are 32 bits long, consisting of a 16-bit offset
4138 followed by a 16-bit segment. You should still be careful not to
4139 modify \c{DS} in your routines without restoring it afterwards, but
4140 \c{ES} is free for you to use to access the contents of 32-bit data
4141 pointers you are passed.
4143 \b The huge memory model allows single data items to exceed 64K in
4144 size. In all other memory models, you can access the whole of a data
4145 item just by doing arithmetic on the offset field of the pointer you
4146 are given, whether a segment field is present or not; in huge model,
4147 you have to be more careful of your pointer arithmetic.
4149 \b In most memory models, there is a \e{default} data segment, whose
4150 segment address is kept in \c{DS} throughout the program. This data
4151 segment is typically the same segment as the stack, kept in \c{SS},
4152 so that functions' local variables (which are stored on the stack)
4153 and global data items can both be accessed easily without changing
4154 \c{DS}. Particularly large data items are typically stored in other
4155 segments. However, some memory models (though not the standard
4156 ones, usually) allow the assumption that \c{SS} and \c{DS} hold the
4157 same value to be removed. Be careful about functions' local
4158 variables in this latter case.
4160 In models with a single code segment, the segment is called
4161 \i\c{_TEXT}, so your code segment must also go by this name in order
4162 to be linked into the same place as the main code segment. In models
4163 with a single data segment, or with a default data segment, it is
4166 \S{16cfunc} Function Definitions and Function Calls
4168 \I{functions, C calling convention}The \i{C calling convention} in
4169 16-bit programs is as follows. In the following description, the
4170 words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are used to denote the function
4171 doing the calling and the function which gets called.
4173 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
4174 after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the first
4175 argument specified to the function is pushed last).
4177 \b The caller then executes a \c{CALL} instruction to pass control
4178 to the callee. This \c{CALL} is either near or far depending on the
4181 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
4182 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
4183 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{SP} in \c{BP} so as to
4184 be able to use \c{BP} as a base pointer to find its parameters on
4185 the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so part
4186 of the calling convention states that \c{BP} must be preserved by
4187 any C function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up \c{BP} as
4188 a \i\e{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
4190 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{BP}.
4191 The word at \c{[BP]} holds the previous value of \c{BP} as it was
4192 pushed; the next word, at \c{[BP+2]}, holds the offset part of the
4193 return address, pushed implicitly by \c{CALL}. In a small-model
4194 (near) function, the parameters start after that, at \c{[BP+4]}; in
4195 a large-model (far) function, the segment part of the return address
4196 lives at \c{[BP+4]}, and the parameters begin at \c{[BP+6]}. The
4197 leftmost parameter of the function, since it was pushed last, is
4198 accessible at this offset from \c{BP}; the others follow, at
4199 successively greater offsets. Thus, in a function such as \c{printf}
4200 which takes a variable number of parameters, the pushing of the
4201 parameters in reverse order means that the function knows where to
4202 find its first parameter, which tells it the number and type of the
4205 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{SP} further, so as to
4206 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
4207 accessible at negative offsets from \c{BP}.
4209 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
4210 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{DX:AX} depending on the size
4211 of the value. Floating-point results are sometimes (depending on the
4212 compiler) returned in \c{ST0}.
4214 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{SP} from
4215 \c{BP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
4216 value of \c{BP}, and returns via \c{RETN} or \c{RETF} depending on
4219 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
4220 parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an immediate
4221 constant to \c{SP} to remove them (instead of executing a number of
4222 slow \c{POP} instructions). Thus, if a function is accidentally
4223 called with the wrong number of parameters due to a prototype
4224 mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a sensible state since
4225 the caller, which \e{knows} how many parameters it pushed, does the
4228 It is instructive to compare this calling convention with that for
4229 Pascal programs (described in \k{16bpfunc}). Pascal has a simpler
4230 convention, since no functions have variable numbers of parameters.
4231 Therefore the callee knows how many parameters it should have been
4232 passed, and is able to deallocate them from the stack itself by
4233 passing an immediate argument to the \c{RET} or \c{RETF}
4234 instruction, so the caller does not have to do it. Also, the
4235 parameters are pushed in left-to-right order, not right-to-left,
4236 which means that a compiler can give better guarantees about
4237 sequence points without performance suffering.
4239 Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way.
4240 The following example is for small model:
4245 \c sub sp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
4246 \c mov bx,[bp+4] ; first parameter to function
4248 \c mov sp,bp ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above
4252 For a large-model function, you would replace \c{RET} by \c{RETF},
4253 and look for the first parameter at \c{[BP+6]} instead of
4254 \c{[BP+4]}. Of course, if one of the parameters is a pointer, then
4255 the offsets of \e{subsequent} parameters will change depending on
4256 the memory model as well: far pointers take up four bytes on the
4257 stack when passed as a parameter, whereas near pointers take up two.
4259 At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
4260 assembly code, you would do something like this:
4263 \c ; and then, further down...
4264 \c push word [myint] ; one of my integer variables
4265 \c push word mystring ; pointer into my data segment
4267 \c add sp,byte 4 ; `byte' saves space
4268 \c ; then those data items...
4271 \c mystring db 'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0
4273 This piece of code is the small-model assembly equivalent of the C
4276 \c int myint = 1234;
4277 \c printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);
4279 In large model, the function-call code might look more like this. In
4280 this example, it is assumed that \c{DS} already holds the segment
4281 base of the segment \c{_DATA}. If not, you would have to initialise
4284 \c push word [myint]
4285 \c push word seg mystring ; Now push the segment, and...
4286 \c push word mystring ; ... offset of "mystring"
4290 The integer value still takes up one word on the stack, since large
4291 model does not affect the size of the \c{int} data type. The first
4292 argument (pushed last) to \c{printf}, however, is a data pointer,
4293 and therefore has to contain a segment and offset part. The segment
4294 should be stored second in memory, and therefore must be pushed
4295 first. (Of course, \c{PUSH DS} would have been a shorter instruction
4296 than \c{PUSH WORD SEG mystring}, if \c{DS} was set up as the above
4297 example assumed.) Then the actual call becomes a far call, since
4298 functions expect far calls in large model; and \c{SP} has to be
4299 increased by 6 rather than 4 afterwards to make up for the extra
4302 \S{16cdata} Accessing Data Items
4304 To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
4305 C can access, you need only declare the names as \c{GLOBAL} or
4306 \c{EXTERN}. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
4307 in \k{16cunder}.) Thus, a C variable declared as \c{int i} can be
4308 accessed from assembler as
4313 And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
4314 as \c{extern int j}, you do this (making sure you are assembling in
4315 the \c{_DATA} segment, if necessary):
4320 To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
4321 the array. For example, \c{int} variables are two bytes long, so if
4322 a C program declares an array as \c{int a[10]}, you can access
4323 \c{a[3]} by coding \c{mov ax,[_a+6]}. (The byte offset 6 is obtained
4324 by multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
4325 element, 2.) The sizes of the C base types in 16-bit compilers are:
4326 1 for \c{char}, 2 for \c{short} and \c{int}, 4 for \c{long} and
4327 \c{float}, and 8 for \c{double}.
4329 To access a C \i{data structure}, you need to know the offset from
4330 the base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You
4331 can either do this by converting the C structure definition into a
4332 NASM structure definition (using \i\c{STRUC}), or by calculating the
4333 one offset and using just that.
4335 To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
4336 find out how it organises data structures. NASM gives no special
4337 alignment to structure members in its own \c{STRUC} macro, so you
4338 have to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
4339 Typically, you might find that a structure like
4346 might be four bytes long rather than three, since the \c{int} field
4347 would be aligned to a two-byte boundary. However, this sort of
4348 feature tends to be a configurable option in the C compiler, either
4349 using command-line options or \c{#pragma} lines, so you have to find
4350 out how your own compiler does it.
4352 \S{16cmacro} \i\c{c16.mac}: Helper Macros for the 16-bit C Interface
4354 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc subdirectory}\c{misc}
4355 directory, is a file \c{c16.mac} of macros. It defines three macros:
4356 \i\c{proc}, \i\c{arg} and \i\c{endproc}. These are intended to be
4357 used for C-style procedure definitions, and they automate a lot of
4358 the work involved in keeping track of the calling convention.
4360 (An alternative, TASM compatible form of \c{arg} is also now built
4361 into NASM's preprocessor. See \k{tasmcompat} for details.)
4363 An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
4369 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
4370 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
4374 This defines \c{_nearproc} to be a procedure taking two arguments,
4375 the first (\c{i}) an integer and the second (\c{j}) a pointer to an
4376 integer. It returns \c{i + *j}.
4378 Note that the \c{arg} macro has an \c{EQU} as the first line of its
4379 expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
4380 to the first line of the expanded macro, the \c{EQU} works, defining
4381 \c{%$i} to be an offset from \c{BP}. A context-local variable is
4382 used, local to the context pushed by the \c{proc} macro and popped
4383 by the \c{endproc} macro, so that the same argument name can be used
4384 in later procedures. Of course, you don't \e{have} to do that.
4386 The macro set produces code for near functions (tiny, small and
4387 compact-model code) by default. You can have it generate far
4388 functions (medium, large and huge-model code) by means of coding
4389 \I\c{FARCODE}\c{%define FARCODE}. This changes the kind of return
4390 instruction generated by \c{endproc}, and also changes the starting
4391 point for the argument offsets. The macro set contains no intrinsic
4392 dependency on whether data pointers are far or not.
4394 \c{arg} can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
4395 argument. If no size is given, 2 is assumed, since it is likely that
4396 many function parameters will be of type \c{int}.
4398 The large-model equivalent of the above function would look like this:
4404 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
4405 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
4406 \c mov es,[bp + %$j + 2]
4410 This makes use of the argument to the \c{arg} macro to define a
4411 parameter of size 4, because \c{j} is now a far pointer. When we
4412 load from \c{j}, we must load a segment and an offset.
4414 \H{16bp} Interfacing to \i{Borland Pascal} Programs
4416 Interfacing to Borland Pascal programs is similar in concept to
4417 interfacing to 16-bit C programs. The differences are:
4419 \b The leading underscore required for interfacing to C programs is
4420 not required for Pascal.
4422 \b The memory model is always large: functions are far, data
4423 pointers are far, and no data item can be more than 64K long.
4424 (Actually, some functions are near, but only those functions that
4425 are local to a Pascal unit and never called from outside it. All
4426 assembly functions that Pascal calls, and all Pascal functions that
4427 assembly routines are able to call, are far.) However, all static
4428 data declared in a Pascal program goes into the default data
4429 segment, which is the one whose segment address will be in \c{DS}
4430 when control is passed to your assembly code. The only things that
4431 do not live in the default data segment are local variables (they
4432 live in the stack segment) and dynamically allocated variables. All
4433 data \e{pointers}, however, are far.
4435 \b The function calling convention is different - described below.
4437 \b Some data types, such as strings, are stored differently.
4439 \b There are restrictions on the segment names you are allowed to
4440 use - Borland Pascal will ignore code or data declared in a segment
4441 it doesn't like the name of. The restrictions are described below.
4443 \S{16bpfunc} The Pascal Calling Convention
4445 \I{functions, Pascal calling convention}\I{Pascal calling
4446 convention}The 16-bit Pascal calling convention is as follows. In
4447 the following description, the words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are
4448 used to denote the function doing the calling and the function which
4451 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
4452 after another, in normal order (left to right, so that the first
4453 argument specified to the function is pushed first).
4455 \b The caller then executes a far \c{CALL} instruction to pass
4456 control to the callee.
4458 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
4459 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
4460 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{SP} in \c{BP} so as to
4461 be able to use \c{BP} as a base pointer to find its parameters on
4462 the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so part
4463 of the calling convention states that \c{BP} must be preserved by
4464 any function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up \c{BP} as a
4465 \i{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
4467 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{BP}.
4468 The word at \c{[BP]} holds the previous value of \c{BP} as it was
4469 pushed. The next word, at \c{[BP+2]}, holds the offset part of the
4470 return address, and the next one at \c{[BP+4]} the segment part. The
4471 parameters begin at \c{[BP+6]}. The rightmost parameter of the
4472 function, since it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset
4473 from \c{BP}; the others follow, at successively greater offsets.
4475 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{SP} further, so as to
4476 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
4477 accessible at negative offsets from \c{BP}.
4479 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
4480 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{DX:AX} depending on the size
4481 of the value. Floating-point results are returned in \c{ST0}.
4482 Results of type \c{Real} (Borland's own custom floating-point data
4483 type, not handled directly by the FPU) are returned in \c{DX:BX:AX}.
4484 To return a result of type \c{String}, the caller pushes a pointer
4485 to a temporary string before pushing the parameters, and the callee
4486 places the returned string value at that location. The pointer is
4487 not a parameter, and should not be removed from the stack by the
4488 \c{RETF} instruction.
4490 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{SP} from
4491 \c{BP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
4492 value of \c{BP}, and returns via \c{RETF}. It uses the form of
4493 \c{RETF} with an immediate parameter, giving the number of bytes
4494 taken up by the parameters on the stack. This causes the parameters
4495 to be removed from the stack as a side effect of the return
4498 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
4499 parameters have already been removed from the stack, so it needs to
4502 Thus, you would define a function in Pascal style, taking two
4503 \c{Integer}-type parameters, in the following way:
4508 \c sub sp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
4509 \c mov bx,[bp+8] ; first parameter to function
4510 \c mov bx,[bp+6] ; second parameter to function
4512 \c mov sp,bp ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above
4514 \c retf 4 ; total size of params is 4
4516 At the other end of the process, to call a Pascal function from your
4517 assembly code, you would do something like this:
4520 \c ; and then, further down...
4521 \c push word seg mystring ; Now push the segment, and...
4522 \c push word mystring ; ... offset of "mystring"
4523 \c push word [myint] ; one of my variables
4524 \c call far SomeFunc
4526 This is equivalent to the Pascal code
4528 \c procedure SomeFunc(String: PChar; Int: Integer);
4529 \c SomeFunc(@mystring, myint);
4531 \S{16bpseg} Borland Pascal \I{segment names, Borland Pascal}Segment
4534 Since Borland Pascal's internal unit file format is completely
4535 different from \c{OBJ}, it only makes a very sketchy job of actually
4536 reading and understanding the various information contained in a
4537 real \c{OBJ} file when it links that in. Therefore an object file
4538 intended to be linked to a Pascal program must obey a number of
4541 \b Procedures and functions must be in a segment whose name is
4542 either \c{CODE}, \c{CSEG}, or something ending in \c{_TEXT}.
4544 \b Initialised data must be in a segment whose name is either
4545 \c{CONST} or something ending in \c{_DATA}.
4547 \b Uninitialised data must be in a segment whose name is either
4548 \c{DATA}, \c{DSEG}, or something ending in \c{_BSS}.
4550 \b Any other segments in the object file are completely ignored.
4551 \c{GROUP} directives and segment attributes are also ignored.
4553 \S{16bpmacro} Using \i\c{c16.mac} With Pascal Programs
4555 The \c{c16.mac} macro package, described in \k{16cmacro}, can also
4556 be used to simplify writing functions to be called from Pascal
4557 programs, if you code \I\c{PASCAL}\c{%define PASCAL}. This
4558 definition ensures that functions are far (it implies
4559 \i\c{FARCODE}), and also causes procedure return instructions to be
4560 generated with an operand.
4562 Defining \c{PASCAL} does not change the code which calculates the
4563 argument offsets; you must declare your function's arguments in
4564 reverse order. For example:
4570 \c mov ax,[bp + %$i]
4571 \c mov bx,[bp + %$j]
4572 \c mov es,[bp + %$j + 2]
4576 This defines the same routine, conceptually, as the example in
4577 \k{16cmacro}: it defines a function taking two arguments, an integer
4578 and a pointer to an integer, which returns the sum of the integer
4579 and the contents of the pointer. The only difference between this
4580 code and the large-model C version is that \c{PASCAL} is defined
4581 instead of \c{FARCODE}, and that the arguments are declared in
4584 \C{32bit} Writing 32-bit Code (Unix, Win32, DJGPP)
4586 This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues involved
4587 when writing 32-bit code, to run under \i{Win32} or Unix, or to be
4588 linked with C code generated by a Unix-style C compiler such as
4589 \i{DJGPP}. It covers how to write assembly code to interface with
4590 32-bit C routines, and how to write position-independent code for
4593 Almost all 32-bit code, and in particular all code running under
4594 Win32, DJGPP or any of the PC Unix variants, runs in \I{flat memory
4595 model}\e{flat} memory model. This means that the segment registers
4596 and paging have already been set up to give you the same 32-bit 4Gb
4597 address space no matter what segment you work relative to, and that
4598 you should ignore all segment registers completely. When writing
4599 flat-model application code, you never need to use a segment
4600 override or modify any segment register, and the code-section
4601 addresses you pass to \c{CALL} and \c{JMP} live in the same address
4602 space as the data-section addresses you access your variables by and
4603 the stack-section addresses you access local variables and procedure
4604 parameters by. Every address is 32 bits long and contains only an
4607 \H{32c} Interfacing to 32-bit C Programs
4609 A lot of the discussion in \k{16c}, about interfacing to 16-bit C
4610 programs, still applies when working in 32 bits. The absence of
4611 memory models or segmentation worries simplifies things a lot.
4613 \S{32cunder} External Symbol Names
4615 Most 32-bit C compilers share the convention used by 16-bit
4616 compilers, that the names of all global symbols (functions or data)
4617 they define are formed by prefixing an underscore to the name as it
4618 appears in the C program. However, not all of them do: the ELF
4619 specification states that C symbols do \e{not} have a leading
4620 underscore on their assembly-language names.
4622 The older Linux \c{a.out} C compiler, all Win32 compilers, DJGPP,
4623 and NetBSD and FreeBSD, all use the leading underscore; for these
4624 compilers, the macros \c{cextern} and \c{cglobal}, as given in
4625 \k{16cunder}, will still work. For ELF, though, the leading
4626 underscore should not be used.
4628 \S{32cfunc} Function Definitions and Function Calls
4630 \I{functions, C calling convention}The \i{C calling convention}The C
4631 calling convention in 32-bit programs is as follows. In the
4632 following description, the words \e{caller} and \e{callee} are used
4633 to denote the function doing the calling and the function which gets
4636 \b The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
4637 after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the first
4638 argument specified to the function is pushed last).
4640 \b The caller then executes a near \c{CALL} instruction to pass
4641 control to the callee.
4643 \b The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
4644 actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access their
4645 parameters) starts by saving the value of \c{ESP} in \c{EBP} so as
4646 to be able to use \c{EBP} as a base pointer to find its parameters
4647 on the stack. However, the caller was probably doing this too, so
4648 part of the calling convention states that \c{EBP} must be preserved
4649 by any C function. Hence the callee, if it is going to set up
4650 \c{EBP} as a \i{frame pointer}, must push the previous value first.
4652 \b The callee may then access its parameters relative to \c{EBP}.
4653 The doubleword at \c{[EBP]} holds the previous value of \c{EBP} as
4654 it was pushed; the next doubleword, at \c{[EBP+4]}, holds the return
4655 address, pushed implicitly by \c{CALL}. The parameters start after
4656 that, at \c{[EBP+8]}. The leftmost parameter of the function, since
4657 it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset from \c{EBP}; the
4658 others follow, at successively greater offsets. Thus, in a function
4659 such as \c{printf} which takes a variable number of parameters, the
4660 pushing of the parameters in reverse order means that the function
4661 knows where to find its first parameter, which tells it the number
4662 and type of the remaining ones.
4664 \b The callee may also wish to decrease \c{ESP} further, so as to
4665 allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then be
4666 accessible at negative offsets from \c{EBP}.
4668 \b The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
4669 leave the value in \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{EAX} depending on the size
4670 of the value. Floating-point results are typically returned in
4673 \b Once the callee has finished processing, it restores \c{ESP} from
4674 \c{EBP} if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the previous
4675 value of \c{EBP}, and returns via \c{RET} (equivalently, \c{RETN}).
4677 \b When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
4678 parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an immediate
4679 constant to \c{ESP} to remove them (instead of executing a number of
4680 slow \c{POP} instructions). Thus, if a function is accidentally
4681 called with the wrong number of parameters due to a prototype
4682 mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a sensible state since
4683 the caller, which \e{knows} how many parameters it pushed, does the
4686 There is an alternative calling convention used by Win32 programs
4687 for Windows API calls, and also for functions called \e{by} the
4688 Windows API such as window procedures: they follow what Microsoft
4689 calls the \c{__stdcall} convention. This is slightly closer to the
4690 Pascal convention, in that the callee clears the stack by passing a
4691 parameter to the \c{RET} instruction. However, the parameters are
4692 still pushed in right-to-left order.
4694 Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way:
4697 \c _myfunc: push ebp
4699 \c sub esp,0x40 ; 64 bytes of local stack space
4700 \c mov ebx,[ebp+8] ; first parameter to function
4702 \c leave ; mov esp,ebp / pop ebp
4705 At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
4706 assembly code, you would do something like this:
4709 \c ; and then, further down...
4710 \c push dword [myint] ; one of my integer variables
4711 \c push dword mystring ; pointer into my data segment
4713 \c add esp,byte 8 ; `byte' saves space
4714 \c ; then those data items...
4717 \c mystring db 'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0
4719 This piece of code is the assembly equivalent of the C code
4721 \c int myint = 1234;
4722 \c printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);
4724 \S{32cdata} Accessing Data Items
4726 To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
4727 C can access, you need only declare the names as \c{GLOBAL} or
4728 \c{EXTERN}. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
4729 in \k{32cunder}.) Thus, a C variable declared as \c{int i} can be
4730 accessed from assembler as
4735 And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
4736 as \c{extern int j}, you do this (making sure you are assembling in
4737 the \c{_DATA} segment, if necessary):
4742 To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
4743 the array. For example, \c{int} variables are four bytes long, so if
4744 a C program declares an array as \c{int a[10]}, you can access
4745 \c{a[3]} by coding \c{mov ax,[_a+12]}. (The byte offset 12 is obtained
4746 by multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
4747 element, 4.) The sizes of the C base types in 32-bit compilers are:
4748 1 for \c{char}, 2 for \c{short}, 4 for \c{int}, \c{long} and
4749 \c{float}, and 8 for \c{double}. Pointers, being 32-bit addresses,
4750 are also 4 bytes long.
4752 To access a C \i{data structure}, you need to know the offset from
4753 the base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You
4754 can either do this by converting the C structure definition into a
4755 NASM structure definition (using \c{STRUC}), or by calculating the
4756 one offset and using just that.
4758 To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
4759 find out how it organises data structures. NASM gives no special
4760 alignment to structure members in its own \i\c{STRUC} macro, so you
4761 have to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
4762 Typically, you might find that a structure like
4769 might be eight bytes long rather than five, since the \c{int} field
4770 would be aligned to a four-byte boundary. However, this sort of
4771 feature is sometimes a configurable option in the C compiler, either
4772 using command-line options or \c{#pragma} lines, so you have to find
4773 out how your own compiler does it.
4775 \S{32cmacro} \i\c{c32.mac}: Helper Macros for the 32-bit C Interface
4777 Included in the NASM archives, in the \I{misc directory}\c{misc}
4778 directory, is a file \c{c32.mac} of macros. It defines three macros:
4779 \i\c{proc}, \i\c{arg} and \i\c{endproc}. These are intended to be
4780 used for C-style procedure definitions, and they automate a lot of
4781 the work involved in keeping track of the calling convention.
4783 An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
4789 \c mov eax,[ebp + %$i]
4790 \c mov ebx,[ebp + %$j]
4794 This defines \c{_proc32} to be a procedure taking two arguments, the
4795 first (\c{i}) an integer and the second (\c{j}) a pointer to an
4796 integer. It returns \c{i + *j}.
4798 Note that the \c{arg} macro has an \c{EQU} as the first line of its
4799 expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
4800 to the first line of the expanded macro, the \c{EQU} works, defining
4801 \c{%$i} to be an offset from \c{BP}. A context-local variable is
4802 used, local to the context pushed by the \c{proc} macro and popped
4803 by the \c{endproc} macro, so that the same argument name can be used
4804 in later procedures. Of course, you don't \e{have} to do that.
4806 \c{arg} can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
4807 argument. If no size is given, 4 is assumed, since it is likely that
4808 many function parameters will be of type \c{int} or pointers.
4810 \H{picdll} Writing NetBSD/FreeBSD/OpenBSD and Linux/ELF \i{Shared
4813 ELF replaced the older \c{a.out} object file format under Linux
4814 because it contains support for \i{position-independent code}
4815 (\i{PIC}), which makes writing shared libraries much easier. NASM
4816 supports the ELF position-independent code features, so you can
4817 write Linux ELF shared libraries in NASM.
4819 \i{NetBSD}, and its close cousins \i{FreeBSD} and \i{OpenBSD}, take
4820 a different approach by hacking PIC support into the \c{a.out}
4821 format. NASM supports this as the \i\c{aoutb} output format, so you
4822 can write \i{BSD} shared libraries in NASM too.
4824 The operating system loads a PIC shared library by memory-mapping
4825 the library file at an arbitrarily chosen point in the address space
4826 of the running process. The contents of the library's code section
4827 must therefore not depend on where it is loaded in memory.
4829 Therefore, you cannot get at your variables by writing code like
4832 \c mov eax,[myvar] ; WRONG
4834 Instead, the linker provides an area of memory called the
4835 \i\e{global offset table}, or \i{GOT}; the GOT is situated at a
4836 constant distance from your library's code, so if you can find out
4837 where your library is loaded (which is typically done using a
4838 \c{CALL} and \c{POP} combination), you can obtain the address of the
4839 GOT, and you can then load the addresses of your variables out of
4840 linker-generated entries in the GOT.
4842 The \e{data} section of a PIC shared library does not have these
4843 restrictions: since the data section is writable, it has to be
4844 copied into memory anyway rather than just paged in from the library
4845 file, so as long as it's being copied it can be relocated too. So
4846 you can put ordinary types of relocation in the data section without
4847 too much worry (but see \k{picglobal} for a caveat).
4849 \S{picgot} Obtaining the Address of the GOT
4851 Each code module in your shared library should define the GOT as an
4854 \c extern _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ ; in ELF
4855 \c extern __GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ ; in BSD a.out
4857 At the beginning of any function in your shared library which plans
4858 to access your data or BSS sections, you must first calculate the
4859 address of the GOT. This is typically done by writing the function
4866 \c .get_GOT: pop ebx
4867 \c add ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-.get_GOT wrt ..gotpc
4868 \c ; the function body comes here
4874 (For BSD, again, the symbol \c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE} requires a
4875 second leading underscore.)
4877 The first two lines of this function are simply the standard C
4878 prologue to set up a stack frame, and the last three lines are
4879 standard C function epilogue. The third line, and the fourth to last
4880 line, save and restore the \c{EBX} register, because PIC shared
4881 libraries use this register to store the address of the GOT.
4883 The interesting bit is the \c{CALL} instruction and the following
4884 two lines. The \c{CALL} and \c{POP} combination obtains the address
4885 of the label \c{.get_GOT}, without having to know in advance where
4886 the program was loaded (since the \c{CALL} instruction is encoded
4887 relative to the current position). The \c{ADD} instruction makes use
4888 of one of the special PIC relocation types: \i{GOTPC relocation}.
4889 With the \i\c{WRT ..gotpc} qualifier specified, the symbol
4890 referenced (here \c{_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_}, the special symbol
4891 assigned to the GOT) is given as an offset from the beginning of the
4892 section. (Actually, ELF encodes it as the offset from the operand
4893 field of the \c{ADD} instruction, but NASM simplifies this
4894 deliberately, so you do things the same way for both ELF and BSD.)
4895 So the instruction then \e{adds} the beginning of the section, to
4896 get the real address of the GOT, and subtracts the value of
4897 \c{.get_GOT} which it knows is in \c{EBX}. Therefore, by the time
4898 that instruction has finished,
4899 \c{EBX} contains the address of the GOT.
4901 If you didn't follow that, don't worry: it's never necessary to
4902 obtain the address of the GOT by any other means, so you can put
4903 those three instructions into a macro and safely ignore them:
4907 \c %%getgot: pop ebx
4908 \c add ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-%%getgot wrt ..gotpc
4911 \S{piclocal} Finding Your Local Data Items
4913 Having got the GOT, you can then use it to obtain the addresses of
4914 your data items. Most variables will reside in the sections you have
4915 declared; they can be accessed using the \I{GOTOFF
4916 relocation}\c{..gotoff} special \I\c{WRT ..gotoff}\c{WRT} type. The
4917 way this works is like this:
4919 \c lea eax,[ebx+myvar wrt ..gotoff]
4921 The expression \c{myvar wrt ..gotoff} is calculated, when the shared
4922 library is linked, to be the offset to the local variable \c{myvar}
4923 from the beginning of the GOT. Therefore, adding it to \c{EBX} as
4924 above will place the real address of \c{myvar} in \c{EAX}.
4926 If you declare variables as \c{GLOBAL} without specifying a size for
4927 them, they are shared between code modules in the library, but do
4928 not get exported from the library to the program that loaded it.
4929 They will still be in your ordinary data and BSS sections, so you
4930 can access them in the same way as local variables, using the above
4931 \c{..gotoff} mechanism.
4933 Note that due to a peculiarity of the way BSD \c{a.out} format
4934 handles this relocation type, there must be at least one non-local
4935 symbol in the same section as the address you're trying to access.
4937 \S{picextern} Finding External and Common Data Items
4939 If your library needs to get at an external variable (external to
4940 the \e{library}, not just to one of the modules within it), you must
4941 use the \I{GOT relocations}\I\c{WRT ..got}\c{..got} type to get at
4942 it. The \c{..got} type, instead of giving you the offset from the
4943 GOT base to the variable, gives you the offset from the GOT base to
4944 a GOT \e{entry} containing the address of the variable. The linker
4945 will set up this GOT entry when it builds the library, and the
4946 dynamic linker will place the correct address in it at load time. So
4947 to obtain the address of an external variable \c{extvar} in \c{EAX},
4950 \c mov eax,[ebx+extvar wrt ..got]
4952 This loads the address of \c{extvar} out of an entry in the GOT. The
4953 linker, when it builds the shared library, collects together every
4954 relocation of type \c{..got}, and builds the GOT so as to ensure it
4955 has every necessary entry present.
4957 Common variables must also be accessed in this way.
4959 \S{picglobal} Exporting Symbols to the Library User
4961 If you want to export symbols to the user of the library, you have
4962 to declare whether they are functions or data, and if they are data,
4963 you have to give the size of the data item. This is because the
4964 dynamic linker has to build \I{PLT}\i{procedure linkage table}
4965 entries for any exported functions, and also moves exported data
4966 items away from the library's data section in which they were
4969 So to export a function to users of the library, you must use
4971 \c global func:function ; declare it as a function
4975 And to export a data item such as an array, you would have to code
4977 \c global array:data array.end-array ; give the size too
4981 Be careful: If you export a variable to the library user, by
4982 declaring it as \c{GLOBAL} and supplying a size, the variable will
4983 end up living in the data section of the main program, rather than
4984 in your library's data section, where you declared it. So you will
4985 have to access your own global variable with the \c{..got} mechanism
4986 rather than \c{..gotoff}, as if it were external (which,
4987 effectively, it has become).
4989 Equally, if you need to store the address of an exported global in
4990 one of your data sections, you can't do it by means of the standard
4993 \c dataptr: dd global_data_item ; WRONG
4995 NASM will interpret this code as an ordinary relocation, in which
4996 \c{global_data_item} is merely an offset from the beginning of the
4997 \c{.data} section (or whatever); so this reference will end up
4998 pointing at your data section instead of at the exported global
4999 which resides elsewhere.
5001 Instead of the above code, then, you must write
5003 \c dataptr: dd global_data_item wrt ..sym
5005 which makes use of the special \c{WRT} type \I\c{WRT ..sym}\c{..sym}
5006 to instruct NASM to search the symbol table for a particular symbol
5007 at that address, rather than just relocating by section base.
5009 Either method will work for functions: referring to one of your
5010 functions by means of
5012 \c funcptr: dd my_function
5014 will give the user the address of the code you wrote, whereas
5016 \c funcptr: dd my_function wrt ..sym
5018 will give the address of the procedure linkage table for the
5019 function, which is where the calling program will \e{believe} the
5020 function lives. Either address is a valid way to call the function.
5022 \S{picproc} Calling Procedures Outside the Library
5024 Calling procedures outside your shared library has to be done by
5025 means of a \i\e{procedure linkage table}, or \i{PLT}. The PLT is
5026 placed at a known offset from where the library is loaded, so the
5027 library code can make calls to the PLT in a position-independent
5028 way. Within the PLT there is code to jump to offsets contained in
5029 the GOT, so function calls to other shared libraries or to routines
5030 in the main program can be transparently passed off to their real
5033 To call an external routine, you must use another special PIC
5034 relocation type, \I{PLT relocations}\i\c{WRT ..plt}. This is much
5035 easier than the GOT-based ones: you simply replace calls such as
5036 \c{CALL printf} with the PLT-relative version \c{CALL printf WRT
5039 \S{link} Generating the Library File
5041 Having written some code modules and assembled them to \c{.o} files,
5042 you then generate your shared library with a command such as
5044 \c ld -shared -o library.so module1.o module2.o # for ELF
5045 \c ld -Bshareable -o library.so module1.o module2.o # for BSD
5047 For ELF, if your shared library is going to reside in system
5048 directories such as \c{/usr/lib} or \c{/lib}, it is usually worth
5049 using the \i\c{-soname} flag to the linker, to store the final
5050 library file name, with a version number, into the library:
5052 \c ld -shared -soname library.so.1 -o library.so.1.2 *.o
5054 You would then copy \c{library.so.1.2} into the library directory,
5055 and create \c{library.so.1} as a symbolic link to it.
5057 \C{mixsize} Mixing 16 and 32 Bit Code
5059 This chapter tries to cover some of the issues, largely related to
5060 unusual forms of addressing and jump instructions, encountered when
5061 writing operating system code such as protected-mode initialisation
5062 routines, which require code that operates in mixed segment sizes,
5063 such as code in a 16-bit segment trying to modify data in a 32-bit
5064 one, or jumps between different-size segments.
5066 \H{mixjump} Mixed-Size Jumps\I{jumps, mixed-size}
5068 \I{operating system, writing}\I{writing operating systems}The most
5069 common form of \i{mixed-size instruction} is the one used when
5070 writing a 32-bit OS: having done your setup in 16-bit mode, such as
5071 loading the kernel, you then have to boot it by switching into
5072 protected mode and jumping to the 32-bit kernel start address. In a
5073 fully 32-bit OS, this tends to be the \e{only} mixed-size
5074 instruction you need, since everything before it can be done in pure
5075 16-bit code, and everything after it can be pure 32-bit.
5077 This jump must specify a 48-bit far address, since the target
5078 segment is a 32-bit one. However, it must be assembled in a 16-bit
5079 segment, so just coding, for example,
5081 \c jmp 0x1234:0x56789ABC ; wrong!
5083 will not work, since the offset part of the address will be
5084 truncated to \c{0x9ABC} and the jump will be an ordinary 16-bit far
5087 The Linux kernel setup code gets round the inability of \c{as86} to
5088 generate the required instruction by coding it manually, using
5089 \c{DB} instructions. NASM can go one better than that, by actually
5090 generating the right instruction itself. Here's how to do it right:
5092 \c jmp dword 0x1234:0x56789ABC ; right
5094 \I\c{JMP DWORD}The \c{DWORD} prefix (strictly speaking, it should
5095 come \e{after} the colon, since it is declaring the \e{offset} field
5096 to be a doubleword; but NASM will accept either form, since both are
5097 unambiguous) forces the offset part to be treated as far, in the
5098 assumption that you are deliberately writing a jump from a 16-bit
5099 segment to a 32-bit one.
5101 You can do the reverse operation, jumping from a 32-bit segment to a
5102 16-bit one, by means of the \c{WORD} prefix:
5104 \c jmp word 0x8765:0x4321 ; 32 to 16 bit
5106 If the \c{WORD} prefix is specified in 16-bit mode, or the \c{DWORD}
5107 prefix in 32-bit mode, they will be ignored, since each is
5108 explicitly forcing NASM into a mode it was in anyway.
5110 \H{mixaddr} Addressing Between Different-Size Segments\I{addressing,
5111 mixed-size}\I{mixed-size addressing}
5113 If your OS is mixed 16 and 32-bit, or if you are writing a DOS
5114 extender, you are likely to have to deal with some 16-bit segments
5115 and some 32-bit ones. At some point, you will probably end up
5116 writing code in a 16-bit segment which has to access data in a
5117 32-bit segment, or vice versa.
5119 If the data you are trying to access in a 32-bit segment lies within
5120 the first 64K of the segment, you may be able to get away with using
5121 an ordinary 16-bit addressing operation for the purpose; but sooner
5122 or later, you will want to do 32-bit addressing from 16-bit mode.
5124 The easiest way to do this is to make sure you use a register for
5125 the address, since any effective address containing a 32-bit
5126 register is forced to be a 32-bit address. So you can do
5128 \c mov eax,offset_into_32_bit_segment_specified_by_fs
5129 \c mov dword [fs:eax],0x11223344
5131 This is fine, but slightly cumbersome (since it wastes an
5132 instruction and a register) if you already know the precise offset
5133 you are aiming at. The x86 architecture does allow 32-bit effective
5134 addresses to specify nothing but a 4-byte offset, so why shouldn't
5135 NASM be able to generate the best instruction for the purpose?
5137 It can. As in \k{mixjump}, you need only prefix the address with the
5138 \c{DWORD} keyword, and it will be forced to be a 32-bit address:
5140 \c mov dword [fs:dword my_offset],0x11223344
5142 Also as in \k{mixjump}, NASM is not fussy about whether the
5143 \c{DWORD} prefix comes before or after the segment override, so
5144 arguably a nicer-looking way to code the above instruction is
5146 \c mov dword [dword fs:my_offset],0x11223344
5148 Don't confuse the \c{DWORD} prefix \e{outside} the square brackets,
5149 which controls the size of the data stored at the address, with the
5150 one \c{inside} the square brackets which controls the length of the
5151 address itself. The two can quite easily be different:
5153 \c mov word [dword 0x12345678],0x9ABC
5155 This moves 16 bits of data to an address specified by a 32-bit
5158 You can also specify \c{WORD} or \c{DWORD} prefixes along with the
5159 \c{FAR} prefix to indirect far jumps or calls. For example:
5161 \c call dword far [fs:word 0x4321]
5163 This instruction contains an address specified by a 16-bit offset;
5164 it loads a 48-bit far pointer from that (16-bit segment and 32-bit
5165 offset), and calls that address.
5167 \H{mixother} Other Mixed-Size Instructions
5169 The other way you might want to access data might be using the
5170 string instructions (\c{LODSx}, \c{STOSx} and so on) or the
5171 \c{XLATB} instruction. These instructions, since they take no
5172 parameters, might seem to have no easy way to make them perform
5173 32-bit addressing when assembled in a 16-bit segment.
5175 This is the purpose of NASM's \i\c{a16} and \i\c{a32} prefixes. If
5176 you are coding \c{LODSB} in a 16-bit segment but it is supposed to
5177 be accessing a string in a 32-bit segment, you should load the
5178 desired address into \c{ESI} and then code
5182 The prefix forces the addressing size to 32 bits, meaning that
5183 \c{LODSB} loads from \c{[DS:ESI]} instead of \c{[DS:SI]}. To access
5184 a string in a 16-bit segment when coding in a 32-bit one, the
5185 corresponding \c{a16} prefix can be used.
5187 The \c{a16} and \c{a32} prefixes can be applied to any instruction
5188 in NASM's instruction table, but most of them can generate all the
5189 useful forms without them. The prefixes are necessary only for
5190 instructions with implicit addressing: \c{CMPSx} (\k{insCMPSB}),
5191 \c{SCASx} (\k{insSCASB}), \c{LODSx} (\k{insLODSB}), \c{STOSx}
5192 (\k{insSTOSB}), \c{MOVSx} (\k{insMOVSB}), \c{INSx} (\k{insINSB}),
5193 \c{OUTSx} (\k{insOUTSB}), and \c{XLATB} (\k{insXLATB}). Also, the
5194 various push and pop instructions (\c{PUSHA} and \c{POPF} as well as
5195 the more usual \c{PUSH} and \c{POP}) can accept \c{a16} or \c{a32}
5196 prefixes to force a particular one of \c{SP} or \c{ESP} to be used
5197 as a stack pointer, in case the stack segment in use is a different
5198 size from the code segment.
5200 \c{PUSH} and \c{POP}, when applied to segment registers in 32-bit
5201 mode, also have the slightly odd behaviour that they push and pop 4
5202 bytes at a time, of which the top two are ignored and the bottom two
5203 give the value of the segment register being manipulated. To force
5204 the 16-bit behaviour of segment-register push and pop instructions,
5205 you can use the operand-size prefix \i\c{o16}:
5210 This code saves a doubleword of stack space by fitting two segment
5211 registers into the space which would normally be consumed by pushing
5214 (You can also use the \i\c{o32} prefix to force the 32-bit behaviour
5215 when in 16-bit mode, but this seems less useful.)
5217 \C{trouble} Troubleshooting
5219 This chapter describes some of the common problems that users have
5220 been known to encounter with NASM, and answers them. It also gives
5221 instructions for reporting bugs in NASM if you find a difficulty
5222 that isn't listed here.
5224 \H{problems} Common Problems
5226 \S{inefficient} NASM Generates \i{Inefficient Code}
5228 I get a lot of `bug' reports about NASM generating inefficient, or
5229 even `wrong', code on instructions such as \c{ADD ESP,8}. This is a
5230 deliberate design feature, connected to predictability of output:
5231 NASM, on seeing \c{ADD ESP,8}, will generate the form of the
5232 instruction which leaves room for a 32-bit offset. You need to code
5233 \I\c{BYTE}\c{ADD ESP,BYTE 8} if you want the space-efficient
5234 form of the instruction. This isn't a bug: at worst it's a
5235 misfeature, and that's a matter of opinion only.
5237 \S{jmprange} My Jumps are Out of Range\I{out of range, jumps}
5239 Similarly, people complain that when they issue \i{conditional
5240 jumps} (which are \c{SHORT} by default) that try to jump too far,
5241 NASM reports `short jump out of range' instead of making the jumps
5244 This, again, is partly a predictability issue, but in fact has a
5245 more practical reason as well. NASM has no means of being told what
5246 type of processor the code it is generating will be run on; so it
5247 cannot decide for itself that it should generate \i\c{Jcc NEAR} type
5248 instructions, because it doesn't know that it's working for a 386 or
5249 above. Alternatively, it could replace the out-of-range short
5250 \c{JNE} instruction with a very short \c{JE} instruction that jumps
5251 over a \c{JMP NEAR}; this is a sensible solution for processors
5252 below a 386, but hardly efficient on processors which have good
5253 branch prediction \e{and} could have used \c{JNE NEAR} instead. So,
5254 once again, it's up to the user, not the assembler, to decide what
5255 instructions should be generated.
5257 \S{proborg} \i\c{ORG} Doesn't Work
5259 People writing \i{boot sector} programs in the \c{bin} format often
5260 complain that \c{ORG} doesn't work the way they'd like: in order to
5261 place the \c{0xAA55} signature word at the end of a 512-byte boot
5262 sector, people who are used to MASM tend to code
5265 \c ; some boot sector code
5269 This is not the intended use of the \c{ORG} directive in NASM, and
5270 will not work. The correct way to solve this problem in NASM is to
5271 use the \i\c{TIMES} directive, like this:
5274 \c ; some boot sector code
5275 \c TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0
5278 The \c{TIMES} directive will insert exactly enough zero bytes into
5279 the output to move the assembly point up to 510. This method also
5280 has the advantage that if you accidentally fill your boot sector too
5281 full, NASM will catch the problem at assembly time and report it, so
5282 you won't end up with a boot sector that you have to disassemble to
5283 find out what's wrong with it.
5285 \S{probtimes} \i\c{TIMES} Doesn't Work
5287 The other common problem with the above code is people who write the
5292 by reasoning that \c{$} should be a pure number, just like 510, so
5293 the difference between them is also a pure number and can happily be
5296 NASM is a \e{modular} assembler: the various component parts are
5297 designed to be easily separable for re-use, so they don't exchange
5298 information unnecessarily. In consequence, the \c{bin} output
5299 format, even though it has been told by the \c{ORG} directive that
5300 the \c{.text} section should start at 0, does not pass that
5301 information back to the expression evaluator. So from the
5302 evaluator's point of view, \c{$} isn't a pure number: it's an offset
5303 from a section base. Therefore the difference between \c{$} and 510
5304 is also not a pure number, but involves a section base. Values
5305 involving section bases cannot be passed as arguments to \c{TIMES}.
5307 The solution, as in the previous section, is to code the \c{TIMES}
5310 \c TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0
5312 in which \c{$} and \c{$$} are offsets from the same section base,
5313 and so their difference is a pure number. This will solve the
5314 problem and generate sensible code.
5316 \H{bugs} \i{Bugs}\I{reporting bugs}
5318 We have never yet released a version of NASM with any \e{known}
5319 bugs. That doesn't usually stop there being plenty we didn't know
5320 about, though. Any that you find should be reported to
5321 \W{mailto:hpa@zytor.com}\c{hpa@zytor.com}.
5323 Please read \k{qstart} first, and don't report the bug if it's
5324 listed in there as a deliberate feature. (If you think the feature
5325 is badly thought out, feel free to send us reasons why you think it
5326 should be changed, but don't just send us mail saying `This is a
5327 bug' if the documentation says we did it on purpose.) Then read
5328 \k{problems}, and don't bother reporting the bug if it's listed
5331 If you do report a bug, \e{please} give us all of the following
5334 \b What operating system you're running NASM under. DOS, Linux,
5335 NetBSD, Win16, Win32, VMS (I'd be impressed), whatever.
5337 \b If you're running NASM under DOS or Win32, tell us whether you've
5338 compiled your own executable from the DOS source archive, or whether
5339 you were using the standard distribution binaries out of the
5340 archive. If you were using a locally built executable, try to
5341 reproduce the problem using one of the standard binaries, as this
5342 will make it easier for us to reproduce your problem prior to fixing
5345 \b Which version of NASM you're using, and exactly how you invoked
5346 it. Give us the precise command line, and the contents of the
5347 \c{NASM} environment variable if any.
5349 \b Which versions of any supplementary programs you're using, and
5350 how you invoked them. If the problem only becomes visible at link
5351 time, tell us what linker you're using, what version of it you've
5352 got, and the exact linker command line. If the problem involves
5353 linking against object files generated by a compiler, tell us what
5354 compiler, what version, and what command line or options you used.
5355 (If you're compiling in an IDE, please try to reproduce the problem
5356 with the command-line version of the compiler.)
5358 \b If at all possible, send us a NASM source file which exhibits the
5359 problem. If this causes copyright problems (e.g. you can only
5360 reproduce the bug in restricted-distribution code) then bear in mind
5361 the following two points: firstly, we guarantee that any source code
5362 sent to us for the purposes of debugging NASM will be used \e{only}
5363 for the purposes of debugging NASM, and that we will delete all our
5364 copies of it as soon as we have found and fixed the bug or bugs in
5365 question; and secondly, we would prefer \e{not} to be mailed large
5366 chunks of code anyway. The smaller the file, the better. A
5367 three-line sample file that does nothing useful \e{except}
5368 demonstrate the problem is much easier to work with than a
5369 fully fledged ten-thousand-line program. (Of course, some errors
5370 \e{do} only crop up in large files, so this may not be possible.)
5372 \b A description of what the problem actually \e{is}. `It doesn't
5373 work' is \e{not} a helpful description! Please describe exactly what
5374 is happening that shouldn't be, or what isn't happening that should.
5375 Examples might be: `NASM generates an error message saying Line 3
5376 for an error that's actually on Line 5'; `NASM generates an error
5377 message that I believe it shouldn't be generating at all'; `NASM
5378 fails to generate an error message that I believe it \e{should} be
5379 generating'; `the object file produced from this source code crashes
5380 my linker'; `the ninth byte of the output file is 66 and I think it
5381 should be 77 instead'.
5383 \b If you believe the output file from NASM to be faulty, send it to
5384 us. That allows us to determine whether our own copy of NASM
5385 generates the same file, or whether the problem is related to
5386 portability issues between our development platforms and yours. We
5387 can handle binary files mailed to us as MIME attachments, uuencoded,
5388 and even BinHex. Alternatively, we may be able to provide an FTP
5389 site you can upload the suspect files to; but mailing them is easier
5392 \b Any other information or data files that might be helpful. If,
5393 for example, the problem involves NASM failing to generate an object
5394 file while TASM can generate an equivalent file without trouble,
5395 then send us \e{both} object files, so we can see what TASM is doing
5396 differently from us.
5398 \A{iref} Intel x86 Instruction Reference
5400 This appendix provides a complete list of the machine instructions
5401 which NASM will assemble, and a short description of the function of
5404 It is not intended to be exhaustive documentation on the fine
5405 details of the instructions' function, such as which exceptions they
5406 can trigger: for such documentation, you should go to Intel's Web
5407 site, \W{http://www.intel.com/}\c{http://www.intel.com/}.
5409 Instead, this appendix is intended primarily to provide
5410 documentation on the way the instructions may be used within NASM.
5411 For example, looking up \c{LOOP} will tell you that NASM allows
5412 \c{CX} or \c{ECX} to be specified as an optional second argument to
5413 the \c{LOOP} instruction, to enforce which of the two possible
5414 counter registers should be used if the default is not the one
5417 The instructions are not quite listed in alphabetical order, since
5418 groups of instructions with similar functions are lumped together in
5419 the same entry. Most of them don't move very far from their
5420 alphabetic position because of this.
5422 \H{iref-opr} Key to Operand Specifications
5424 The instruction descriptions in this appendix specify their operands
5425 using the following notation:
5427 \b Registers: \c{reg8} denotes an 8-bit \i{general purpose
5428 register}, \c{reg16} denotes a 16-bit general purpose register, and
5429 \c{reg32} a 32-bit one. \c{fpureg} denotes one of the eight FPU
5430 stack registers, \c{mmxreg} denotes one of the eight 64-bit MMX
5431 registers, and \c{segreg} denotes a segment register. In addition,
5432 some registers (such as \c{AL}, \c{DX} or
5433 \c{ECX}) may be specified explicitly.
5435 \b Immediate operands: \c{imm} denotes a generic \i{immediate operand}.
5436 \c{imm8}, \c{imm16} and \c{imm32} are used when the operand is
5437 intended to be a specific size. For some of these instructions, NASM
5438 needs an explicit specifier: for example, \c{ADD ESP,16} could be
5439 interpreted as either \c{ADD r/m32,imm32} or \c{ADD r/m32,imm8}.
5440 NASM chooses the former by default, and so you must specify \c{ADD
5441 ESP,BYTE 16} for the latter.
5443 \b Memory references: \c{mem} denotes a generic \i{memory reference};
5444 \c{mem8}, \c{mem16}, \c{mem32}, \c{mem64} and \c{mem80} are used
5445 when the operand needs to be a specific size. Again, a specifier is
5446 needed in some cases: \c{DEC [address]} is ambiguous and will be
5447 rejected by NASM. You must specify \c{DEC BYTE [address]}, \c{DEC
5448 WORD [address]} or \c{DEC DWORD [address]} instead.
5450 \b \i{Restricted memory references}: one form of the \c{MOV}
5451 instruction allows a memory address to be specified \e{without}
5452 allowing the normal range of register combinations and effective
5453 address processing. This is denoted by \c{memoffs8}, \c{memoffs16}
5456 \b Register or memory choices: many instructions can accept either a
5457 register \e{or} a memory reference as an operand. \c{r/m8} is a
5458 shorthand for \c{reg8/mem8}; similarly \c{r/m16} and \c{r/m32}.
5459 \c{r/m64} is MMX-related, and is a shorthand for \c{mmxreg/mem64}.
5461 \H{iref-opc} Key to Opcode Descriptions
5463 This appendix also provides the opcodes which NASM will generate for
5464 each form of each instruction. The opcodes are listed in the
5467 \b A hex number, such as \c{3F}, indicates a fixed byte containing
5470 \b A hex number followed by \c{+r}, such as \c{C8+r}, indicates that
5471 one of the operands to the instruction is a register, and the
5472 `register value' of that register should be added to the hex number
5473 to produce the generated byte. For example, EDX has register value
5474 2, so the code \c{C8+r}, when the register operand is EDX, generates
5475 the hex byte \c{CA}. Register values for specific registers are
5476 given in \k{iref-rv}.
5478 \b A hex number followed by \c{+cc}, such as \c{40+cc}, indicates
5479 that the instruction name has a condition code suffix, and the
5480 numeric representation of the condition code should be added to the
5481 hex number to produce the generated byte. For example, the code
5482 \c{40+cc}, when the instruction contains the \c{NE} condition,
5483 generates the hex byte \c{45}. Condition codes and their numeric
5484 representations are given in \k{iref-cc}.
5486 \b A slash followed by a digit, such as \c{/2}, indicates that one
5487 of the operands to the instruction is a memory address or register
5488 (denoted \c{mem} or \c{r/m}, with an optional size). This is to be
5489 encoded as an effective address, with a \i{ModR/M byte}, an optional
5490 \i{SIB byte}, and an optional displacement, and the spare (register)
5491 field of the ModR/M byte should be the digit given (which will be
5492 from 0 to 7, so it fits in three bits). The encoding of effective
5493 addresses is given in \k{iref-ea}.
5495 \b The code \c{/r} combines the above two: it indicates that one of
5496 the operands is a memory address or \c{r/m}, and another is a
5497 register, and that an effective address should be generated with the
5498 spare (register) field in the ModR/M byte being equal to the
5499 `register value' of the register operand. The encoding of effective
5500 addresses is given in \k{iref-ea}; register values are given in
5503 \b The codes \c{ib}, \c{iw} and \c{id} indicate that one of the
5504 operands to the instruction is an immediate value, and that this is
5505 to be encoded as a byte, little-endian word or little-endian
5506 doubleword respectively.
5508 \b The codes \c{rb}, \c{rw} and \c{rd} indicate that one of the
5509 operands to the instruction is an immediate value, and that the
5510 \e{difference} between this value and the address of the end of the
5511 instruction is to be encoded as a byte, word or doubleword
5512 respectively. Where the form \c{rw/rd} appears, it indicates that
5513 either \c{rw} or \c{rd} should be used according to whether assembly
5514 is being performed in \c{BITS 16} or \c{BITS 32} state respectively.
5516 \b The codes \c{ow} and \c{od} indicate that one of the operands to
5517 the instruction is a reference to the contents of a memory address
5518 specified as an immediate value: this encoding is used in some forms
5519 of the \c{MOV} instruction in place of the standard
5520 effective-address mechanism. The displacement is encoded as a word
5521 or doubleword. Again, \c{ow/od} denotes that \c{ow} or \c{od} should
5522 be chosen according to the \c{BITS} setting.
5524 \b The codes \c{o16} and \c{o32} indicate that the given form of the
5525 instruction should be assembled with operand size 16 or 32 bits. In
5526 other words, \c{o16} indicates a \c{66} prefix in \c{BITS 32} state,
5527 but generates no code in \c{BITS 16} state; and \c{o32} indicates a
5528 \c{66} prefix in \c{BITS 16} state but generates nothing in \c{BITS
5531 \b The codes \c{a16} and \c{a32}, similarly to \c{o16} and \c{o32},
5532 indicate the address size of the given form of the instruction.
5533 Where this does not match the \c{BITS} setting, a \c{67} prefix is
5536 \S{iref-rv} Register Values
5538 Where an instruction requires a register value, it is already
5539 implicit in the encoding of the rest of the instruction what type of
5540 register is intended: an 8-bit general-purpose register, a segment
5541 register, a debug register, an MMX register, or whatever. Therefore
5542 there is no problem with registers of different types sharing an
5545 The encodings for the various classes of register are:
5547 \b 8-bit general registers: \c{AL} is 0, \c{CL} is 1, \c{DL} is 2,
5548 \c{BL} is 3, \c{AH} is 4, \c{CH} is 5, \c{DH} is 6, and \c{BH} is
5551 \b 16-bit general registers: \c{AX} is 0, \c{CX} is 1, \c{DX} is 2,
5552 \c{BX} is 3, \c{SP} is 4, \c{BP} is 5, \c{SI} is 6, and \c{DI} is 7.
5554 \b 32-bit general registers: \c{EAX} is 0, \c{ECX} is 1, \c{EDX} is
5555 2, \c{EBX} is 3, \c{ESP} is 4, \c{EBP} is 5, \c{ESI} is 6, and
5558 \b \i{Segment registers}: \c{ES} is 0, \c{CS} is 1, \c{SS} is 2, \c{DS}
5559 is 3, \c{FS} is 4, and \c{GS} is 5.
5561 \b \I{floating-point, registers}Floating-point registers: \c{ST0}
5562 is 0, \c{ST1} is 1, \c{ST2} is 2, \c{ST3} is 3, \c{ST4} is 4,
5563 \c{ST5} is 5, \c{ST6} is 6, and \c{ST7} is 7.
5565 \b 64-bit \i{MMX registers}: \c{MM0} is 0, \c{MM1} is 1, \c{MM2} is 2,
5566 \c{MM3} is 3, \c{MM4} is 4, \c{MM5} is 5, \c{MM6} is 6, and \c{MM7}
5569 \b \i{Control registers}: \c{CR0} is 0, \c{CR2} is 2, \c{CR3} is 3,
5572 \b \i{Debug registers}: \c{DR0} is 0, \c{DR1} is 1, \c{DR2} is 2,
5573 \c{DR3} is 3, \c{DR6} is 6, and \c{DR7} is 7.
5575 \b \i{Test registers}: \c{TR3} is 3, \c{TR4} is 4, \c{TR5} is 5,
5576 \c{TR6} is 6, and \c{TR7} is 7.
5578 (Note that wherever a register name contains a number, that number
5579 is also the register value for that register.)
5581 \S{iref-cc} \i{Condition Codes}
5583 The available condition codes are given here, along with their
5584 numeric representations as part of opcodes. Many of these condition
5585 codes have synonyms, so several will be listed at a time.
5587 In the following descriptions, the word `either', when applied to two
5588 possible trigger conditions, is used to mean `either or both'. If
5589 `either but not both' is meant, the phrase `exactly one of' is used.
5591 \b \c{O} is 0 (trigger if the overflow flag is set); \c{NO} is 1.
5593 \b \c{B}, \c{C} and \c{NAE} are 2 (trigger if the carry flag is
5594 set); \c{AE}, \c{NB} and \c{NC} are 3.
5596 \b \c{E} and \c{Z} are 4 (trigger if the zero flag is set); \c{NE}
5599 \b \c{BE} and \c{NA} are 6 (trigger if either of the carry or zero
5600 flags is set); \c{A} and \c{NBE} are 7.
5602 \b \c{S} is 8 (trigger if the sign flag is set); \c{NS} is 9.
5604 \b \c{P} and \c{PE} are 10 (trigger if the parity flag is set);
5605 \c{NP} and \c{PO} are 11.
5607 \b \c{L} and \c{NGE} are 12 (trigger if exactly one of the sign and
5608 overflow flags is set); \c{GE} and \c{NL} are 13.
5610 \b \c{LE} and \c{NG} are 14 (trigger if either the zero flag is set,
5611 or exactly one of the sign and overflow flags is set); \c{G} and
5614 Note that in all cases, the sense of a condition code may be
5615 reversed by changing the low bit of the numeric representation.
5617 \S{iref-ea} Effective Address Encoding: \i{ModR/M} and \i{SIB}
5619 An \i{effective address} is encoded in up to three parts: a ModR/M
5620 byte, an optional SIB byte, and an optional byte, word or doubleword
5623 The ModR/M byte consists of three fields: the \c{mod} field, ranging
5624 from 0 to 3, in the upper two bits of the byte, the \c{r/m} field,
5625 ranging from 0 to 7, in the lower three bits, and the spare
5626 (register) field in the middle (bit 3 to bit 5). The spare field is
5627 not relevant to the effective address being encoded, and either
5628 contains an extension to the instruction opcode or the register
5629 value of another operand.
5631 The ModR/M system can be used to encode a direct register reference
5632 rather than a memory access. This is always done by setting the
5633 \c{mod} field to 3 and the \c{r/m} field to the register value of
5634 the register in question (it must be a general-purpose register, and
5635 the size of the register must already be implicit in the encoding of
5636 the rest of the instruction). In this case, the SIB byte and
5637 displacement field are both absent.
5639 In 16-bit addressing mode (either \c{BITS 16} with no \c{67} prefix,
5640 or \c{BITS 32} with a \c{67} prefix), the SIB byte is never used.
5641 The general rules for \c{mod} and \c{r/m} (there is an exception,
5644 \b The \c{mod} field gives the length of the displacement field: 0
5645 means no displacement, 1 means one byte, and 2 means two bytes.
5647 \b The \c{r/m} field encodes the combination of registers to be
5648 added to the displacement to give the accessed address: 0 means
5649 \c{BX+SI}, 1 means \c{BX+DI}, 2 means \c{BP+SI}, 3 means \c{BP+DI},
5650 4 means \c{SI} only, 5 means \c{DI} only, 6 means \c{BP} only, and 7
5653 However, there is a special case:
5655 \b If \c{mod} is 0 and \c{r/m} is 6, the effective address encoded
5656 is not \c{[BP]} as the above rules would suggest, but instead
5657 \c{[disp16]}: the displacement field is present and is two bytes
5658 long, and no registers are added to the displacement.
5660 Therefore the effective address \c{[BP]} cannot be encoded as
5661 efficiently as \c{[BX]}; so if you code \c{[BP]} in a program, NASM
5662 adds a notional 8-bit zero displacement, and sets \c{mod} to 1,
5663 \c{r/m} to 6, and the one-byte displacement field to 0.
5665 In 32-bit addressing mode (either \c{BITS 16} with a \c{67} prefix,
5666 or \c{BITS 32} with no \c{67} prefix) the general rules (again,
5667 there are exceptions) for \c{mod} and \c{r/m} are:
5669 \b The \c{mod} field gives the length of the displacement field: 0
5670 means no displacement, 1 means one byte, and 2 means four bytes.
5672 \b If only one register is to be added to the displacement, and it
5673 is not \c{ESP}, the \c{r/m} field gives its register value, and the
5674 SIB byte is absent. If the \c{r/m} field is 4 (which would encode
5675 \c{ESP}), the SIB byte is present and gives the combination and
5676 scaling of registers to be added to the displacement.
5678 If the SIB byte is present, it describes the combination of
5679 registers (an optional base register, and an optional index register
5680 scaled by multiplication by 1, 2, 4 or 8) to be added to the
5681 displacement. The SIB byte is divided into the \c{scale} field, in
5682 the top two bits, the \c{index} field in the next three, and the
5683 \c{base} field in the bottom three. The general rules are:
5685 \b The \c{base} field encodes the register value of the base
5688 \b The \c{index} field encodes the register value of the index
5689 register, unless it is 4, in which case no index register is used
5690 (so \c{ESP} cannot be used as an index register).
5692 \b The \c{scale} field encodes the multiplier by which the index
5693 register is scaled before adding it to the base and displacement: 0
5694 encodes a multiplier of 1, 1 encodes 2, 2 encodes 4 and 3 encodes 8.
5696 The exceptions to the 32-bit encoding rules are:
5698 \b If \c{mod} is 0 and \c{r/m} is 5, the effective address encoded
5699 is not \c{[EBP]} as the above rules would suggest, but instead
5700 \c{[disp32]}: the displacement field is present and is four bytes
5701 long, and no registers are added to the displacement.
5703 \b If \c{mod} is 0, \c{r/m} is 4 (meaning the SIB byte is present)
5704 and \c{base} is 4, the effective address encoded is not
5705 \c{[EBP+index]} as the above rules would suggest, but instead
5706 \c{[disp32+index]}: the displacement field is present and is four
5707 bytes long, and there is no base register (but the index register is
5708 still processed in the normal way).
5710 \H{iref-flg} Key to Instruction Flags
5712 Given along with each instruction in this appendix is a set of
5713 flags, denoting the type of the instruction. The types are as follows:
5715 \b \c{8086}, \c{186}, \c{286}, \c{386}, \c{486}, \c{PENT} and \c{P6}
5716 denote the lowest processor type that supports the instruction. Most
5717 instructions run on all processors above the given type; those that
5718 do not are documented. The Pentium II contains no additional
5719 instructions beyond the P6 (Pentium Pro); from the point of view of
5720 its instruction set, it can be thought of as a P6 with MMX
5723 \b \c{CYRIX} indicates that the instruction is specific to Cyrix
5724 processors, for example the extra MMX instructions in the Cyrix
5725 extended MMX instruction set.
5727 \b \c{FPU} indicates that the instruction is a floating-point one,
5728 and will only run on machines with a coprocessor (automatically
5729 including 486DX, Pentium and above).
5731 \b \c{MMX} indicates that the instruction is an MMX one, and will
5732 run on MMX-capable Pentium processors and the Pentium II.
5734 \b \c{PRIV} indicates that the instruction is a protected-mode
5735 management instruction. Many of these may only be used in protected
5736 mode, or only at privilege level zero.
5738 \b \c{UNDOC} indicates that the instruction is an undocumented one,
5739 and not part of the official Intel Architecture; it may or may not
5740 be supported on any given machine.
5742 \H{insAAA} \i\c{AAA}, \i\c{AAS}, \i\c{AAM}, \i\c{AAD}: ASCII
5749 \c AAD ; D5 0A [8086]
5750 \c AAD imm ; D5 ib [8086]
5752 \c AAM ; D4 0A [8086]
5753 \c AAM imm ; D4 ib [8086]
5755 These instructions are used in conjunction with the add, subtract,
5756 multiply and divide instructions to perform binary-coded decimal
5757 arithmetic in \e{unpacked} (one BCD digit per byte - easy to
5758 translate to and from ASCII, hence the instruction names) form.
5759 There are also packed BCD instructions \c{DAA} and \c{DAS}: see
5762 \c{AAA} should be used after a one-byte \c{ADD} instruction whose
5763 destination was the \c{AL} register: by means of examining the value
5764 in the low nibble of \c{AL} and also the auxiliary carry flag
5765 \c{AF}, it determines whether the addition has overflowed, and
5766 adjusts it (and sets the carry flag) if so. You can add long BCD
5767 strings together by doing \c{ADD}/\c{AAA} on the low digits, then
5768 doing \c{ADC}/\c{AAA} on each subsequent digit.
5770 \c{AAS} works similarly to \c{AAA}, but is for use after \c{SUB}
5771 instructions rather than \c{ADD}.
5773 \c{AAM} is for use after you have multiplied two decimal digits
5774 together and left the result in \c{AL}: it divides \c{AL} by ten and
5775 stores the quotient in \c{AH}, leaving the remainder in \c{AL}. The
5776 divisor 10 can be changed by specifying an operand to the
5777 instruction: a particularly handy use of this is \c{AAM 16}, causing
5778 the two nibbles in \c{AL} to be separated into \c{AH} and \c{AL}.
5780 \c{AAD} performs the inverse operation to \c{AAM}: it multiplies
5781 \c{AH} by ten, adds it to \c{AL}, and sets \c{AH} to zero. Again,
5782 the multiplier 10 can be changed.
5784 \H{insADC} \i\c{ADC}: Add with Carry
5786 \c ADC r/m8,reg8 ; 10 /r [8086]
5787 \c ADC r/m16,reg16 ; o16 11 /r [8086]
5788 \c ADC r/m32,reg32 ; o32 11 /r [386]
5790 \c ADC reg8,r/m8 ; 12 /r [8086]
5791 \c ADC reg16,r/m16 ; o16 13 /r [8086]
5792 \c ADC reg32,r/m32 ; o32 13 /r [386]
5794 \c ADC r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /2 ib [8086]
5795 \c ADC r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /2 iw [8086]
5796 \c ADC r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /2 id [386]
5798 \c ADC r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /2 ib [8086]
5799 \c ADC r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /2 ib [386]
5801 \c ADC AL,imm8 ; 14 ib [8086]
5802 \c ADC AX,imm16 ; o16 15 iw [8086]
5803 \c ADC EAX,imm32 ; o32 15 id [386]
5805 \c{ADC} performs integer addition: it adds its two operands
5806 together, plus the value of the carry flag, and leaves the result in
5807 its destination (first) operand. The flags are set according to the
5808 result of the operation: in particular, the carry flag is affected
5809 and can be used by a subsequent \c{ADC} instruction.
5811 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
5812 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
5813 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
5814 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
5815 form of the instruction.
5817 To add two numbers without also adding the contents of the carry
5818 flag, use \c{ADD} (\k{insADD}).
5820 \H{insADD} \i\c{ADD}: Add Integers
5822 \c ADD r/m8,reg8 ; 00 /r [8086]
5823 \c ADD r/m16,reg16 ; o16 01 /r [8086]
5824 \c ADD r/m32,reg32 ; o32 01 /r [386]
5826 \c ADD reg8,r/m8 ; 02 /r [8086]
5827 \c ADD reg16,r/m16 ; o16 03 /r [8086]
5828 \c ADD reg32,r/m32 ; o32 03 /r [386]
5830 \c ADD r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /0 ib [8086]
5831 \c ADD r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /0 iw [8086]
5832 \c ADD r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /0 id [386]
5834 \c ADD r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /0 ib [8086]
5835 \c ADD r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /0 ib [386]
5837 \c ADD AL,imm8 ; 04 ib [8086]
5838 \c ADD AX,imm16 ; o16 05 iw [8086]
5839 \c ADD EAX,imm32 ; o32 05 id [386]
5841 \c{ADD} performs integer addition: it adds its two operands
5842 together, and leaves the result in its destination (first) operand.
5843 The flags are set according to the result of the operation: in
5844 particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used by a
5845 subsequent \c{ADC} instruction (\k{insADC}).
5847 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
5848 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
5849 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
5850 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
5851 form of the instruction.
5853 \H{insADDPS} \i\c{ADDPS}: Packed Single FP ADD
5855 \c ADDPS xmmreg,mem128 ; 0f 58 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
5856 \c ADDPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; 0f 58 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
5858 \c{ADDPS} performs addition on each of four packed SP FP
5859 number items dst(0-31):=dst(0-31)+src(0-31)
5862 \H{insADDSS} \i\c{ADDSS}: Scalar Single FP ADD
5864 \c ADDSS xmmreg,mem128 ; f3 0f 58 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
5865 \c ADDSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; f3 0f 58 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
5867 \H{insAND} \i\c{AND}: Bitwise AND
5869 \c AND r/m8,reg8 ; 20 /r [8086]
5870 \c AND r/m16,reg16 ; o16 21 /r [8086]
5871 \c AND r/m32,reg32 ; o32 21 /r [386]
5873 \c AND reg8,r/m8 ; 22 /r [8086]
5874 \c AND reg16,r/m16 ; o16 23 /r [8086]
5875 \c AND reg32,r/m32 ; o32 23 /r [386]
5877 \c AND r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /4 ib [8086]
5878 \c AND r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /4 iw [8086]
5879 \c AND r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /4 id [386]
5881 \c AND r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /4 ib [8086]
5882 \c AND r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /4 ib [386]
5884 \c AND AL,imm8 ; 24 ib [8086]
5885 \c AND AX,imm16 ; o16 25 iw [8086]
5886 \c AND EAX,imm32 ; o32 25 id [386]
5888 \c{AND} performs a bitwise AND operation between its two operands
5889 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if the corresponding
5890 bits of the two inputs were both 1), and stores the result in the
5891 destination (first) operand.
5893 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
5894 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
5895 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
5896 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
5897 form of the instruction.
5899 The MMX instruction \c{PAND} (see \k{insPAND}) performs the same
5900 operation on the 64-bit MMX registers.
5902 \H{insANDNPS} \i\c{ANDNPS}: Bitwise Logical AND NOT For Single FP
5904 \c ANDNPS xmmreg,mem128 ; 0f 55 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
5905 \c ANDNPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; 0f 55 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
5908 \H{insANDPS} \i\c{ANDPS}: Bitwise Logical AND For Single FP
5910 \c ANDPS xmmreg,mem128 ; 0f 54 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
5911 \c ANDPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; 0f 54 /r [KATMAI,SSE]
5914 \H{insARPL} \i\c{ARPL}: Adjust RPL Field of Selector
5916 \c ARPL r/m16,reg16 ; 63 /r [286,PRIV]
5918 \c{ARPL} expects its two word operands to be segment selectors. It
5919 adjusts the RPL (requested privilege level - stored in the bottom
5920 two bits of the selector) field of the destination (first) operand
5921 to ensure that it is no less (i.e. no more privileged than) the RPL
5922 field of the source operand. The zero flag is set if and only if a
5923 change had to be made.
5925 \H{insBOUND} \i\c{BOUND}: Check Array Index against Bounds
5927 \c BOUND reg16,mem ; o16 62 /r [186]
5928 \c BOUND reg32,mem ; o32 62 /r [386]
5930 \c{BOUND} expects its second operand to point to an area of memory
5931 containing two signed values of the same size as its first operand
5932 (i.e. two words for the 16-bit form; two doublewords for the 32-bit
5933 form). It performs two signed comparisons: if the value in the
5934 register passed as its first operand is less than the first of the
5935 in-memory values, or is greater than or equal to the second, it
5936 throws a BR exception. Otherwise, it does nothing.
5938 \H{insBSF} \i\c{BSF}, \i\c{BSR}: Bit Scan
5940 \c BSF reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F BC /r [386]
5941 \c BSF reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F BC /r [386]
5943 \c BSR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F BD /r [386]
5944 \c BSR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F BD /r [386]
5946 \c{BSF} searches for a set bit in its source (second) operand,
5947 starting from the bottom, and if it finds one, stores the index in
5948 its destination (first) operand. If no set bit is found, the
5949 contents of the destination operand are undefined.
5951 \c{BSR} performs the same function, but searches from the top
5952 instead, so it finds the most significant set bit.
5954 Bit indices are from 0 (least significant) to 15 or 31 (most
5957 \H{insBSWAP} \i\c{BSWAP}: Byte Swap
5959 \c BSWAP reg32 ; o32 0F C8+r [486]
5961 \c{BSWAP} swaps the order of the four bytes of a 32-bit register:
5962 bits 0-7 exchange places with bits 24-31, and bits 8-15 swap with
5963 bits 16-23. There is no explicit 16-bit equivalent: to byte-swap
5964 \c{AX}, \c{BX}, \c{CX} or \c{DX}, \c{XCHG} can be used.
5966 \H{insBT} \i\c{BT}, \i\c{BTC}, \i\c{BTR}, \i\c{BTS}: Bit Test
5968 \c BT r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F A3 /r [386]
5969 \c BT r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F A3 /r [386]
5970 \c BT r/m16,imm8 ; o16 0F BA /4 ib [386]
5971 \c BT r/m32,imm8 ; o32 0F BA /4 ib [386]
5973 \c BTC r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F BB /r [386]
5974 \c BTC r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F BB /r [386]
5975 \c BTC r/m16,imm8 ; o16 0F BA /7 ib [386]
5976 \c BTC r/m32,imm8 ; o32 0F BA /7 ib [386]
5978 \c BTR r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F B3 /r [386]
5979 \c BTR r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F B3 /r [386]
5980 \c BTR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 0F BA /6 ib [386]
5981 \c BTR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 0F BA /6 ib [386]
5983 \c BTS r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F AB /r [386]
5984 \c BTS r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F AB /r [386]
5985 \c BTS r/m16,imm ; o16 0F BA /5 ib [386]
5986 \c BTS r/m32,imm ; o32 0F BA /5 ib [386]
5988 These instructions all test one bit of their first operand, whose
5989 index is given by the second operand, and store the value of that
5990 bit into the carry flag. Bit indices are from 0 (least significant)
5991 to 15 or 31 (most significant).
5993 In addition to storing the original value of the bit into the carry
5994 flag, \c{BTR} also resets (clears) the bit in the operand itself.
5995 \c{BTS} sets the bit, and \c{BTC} complements the bit. \c{BT} does
5996 not modify its operands.
5998 The bit offset should be no greater than the size of the operand.
6000 \H{insCALL} \i\c{CALL}: Call Subroutine
6002 \c CALL imm ; E8 rw/rd [8086]
6003 \c CALL imm:imm16 ; o16 9A iw iw [8086]
6004 \c CALL imm:imm32 ; o32 9A id iw [386]
6005 \c CALL FAR mem16 ; o16 FF /3 [8086]
6006 \c CALL FAR mem32 ; o32 FF /3 [386]
6007 \c CALL r/m16 ; o16 FF /2 [8086]
6008 \c CALL r/m32 ; o32 FF /2 [386]
6010 \c{CALL} calls a subroutine, by means of pushing the current
6011 instruction pointer (\c{IP}) and optionally \c{CS} as well on the
6012 stack, and then jumping to a given address.
6014 \c{CS} is pushed as well as \c{IP} if and only if the call is a far
6015 call, i.e. a destination segment address is specified in the
6016 instruction. The forms involving two colon-separated arguments are
6017 far calls; so are the \c{CALL FAR mem} forms.
6019 You can choose between the two immediate \i{far call} forms (\c{CALL
6020 imm:imm}) by the use of the \c{WORD} and \c{DWORD} keywords: \c{CALL
6021 WORD 0x1234:0x5678}) or \c{CALL DWORD 0x1234:0x56789abc}.
6023 The \c{CALL FAR mem} forms execute a far call by loading the
6024 destination address out of memory. The address loaded consists of 16
6025 or 32 bits of offset (depending on the operand size), and 16 bits of
6026 segment. The operand size may be overridden using \c{CALL WORD FAR
6027 mem} or \c{CALL DWORD FAR mem}.
6029 The \c{CALL r/m} forms execute a \i{near call} (within the same
6030 segment), loading the destination address out of memory or out of a
6031 register. The keyword \c{NEAR} may be specified, for clarity, in
6032 these forms, but is not necessary. Again, operand size can be
6033 overridden using \c{CALL WORD mem} or \c{CALL DWORD mem}.
6035 As a convenience, NASM does not require you to call a far procedure
6036 symbol by coding the cumbersome \c{CALL SEG routine:routine}, but
6037 instead allows the easier synonym \c{CALL FAR routine}.
6039 The \c{CALL r/m} forms given above are near calls; NASM will accept
6040 the \c{NEAR} keyword (e.g. \c{CALL NEAR [address]}), even though it
6041 is not strictly necessary.
6043 \H{insCBW} \i\c{CBW}, \i\c{CWD}, \i\c{CDQ}, \i\c{CWDE}: Sign Extensions
6045 \c CBW ; o16 98 [8086]
6046 \c CWD ; o16 99 [8086]
6047 \c CDQ ; o32 99 [386]
6048 \c CWDE ; o32 98 [386]
6050 All these instructions sign-extend a short value into a longer one,
6051 by replicating the top bit of the original value to fill the
6054 \c{CBW} extends \c{AL} into \c{AX} by repeating the top bit of
6055 \c{AL} in every bit of \c{AH}. \c{CWD} extends \c{AX} into \c{DX:AX}
6056 by repeating the top bit of \c{AX} throughout \c{DX}. \c{CWDE}
6057 extends \c{AX} into \c{EAX}, and \c{CDQ} extends \c{EAX} into
6060 \H{insCLC} \i\c{CLC}, \i\c{CLD}, \i\c{CLI}, \i\c{CLTS}: Clear Flags
6065 \c CLTS ; 0F 06 [286,PRIV]
6067 These instructions clear various flags. \c{CLC} clears the carry
6068 flag; \c{CLD} clears the direction flag; \c{CLI} clears the
6069 interrupt flag (thus disabling interrupts); and \c{CLTS} clears the
6070 task-switched (\c{TS}) flag in \c{CR0}.
6072 To set the carry, direction, or interrupt flags, use the \c{STC},
6073 \c{STD} and \c{STI} instructions (\k{insSTC}). To invert the carry
6074 flag, use \c{CMC} (\k{insCMC}).
6076 \H{insCMC} \i\c{CMC}: Complement Carry Flag
6080 \c{CMC} changes the value of the carry flag: if it was 0, it sets it
6081 to 1, and vice versa.
6083 \H{insCMOVcc} \i\c{CMOVcc}: Conditional Move
6085 \c CMOVcc reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 40+cc /r [P6]
6086 \c CMOVcc reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 40+cc /r [P6]
6088 \c{CMOV} moves its source (second) operand into its destination
6089 (first) operand if the given condition code is satisfied; otherwise
6092 For a list of condition codes, see \k{iref-cc}.
6094 Although the \c{CMOV} instructions are flagged \c{P6} above, they
6095 may not be supported by all Pentium Pro processors; the \c{CPUID}
6096 instruction (\k{insCPUID}) will return a bit which indicates whether
6097 conditional moves are supported.
6099 \H{insCMP} \i\c{CMP}: Compare Integers
6101 \c CMP r/m8,reg8 ; 38 /r [8086]
6102 \c CMP r/m16,reg16 ; o16 39 /r [8086]
6103 \c CMP r/m32,reg32 ; o32 39 /r [386]
6105 \c CMP reg8,r/m8 ; 3A /r [8086]
6106 \c CMP reg16,r/m16 ; o16 3B /r [8086]
6107 \c CMP reg32,r/m32 ; o32 3B /r [386]
6109 \c CMP r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /0 ib [8086]
6110 \c CMP r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /0 iw [8086]
6111 \c CMP r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /0 id [386]
6113 \c CMP r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /0 ib [8086]
6114 \c CMP r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /0 ib [386]
6116 \c CMP AL,imm8 ; 3C ib [8086]
6117 \c CMP AX,imm16 ; o16 3D iw [8086]
6118 \c CMP EAX,imm32 ; o32 3D id [386]
6120 \c{CMP} performs a `mental' subtraction of its second operand from
6121 its first operand, and affects the flags as if the subtraction had
6122 taken place, but does not store the result of the subtraction
6125 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
6126 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
6127 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
6128 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
6129 form of the instruction.
6132 \H{insCMPEQPS} \i\c{CMPEQPS}: Packed Single FP Compare (CMPPS)
6134 \c CMPEQPS xmmreg,memory ; 0f c2 /r ib [KATMAI,SSE]
6135 \c CMPEQPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; [KATMAI,SSE]
6137 \c{CMPPS} with condition set, re CMPPS.
6139 \H{insCMPEQSS} \i\c{CMPEQSS}: Scalar Single FP Compare (CMPSS)
6141 \c CMPEQSS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6142 \c CMPEQSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6144 \c{CMPSS} with condition set, re CMPPS.
6146 \H{insCMPLEPS} \i\c{CMPLEPS}: Packed Single FP Compare (CMPPS)
6148 \c CMPLEPS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6149 \c CMPLEPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6152 \H{insCMPLESS} \i\c{CMPLESS}: Scalar Single FP Compare (CMPSS)
6154 \c CMPLESS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6155 \c CMPLESS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6158 \H{insCMPLTPS} \i\c{CMPLTPS}: Packed Single FP Compare (CMPPS)
6160 \c CMPLTPS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6161 \c CMPLTPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6164 \H{insCMPLTSS} \i\c{CMPLTSS}: Scalar Single FP Compare (CMPSS)
6166 \c CMPLTSS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6167 \c CMPLTSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6170 \H{insCMPNEQPS} \i\c{CMPNEQPS}: Packed Single FP Compare (CMPPS)
6172 \c CMPNEQPS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6173 \c CMPNEQPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6176 \H{insCMPNEQSS} \i\c{CMPNEQSS}: Scalar Single FP Compare (CMPSS)
6178 \c CMPNEQSS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6179 \c CMPNEQSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6182 \H{insCMPNLEPS} \i\c{CMPNLEPS}: Packed Single FP Compare (CMPPS)
6184 \c CMPNLEPS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6185 \c CMPNLEPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6188 \H{insCMPNLESS} \i\c{CMPNLESS}: Scalar Single FP Compare (CMPSS)
6190 \c CMPNLESS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6191 \c CMPNLESS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6194 \H{insCMPNLTPS} \i\c{CMPNLTPS}: Packed Single FP Compare (CMPPS)
6196 \c CMPNLTPS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6197 \c CMPNLTPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6200 \H{insCMPNLTSS} \i\c{CMPNLTSS}: Scalar Single FP Compare (CMPSS)
6202 \c CMPNLTSS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6203 \c CMPNLTSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6206 \H{insCMPORDPS} \i\c{CMPORDPS}: Packed Single FP Compare (CMPPS)
6208 \c CMPORDPS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6209 \c CMPORDPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6212 \H{insCMPORDSS} \i\c{CMPORDSS}: Scalar Single FP Compare (CMPSS)
6214 \c CMPORDSS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6215 \c CMPORDSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6218 \H{insCMPPS} \i\c{CMPPS}: Packed Single FP Compare
6220 \c CMPPS xmmreg,memory,immediate ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,SB,AR2]
6221 \c CMPPS xmmreg,xmmreg,immediate ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,SB,AR2]
6223 \c{CMP(cc)PS} and \c{CMP(cc)SS} conditions (cc):
6224 EQ, LT, LE, UNORD, NEQ, NLT, NLE, ORD
6227 \H{insCMPSB} \i\c{CMPSB}, \i\c{CMPSW}, \i\c{CMPSD}: Compare Strings
6229 \c CMPSB ; A6 [8086]
6230 \c CMPSW ; o16 A7 [8086]
6231 \c CMPSD ; o32 A7 [386]
6233 \c{CMPSB} compares the byte at \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} with the
6234 byte at \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]}, and sets the flags accordingly.
6235 It then increments or decrements (depending on the direction flag:
6236 increments if the flag is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{SI} and
6237 \c{DI} (or \c{ESI} and \c{EDI}).
6239 The registers used are \c{SI} and \c{DI} if the address size is 16
6240 bits, and \c{ESI} and \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use
6241 an address size not equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can
6242 use an explicit \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
6244 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
6245 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
6246 example, \c{es cmpsb}). The use of \c{ES} for the load from \c{[DI]}
6247 or \c{[EDI]} cannot be overridden.
6249 \c{CMPSW} and \c{CMPSD} work in the same way, but they compare a
6250 word or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement
6251 the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
6253 The \c{REPE} and \c{REPNE} prefixes (equivalently, \c{REPZ} and
6254 \c{REPNZ}) may be used to repeat the instruction up to \c{CX} (or
6255 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times until the
6256 first unequal or equal byte is found.
6260 \H{insCMPSS} \i\c{CMPSS}: Scalar Single FP Compare
6262 \c CMPSS xmmreg,memory,immediate ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,SB,AR2]
6263 \c CMPSS xmmreg,xmmreg,immediate ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,SB,AR2]
6265 \c{CMP(cc)PS} and \c{CMP(cc)SS} conditions (cc):
6266 EQ, LT, LE, UNORD, NEQ, NLT, NLE, ORD
6269 \H{insCMPUNORDPS} \i\c{CMPUNORDPS}: Packed Single FP Compare
6273 \c CMPUNORDPS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6274 \c CMPUNORDPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6277 \H{insCMPUNORDSS} \i\c{CMPUNORDSS}: Scalar Single FP Compare
6281 \c CMPUNORDSS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6282 \c CMPUNORDSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6285 \H{insCMPXCHG} \i\c{CMPXCHG}, \i\c{CMPXCHG486}: Compare and Exchange
6287 \c CMPXCHG r/m8,reg8 ; 0F B0 /r [PENT]
6288 \c CMPXCHG r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F B1 /r [PENT]
6289 \c CMPXCHG r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F B1 /r [PENT]
6291 \c CMPXCHG486 r/m8,reg8 ; 0F A6 /r [486,UNDOC]
6292 \c CMPXCHG486 r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F A7 /r [486,UNDOC]
6293 \c CMPXCHG486 r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F A7 /r [486,UNDOC]
6295 These two instructions perform exactly the same operation; however,
6296 apparently some (not all) 486 processors support it under a
6297 non-standard opcode, so NASM provides the undocumented
6298 \c{CMPXCHG486} form to generate the non-standard opcode.
6300 \c{CMPXCHG} compares its destination (first) operand to the value in
6301 \c{AL}, \c{AX} or \c{EAX} (depending on the size of the
6302 instruction). If they are equal, it copies its source (second)
6303 operand into the destination and sets the zero flag. Otherwise, it
6304 clears the zero flag and leaves the destination alone.
6306 \c{CMPXCHG} is intended to be used for atomic operations in
6307 multitasking or multiprocessor environments. To safely update a
6308 value in shared memory, for example, you might load the value into
6309 \c{EAX}, load the updated value into \c{EBX}, and then execute the
6310 instruction \c{lock cmpxchg [value],ebx}. If \c{value} has not
6311 changed since being loaded, it is updated with your desired new
6312 value, and the zero flag is set to let you know it has worked. (The
6313 \c{LOCK} prefix prevents another processor doing anything in the
6314 middle of this operation: it guarantees atomicity.) However, if
6315 another processor has modified the value in between your load and
6316 your attempted store, the store does not happen, and you are
6317 notified of the failure by a cleared zero flag, so you can go round
6320 \H{insCMPXCHG8B} \i\c{CMPXCHG8B}: Compare and Exchange Eight Bytes
6322 \c CMPXCHG8B mem ; 0F C7 /1 [PENT]
6324 This is a larger and more unwieldy version of \c{CMPXCHG}: it
6325 compares the 64-bit (eight-byte) value stored at \c{[mem]} with the
6326 value in \c{EDX:EAX}. If they are equal, it sets the zero flag and
6327 stores \c{ECX:EBX} into the memory area. If they are unequal, it
6328 clears the zero flag and leaves the memory area untouched.
6330 \H{insCOMISS} \i\c{COMISS}: Scalar Ordered Single-FP Compare and Set EFLAGS
6332 \c COMISS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6333 \c COMISS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6335 Set Z, P, C according to comparison, clear O, S, A bits of EFLAGS.
6336 Z=P=C=1 for "unordered" result (QNaN).
6338 \H{insCPUID} \i\c{CPUID}: Get CPU Identification Code
6340 \c CPUID ; 0F A2 [PENT]
6342 \c{CPUID} returns various information about the processor it is
6343 being executed on. It fills the four registers \c{EAX}, \c{EBX},
6344 \c{ECX} and \c{EDX} with information, which varies depending on the
6345 input contents of \c{EAX}.
6347 \c{CPUID} also acts as a barrier to serialise instruction execution:
6348 executing the \c{CPUID} instruction guarantees that all the effects
6349 (memory modification, flag modification, register modification) of
6350 previous instructions have been completed before the next
6351 instruction gets fetched.
6353 The information returned is as follows:
6355 \b If \c{EAX} is zero on input, \c{EAX} on output holds the maximum
6356 acceptable input value of \c{EAX}, and \c{EBX:EDX:ECX} contain the
6357 string \c{"GenuineIntel"} (or not, if you have a clone processor).
6358 That is to say, \c{EBX} contains \c{"Genu"} (in NASM's own sense of
6359 character constants, described in \k{chrconst}), \c{EDX} contains
6360 \c{"ineI"} and \c{ECX} contains \c{"ntel"}.
6362 \b If \c{EAX} is one on input, \c{EAX} on output contains version
6363 information about the processor, and \c{EDX} contains a set of
6364 feature flags, showing the presence and absence of various features.
6365 For example, bit 8 is set if the \c{CMPXCHG8B} instruction
6366 (\k{insCMPXCHG8B}) is supported, bit 15 is set if the conditional
6367 move instructions (\k{insCMOVcc} and \k{insFCMOVB}) are supported,
6368 and bit 23 is set if MMX instructions are supported.
6370 \b If \c{EAX} is two on input, \c{EAX}, \c{EBX}, \c{ECX} and \c{EDX}
6371 all contain information about caches and TLBs (Translation Lookahead
6374 For more information on the data returned from \c{CPUID}, see the
6375 documentation on Intel's web site.
6378 \H{insCVTPI2PS} \i\c{CVTPI2PS}:
6379 Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Single-FP Conversion
6381 \c CVTPI2PS xmmreg,mem64 ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,MMX]
6382 \c CVTPI2PS xmmreg,mmxreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,MMX]
6385 \H{insCVTPS2PI} \i\c{CVTPS2PI}:
6386 Packed Single-FP to Packed INT32 Conversion
6388 \c CVTPS2PI mmxreg,mem64 ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,MMX]
6389 \c CVTPS2PI mmxreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,MMX]
6392 \H{insCVTSI2SS} \i\c{CVTSI2SS}:
6393 Scalar Signed INT32 to Single-FP Conversion
6395 \c CVTSI2SS xmmreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,SD,AR1]
6396 \c CVTSI2SS xmmreg,reg32 ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6400 \H{insCVTSS2SI} \i\c{CVTSS2SI}:
6401 Scalar Single-FP to Signed INT32 Conversion
6403 \c CVTSS2SI reg32,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6404 \c CVTSS2SI reg32,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6407 \H{insCVTTPS2PI} \i\c{CVTTPS2PI}:
6408 Packed Single-FP to Packed INT32 Conversion
6410 \c CVTTPS2PI mmxreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,MMX]
6411 \c CVTTPS2PI mmxreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,MMX]
6414 \H{insCVTTSS2SI} \i\c{CVTTSS2SI}:
6415 Scalr Single-FP to Signed INT32 Conversion
6417 \c CVTTSS2SI reg32,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6418 \c CVTTSS2SI reg32,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6421 \H{insDAA} \i\c{DAA}, \i\c{DAS}: Decimal Adjustments
6426 These instructions are used in conjunction with the add and subtract
6427 instructions to perform binary-coded decimal arithmetic in
6428 \e{packed} (one BCD digit per nibble) form. For the unpacked
6429 equivalents, see \k{insAAA}.
6431 \c{DAA} should be used after a one-byte \c{ADD} instruction whose
6432 destination was the \c{AL} register: by means of examining the value
6433 in the \c{AL} and also the auxiliary carry flag \c{AF}, it
6434 determines whether either digit of the addition has overflowed, and
6435 adjusts it (and sets the carry and auxiliary-carry flags) if so. You
6436 can add long BCD strings together by doing \c{ADD}/\c{DAA} on the
6437 low two digits, then doing \c{ADC}/\c{DAA} on each subsequent pair
6440 \c{DAS} works similarly to \c{DAA}, but is for use after \c{SUB}
6441 instructions rather than \c{ADD}.
6443 \H{insDEC} \i\c{DEC}: Decrement Integer
6445 \c DEC reg16 ; o16 48+r [8086]
6446 \c DEC reg32 ; o32 48+r [386]
6447 \c DEC r/m8 ; FE /1 [8086]
6448 \c DEC r/m16 ; o16 FF /1 [8086]
6449 \c DEC r/m32 ; o32 FF /1 [386]
6451 \c{DEC} subtracts 1 from its operand. It does \e{not} affect the
6452 carry flag: to affect the carry flag, use \c{SUB something,1} (see
6453 \k{insSUB}). See also \c{INC} (\k{insINC}).
6455 \H{insDIV} \i\c{DIV}: Unsigned Integer Divide
6457 \c DIV r/m8 ; F6 /6 [8086]
6458 \c DIV r/m16 ; o16 F7 /6 [8086]
6459 \c DIV r/m32 ; o32 F7 /6 [386]
6461 \c{DIV} performs unsigned integer division. The explicit operand
6462 provided is the divisor; the dividend and destination operands are
6463 implicit, in the following way:
6465 \b For \c{DIV r/m8}, \c{AX} is divided by the given operand; the
6466 quotient is stored in \c{AL} and the remainder in \c{AH}.
6468 \b For \c{DIV r/m16}, \c{DX:AX} is divided by the given operand; the
6469 quotient is stored in \c{AX} and the remainder in \c{DX}.
6471 \b For \c{DIV r/m32}, \c{EDX:EAX} is divided by the given operand;
6472 the quotient is stored in \c{EAX} and the remainder in \c{EDX}.
6474 Signed integer division is performed by the \c{IDIV} instruction:
6477 \H{insDIVPS} \i\c{DIVPS}: Packed Single-FP Divide
6479 \c DIVPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,5E,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
6480 \c DIVPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6482 \c{DIVPS}The DIVPS instruction divides the packed SP FP numbers
6483 of both their operands.
6486 \H{insDIVSS} \i\c{DIVSS}: Scalar Single-FP Divide
6488 \c DIVSS xmmreg,memory ; F3,0F,5E,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
6489 \c DIVSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
6491 \c{DIVSS}-The DIVSS instructions divide the lowest SP FP numbers
6492 of both operands; the upper three fields are passed through from xmm1.
6495 \H{insEMMS} \i\c{EMMS}: Empty MMX State
6497 \c EMMS ; 0F 77 [PENT,MMX]
6499 \c{EMMS} sets the FPU tag word (marking which floating-point
6500 registers are available) to all ones, meaning all registers are
6501 available for the FPU to use. It should be used after executing MMX
6502 instructions and before executing any subsequent floating-point
6505 \H{insENTER} \i\c{ENTER}: Create Stack Frame
6507 \c ENTER imm,imm ; C8 iw ib [186]
6509 \c{ENTER} constructs a stack frame for a high-level language
6510 procedure call. The first operand (the \c{iw} in the opcode
6511 definition above refers to the first operand) gives the amount of
6512 stack space to allocate for local variables; the second (the \c{ib}
6513 above) gives the nesting level of the procedure (for languages like
6514 Pascal, with nested procedures).
6516 The function of \c{ENTER}, with a nesting level of zero, is
6519 \c PUSH EBP ; or PUSH BP in 16 bits
6520 \c MOV EBP,ESP ; or MOV BP,SP in 16 bits
6521 \c SUB ESP,operand1 ; or SUB SP,operand1 in 16 bits
6523 This creates a stack frame with the procedure parameters accessible
6524 upwards from \c{EBP}, and local variables accessible downwards from
6527 With a nesting level of one, the stack frame created is 4 (or 2)
6528 bytes bigger, and the value of the final frame pointer \c{EBP} is
6529 accessible in memory at \c{[EBP-4]}.
6531 This allows \c{ENTER}, when called with a nesting level of two, to
6532 look at the stack frame described by the \e{previous} value of
6533 \c{EBP}, find the frame pointer at offset -4 from that, and push it
6534 along with its new frame pointer, so that when a level-two procedure
6535 is called from within a level-one procedure, \c{[EBP-4]} holds the
6536 frame pointer of the most recent level-one procedure call and
6537 \c{[EBP-8]} holds that of the most recent level-two call. And so on,
6538 for nesting levels up to 31.
6540 Stack frames created by \c{ENTER} can be destroyed by the \c{LEAVE}
6541 instruction: see \k{insLEAVE}.
6543 \H{insF2XM1} \i\c{F2XM1}: Calculate 2**X-1
6545 \c F2XM1 ; D9 F0 [8086,FPU]
6547 \c{F2XM1} raises 2 to the power of \c{ST0}, subtracts one, and
6548 stores the result back into \c{ST0}. The initial contents of \c{ST0}
6549 must be a number in the range -1 to +1.
6551 \H{insFABS} \i\c{FABS}: Floating-Point Absolute Value
6553 \c FABS ; D9 E1 [8086,FPU]
6555 \c{FABS} computes the absolute value of \c{ST0}, storing the result
6558 \H{insFADD} \i\c{FADD}, \i\c{FADDP}: Floating-Point Addition
6560 \c FADD mem32 ; D8 /0 [8086,FPU]
6561 \c FADD mem64 ; DC /0 [8086,FPU]
6563 \c FADD fpureg ; D8 C0+r [8086,FPU]
6564 \c FADD ST0,fpureg ; D8 C0+r [8086,FPU]
6566 \c FADD TO fpureg ; DC C0+r [8086,FPU]
6567 \c FADD fpureg,ST0 ; DC C0+r [8086,FPU]
6569 \c FADDP fpureg ; DE C0+r [8086,FPU]
6570 \c FADDP fpureg,ST0 ; DE C0+r [8086,FPU]
6572 \c{FADD}, given one operand, adds the operand to \c{ST0} and stores
6573 the result back in \c{ST0}. If the operand has the \c{TO} modifier,
6574 the result is stored in the register given rather than in \c{ST0}.
6576 \c{FADDP} performs the same function as \c{FADD TO}, but pops the
6577 register stack after storing the result.
6579 The given two-operand forms are synonyms for the one-operand forms.
6581 \H{insFBLD} \i\c{FBLD}, \i\c{FBSTP}: BCD Floating-Point Load and Store
6583 \c FBLD mem80 ; DF /4 [8086,FPU]
6584 \c FBSTP mem80 ; DF /6 [8086,FPU]
6586 \c{FBLD} loads an 80-bit (ten-byte) packed binary-coded decimal
6587 number from the given memory address, converts it to a real, and
6588 pushes it on the register stack. \c{FBSTP} stores the value of
6589 \c{ST0}, in packed BCD, at the given address and then pops the
6592 \H{insFCHS} \i\c{FCHS}: Floating-Point Change Sign
6594 \c FCHS ; D9 E0 [8086,FPU]
6596 \c{FCHS} negates the number in \c{ST0}: negative numbers become
6597 positive, and vice versa.
6599 \H{insFCLEX} \i\c{FCLEX}, \c{FNCLEX}: Clear Floating-Point Exceptions
6601 \c FCLEX ; 9B DB E2 [8086,FPU]
6602 \c FNCLEX ; DB E2 [8086,FPU]
6604 \c{FCLEX} clears any floating-point exceptions which may be pending.
6605 \c{FNCLEX} does the same thing but doesn't wait for previous
6606 floating-point operations (including the \e{handling} of pending
6607 exceptions) to finish first.
6609 \H{insFCMOVB} \i\c{FCMOVcc}: Floating-Point Conditional Move
6611 \c FCMOVB fpureg ; DA C0+r [P6,FPU]
6612 \c FCMOVB ST0,fpureg ; DA C0+r [P6,FPU]
6614 \c FCMOVBE fpureg ; DA D0+r [P6,FPU]
6615 \c FCMOVBE ST0,fpureg ; DA D0+r [P6,FPU]
6617 \c FCMOVE fpureg ; DA C8+r [P6,FPU]
6618 \c FCMOVE ST0,fpureg ; DA C8+r [P6,FPU]
6620 \c FCMOVNB fpureg ; DB C0+r [P6,FPU]
6621 \c FCMOVNB ST0,fpureg ; DB C0+r [P6,FPU]
6623 \c FCMOVNBE fpureg ; DB D0+r [P6,FPU]
6624 \c FCMOVNBE ST0,fpureg ; DB D0+r [P6,FPU]
6626 \c FCMOVNE fpureg ; DB C8+r [P6,FPU]
6627 \c FCMOVNE ST0,fpureg ; DB C8+r [P6,FPU]
6629 \c FCMOVNU fpureg ; DB D8+r [P6,FPU]
6630 \c FCMOVNU ST0,fpureg ; DB D8+r [P6,FPU]
6632 \c FCMOVU fpureg ; DA D8+r [P6,FPU]
6633 \c FCMOVU ST0,fpureg ; DA D8+r [P6,FPU]
6635 The \c{FCMOV} instructions perform conditional move operations: each
6636 of them moves the contents of the given register into \c{ST0} if its
6637 condition is satisfied, and does nothing if not.
6639 The conditions are not the same as the standard condition codes used
6640 with conditional jump instructions. The conditions \c{B}, \c{BE},
6641 \c{NB}, \c{NBE}, \c{E} and \c{NE} are exactly as normal, but none of
6642 the other standard ones are supported. Instead, the condition \c{U}
6643 and its counterpart \c{NU} are provided; the \c{U} condition is
6644 satisfied if the last two floating-point numbers compared were
6645 \e{unordered}, i.e. they were not equal but neither one could be
6646 said to be greater than the other, for example if they were NaNs.
6647 (The flag state which signals this is the setting of the parity
6648 flag: so the \c{U} condition is notionally equivalent to \c{PE}, and
6649 \c{NU} is equivalent to \c{PO}.)
6651 The \c{FCMOV} conditions test the main processor's status flags, not
6652 the FPU status flags, so using \c{FCMOV} directly after \c{FCOM}
6653 will not work. Instead, you should either use \c{FCOMI} which writes
6654 directly to the main CPU flags word, or use \c{FSTSW} to extract the
6657 Although the \c{FCMOV} instructions are flagged \c{P6} above, they
6658 may not be supported by all Pentium Pro processors; the \c{CPUID}
6659 instruction (\k{insCPUID}) will return a bit which indicates whether
6660 conditional moves are supported.
6662 \H{insFCOM} \i\c{FCOM}, \i\c{FCOMP}, \i\c{FCOMPP}, \i\c{FCOMI}, \i\c{FCOMIP}: Floating-Point Compare
6664 \c FCOM mem32 ; D8 /2 [8086,FPU]
6665 \c FCOM mem64 ; DC /2 [8086,FPU]
6666 \c FCOM fpureg ; D8 D0+r [8086,FPU]
6667 \c FCOM ST0,fpureg ; D8 D0+r [8086,FPU]
6669 \c FCOMP mem32 ; D8 /3 [8086,FPU]
6670 \c FCOMP mem64 ; DC /3 [8086,FPU]
6671 \c FCOMP fpureg ; D8 D8+r [8086,FPU]
6672 \c FCOMP ST0,fpureg ; D8 D8+r [8086,FPU]
6674 \c FCOMPP ; DE D9 [8086,FPU]
6676 \c FCOMI fpureg ; DB F0+r [P6,FPU]
6677 \c FCOMI ST0,fpureg ; DB F0+r [P6,FPU]
6679 \c FCOMIP fpureg ; DF F0+r [P6,FPU]
6680 \c FCOMIP ST0,fpureg ; DF F0+r [P6,FPU]
6682 \c{FCOM} compares \c{ST0} with the given operand, and sets the FPU
6683 flags accordingly. \c{ST0} is treated as the left-hand side of the
6684 comparison, so that the carry flag is set (for a `less-than' result)
6685 if \c{ST0} is less than the given operand.
6687 \c{FCOMP} does the same as \c{FCOM}, but pops the register stack
6688 afterwards. \c{FCOMPP} compares \c{ST0} with \c{ST1} and then pops
6689 the register stack twice.
6691 \c{FCOMI} and \c{FCOMIP} work like the corresponding forms of
6692 \c{FCOM} and \c{FCOMP}, but write their results directly to the CPU
6693 flags register rather than the FPU status word, so they can be
6694 immediately followed by conditional jump or conditional move
6697 The \c{FCOM} instructions differ from the \c{FUCOM} instructions
6698 (\k{insFUCOM}) only in the way they handle quiet NaNs: \c{FUCOM}
6699 will handle them silently and set the condition code flags to an
6700 `unordered' result, whereas \c{FCOM} will generate an exception.
6702 \H{insFCOS} \i\c{FCOS}: Cosine
6704 \c FCOS ; D9 FF [386,FPU]
6706 \c{FCOS} computes the cosine of \c{ST0} (in radians), and stores the
6707 result in \c{ST0}. See also \c{FSINCOS} (\k{insFSIN}).
6709 \H{insFDECSTP} \i\c{FDECSTP}: Decrement Floating-Point Stack Pointer
6711 \c FDECSTP ; D9 F6 [8086,FPU]
6713 \c{FDECSTP} decrements the `top' field in the floating-point status
6714 word. This has the effect of rotating the FPU register stack by one,
6715 as if the contents of \c{ST7} had been pushed on the stack. See also
6716 \c{FINCSTP} (\k{insFINCSTP}).
6718 \H{insFDISI} \i\c{FxDISI}, \i\c{FxENI}: Disable and Enable Floating-Point Interrupts
6720 \c FDISI ; 9B DB E1 [8086,FPU]
6721 \c FNDISI ; DB E1 [8086,FPU]
6723 \c FENI ; 9B DB E0 [8086,FPU]
6724 \c FNENI ; DB E0 [8086,FPU]
6726 \c{FDISI} and \c{FENI} disable and enable floating-point interrupts.
6727 These instructions are only meaningful on original 8087 processors:
6728 the 287 and above treat them as no-operation instructions.
6730 \c{FNDISI} and \c{FNENI} do the same thing as \c{FDISI} and \c{FENI}
6731 respectively, but without waiting for the floating-point processor
6732 to finish what it was doing first.
6734 \H{insFDIV} \i\c{FDIV}, \i\c{FDIVP}, \i\c{FDIVR}, \i\c{FDIVRP}: Floating-Point Division
6736 \c FDIV mem32 ; D8 /6 [8086,FPU]
6737 \c FDIV mem64 ; DC /6 [8086,FPU]
6739 \c FDIV fpureg ; D8 F0+r [8086,FPU]
6740 \c FDIV ST0,fpureg ; D8 F0+r [8086,FPU]
6742 \c FDIV TO fpureg ; DC F8+r [8086,FPU]
6743 \c FDIV fpureg,ST0 ; DC F8+r [8086,FPU]
6745 \c FDIVR mem32 ; D8 /0 [8086,FPU]
6746 \c FDIVR mem64 ; DC /0 [8086,FPU]
6748 \c FDIVR fpureg ; D8 F8+r [8086,FPU]
6749 \c FDIVR ST0,fpureg ; D8 F8+r [8086,FPU]
6751 \c FDIVR TO fpureg ; DC F0+r [8086,FPU]
6752 \c FDIVR fpureg,ST0 ; DC F0+r [8086,FPU]
6754 \c FDIVP fpureg ; DE F8+r [8086,FPU]
6755 \c FDIVP fpureg,ST0 ; DE F8+r [8086,FPU]
6757 \c FDIVRP fpureg ; DE F0+r [8086,FPU]
6758 \c FDIVRP fpureg,ST0 ; DE F0+r [8086,FPU]
6760 \c{FDIV} divides \c{ST0} by the given operand and stores the result
6761 back in \c{ST0}, unless the \c{TO} qualifier is given, in which case
6762 it divides the given operand by \c{ST0} and stores the result in the
6765 \c{FDIVR} does the same thing, but does the division the other way
6766 up: so if \c{TO} is not given, it divides the given operand by
6767 \c{ST0} and stores the result in \c{ST0}, whereas if \c{TO} is given
6768 it divides \c{ST0} by its operand and stores the result in the
6771 \c{FDIVP} operates like \c{FDIV TO}, but pops the register stack
6772 once it has finished. \c{FDIVRP} operates like \c{FDIVR TO}, but
6773 pops the register stack once it has finished.
6776 \H{insFEMMS} \i\c{FEMMS}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
6778 \c FEMMS 0,0,0 ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
6780 3dnow instruction (duh!)
6783 \H{insFFREE} \i\c{FFREE}: Flag Floating-Point Register as Unused
6785 \c FFREE fpureg ; DD C0+r [8086,FPU]
6787 \c{FFREE} marks the given register as being empty.
6789 \H{insFIADD} \i\c{FIADD}: Floating-Point/Integer Addition
6791 \c FIADD mem16 ; DE /0 [8086,FPU]
6792 \c FIADD mem32 ; DA /0 [8086,FPU]
6794 \c{FIADD} adds the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in the given
6795 memory location to \c{ST0}, storing the result in \c{ST0}.
6797 \H{insFICOM} \i\c{FICOM}, \i\c{FICOMP}: Floating-Point/Integer Compare
6799 \c FICOM mem16 ; DE /2 [8086,FPU]
6800 \c FICOM mem32 ; DA /2 [8086,FPU]
6802 \c FICOMP mem16 ; DE /3 [8086,FPU]
6803 \c FICOMP mem32 ; DA /3 [8086,FPU]
6805 \c{FICOM} compares \c{ST0} with the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored
6806 in the given memory location, and sets the FPU flags accordingly.
6807 \c{FICOMP} does the same, but pops the register stack afterwards.
6809 \H{insFIDIV} \i\c{FIDIV}, \i\c{FIDIVR}: Floating-Point/Integer Division
6811 \c FIDIV mem16 ; DE /6 [8086,FPU]
6812 \c FIDIV mem32 ; DA /6 [8086,FPU]
6814 \c FIDIVR mem16 ; DE /0 [8086,FPU]
6815 \c FIDIVR mem32 ; DA /0 [8086,FPU]
6817 \c{FIDIV} divides \c{ST0} by the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in
6818 the given memory location, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
6819 \c{FIDIVR} does the division the other way up: it divides the
6820 integer by \c{ST0}, but still stores the result in \c{ST0}.
6822 \H{insFILD} \i\c{FILD}, \i\c{FIST}, \i\c{FISTP}: Floating-Point/Integer Conversion
6824 \c FILD mem16 ; DF /0 [8086,FPU]
6825 \c FILD mem32 ; DB /0 [8086,FPU]
6826 \c FILD mem64 ; DF /5 [8086,FPU]
6828 \c FIST mem16 ; DF /2 [8086,FPU]
6829 \c FIST mem32 ; DB /2 [8086,FPU]
6831 \c FISTP mem16 ; DF /3 [8086,FPU]
6832 \c FISTP mem32 ; DB /3 [8086,FPU]
6833 \c FISTP mem64 ; DF /0 [8086,FPU]
6835 \c{FILD} loads an integer out of a memory location, converts it to a
6836 real, and pushes it on the FPU register stack. \c{FIST} converts
6837 \c{ST0} to an integer and stores that in memory; \c{FISTP} does the
6838 same as \c{FIST}, but pops the register stack afterwards.
6840 \H{insFIMUL} \i\c{FIMUL}: Floating-Point/Integer Multiplication
6842 \c FIMUL mem16 ; DE /1 [8086,FPU]
6843 \c FIMUL mem32 ; DA /1 [8086,FPU]
6845 \c{FIMUL} multiplies \c{ST0} by the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored
6846 in the given memory location, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
6848 \H{insFINCSTP} \i\c{FINCSTP}: Increment Floating-Point Stack Pointer
6850 \c FINCSTP ; D9 F7 [8086,FPU]
6852 \c{FINCSTP} increments the `top' field in the floating-point status
6853 word. This has the effect of rotating the FPU register stack by one,
6854 as if the register stack had been popped; however, unlike the
6855 popping of the stack performed by many FPU instructions, it does not
6856 flag the new \c{ST7} (previously \c{ST0}) as empty. See also
6857 \c{FDECSTP} (\k{insFDECSTP}).
6859 \H{insFINIT} \i\c{FINIT}, \i\c{FNINIT}: Initialise Floating-Point Unit
6861 \c FINIT ; 9B DB E3 [8086,FPU]
6862 \c FNINIT ; DB E3 [8086,FPU]
6864 \c{FINIT} initialises the FPU to its default state. It flags all
6865 registers as empty, though it does not actually change their values.
6866 \c{FNINIT} does the same, without first waiting for pending
6867 exceptions to clear.
6869 \H{insFISUB} \i\c{FISUB}: Floating-Point/Integer Subtraction
6871 \c FISUB mem16 ; DE /4 [8086,FPU]
6872 \c FISUB mem32 ; DA /4 [8086,FPU]
6874 \c FISUBR mem16 ; DE /5 [8086,FPU]
6875 \c FISUBR mem32 ; DA /5 [8086,FPU]
6877 \c{FISUB} subtracts the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in the given
6878 memory location from \c{ST0}, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
6879 \c{FISUBR} does the subtraction the other way round, i.e. it
6880 subtracts \c{ST0} from the given integer, but still stores the
6883 \H{insFLD} \i\c{FLD}: Floating-Point Load
6885 \c FLD mem32 ; D9 /0 [8086,FPU]
6886 \c FLD mem64 ; DD /0 [8086,FPU]
6887 \c FLD mem80 ; DB /5 [8086,FPU]
6888 \c FLD fpureg ; D9 C0+r [8086,FPU]
6890 \c{FLD} loads a floating-point value out of the given register or
6891 memory location, and pushes it on the FPU register stack.
6893 \H{insFLD1} \i\c{FLDxx}: Floating-Point Load Constants
6895 \c FLD1 ; D9 E8 [8086,FPU]
6896 \c FLDL2E ; D9 EA [8086,FPU]
6897 \c FLDL2T ; D9 E9 [8086,FPU]
6898 \c FLDLG2 ; D9 EC [8086,FPU]
6899 \c FLDLN2 ; D9 ED [8086,FPU]
6900 \c FLDPI ; D9 EB [8086,FPU]
6901 \c FLDZ ; D9 EE [8086,FPU]
6903 These instructions push specific standard constants on the FPU
6904 register stack. \c{FLD1} pushes the value 1; \c{FLDL2E} pushes the
6905 base-2 logarithm of e; \c{FLDL2T} pushes the base-2 log of 10;
6906 \c{FLDLG2} pushes the base-10 log of 2; \c{FLDLN2} pushes the base-e
6907 log of 2; \c{FLDPI} pushes pi; and \c{FLDZ} pushes zero.
6909 \H{insFLDCW} \i\c{FLDCW}: Load Floating-Point Control Word
6911 \c FLDCW mem16 ; D9 /5 [8086,FPU]
6913 \c{FLDCW} loads a 16-bit value out of memory and stores it into the
6914 FPU control word (governing things like the rounding mode, the
6915 precision, and the exception masks). See also \c{FSTCW}
6918 \H{insFLDENV} \i\c{FLDENV}: Load Floating-Point Environment
6920 \c FLDENV mem ; D9 /4 [8086,FPU]
6922 \c{FLDENV} loads the FPU operating environment (control word, status
6923 word, tag word, instruction pointer, data pointer and last opcode)
6924 from memory. The memory area is 14 or 28 bytes long, depending on
6925 the CPU mode at the time. See also \c{FSTENV} (\k{insFSTENV}).
6927 \H{insFMUL} \i\c{FMUL}, \i\c{FMULP}: Floating-Point Multiply
6929 \c FMUL mem32 ; D8 /1 [8086,FPU]
6930 \c FMUL mem64 ; DC /1 [8086,FPU]
6932 \c FMUL fpureg ; D8 C8+r [8086,FPU]
6933 \c FMUL ST0,fpureg ; D8 C8+r [8086,FPU]
6935 \c FMUL TO fpureg ; DC C8+r [8086,FPU]
6936 \c FMUL fpureg,ST0 ; DC C8+r [8086,FPU]
6938 \c FMULP fpureg ; DE C8+r [8086,FPU]
6939 \c FMULP fpureg,ST0 ; DE C8+r [8086,FPU]
6941 \c{FMUL} multiplies \c{ST0} by the given operand, and stores the
6942 result in \c{ST0}, unless the \c{TO} qualifier is used in which case
6943 it stores the result in the operand. \c{FMULP} performs the same
6944 operation as \c{FMUL TO}, and then pops the register stack.
6946 \H{insFNOP} \i\c{FNOP}: Floating-Point No Operation
6948 \c FNOP ; D9 D0 [8086,FPU]
6950 \c{FNOP} does nothing.
6952 \H{insFPATAN} \i\c{FPATAN}, \i\c{FPTAN}: Arctangent and Tangent
6954 \c FPATAN ; D9 F3 [8086,FPU]
6955 \c FPTAN ; D9 F2 [8086,FPU]
6957 \c{FPATAN} computes the arctangent, in radians, of the result of
6958 dividing \c{ST1} by \c{ST0}, stores the result in \c{ST1}, and pops
6959 the register stack. It works like the C \c{atan2} function, in that
6960 changing the sign of both \c{ST0} and \c{ST1} changes the output
6961 value by pi (so it performs true rectangular-to-polar coordinate
6962 conversion, with \c{ST1} being the Y coordinate and \c{ST0} being
6963 the X coordinate, not merely an arctangent).
6965 \c{FPTAN} computes the tangent of the value in \c{ST0} (in radians),
6966 and stores the result back into \c{ST0}.
6968 \H{insFPREM} \i\c{FPREM}, \i\c{FPREM1}: Floating-Point Partial Remainder
6970 \c FPREM ; D9 F8 [8086,FPU]
6971 \c FPREM1 ; D9 F5 [386,FPU]
6973 These instructions both produce the remainder obtained by dividing
6974 \c{ST0} by \c{ST1}. This is calculated, notionally, by dividing
6975 \c{ST0} by \c{ST1}, rounding the result to an integer, multiplying
6976 by \c{ST1} again, and computing the value which would need to be
6977 added back on to the result to get back to the original value in
6980 The two instructions differ in the way the notional round-to-integer
6981 operation is performed. \c{FPREM} does it by rounding towards zero,
6982 so that the remainder it returns always has the same sign as the
6983 original value in \c{ST0}; \c{FPREM1} does it by rounding to the
6984 nearest integer, so that the remainder always has at most half the
6985 magnitude of \c{ST1}.
6987 Both instructions calculate \e{partial} remainders, meaning that
6988 they may not manage to provide the final result, but might leave
6989 intermediate results in \c{ST0} instead. If this happens, they will
6990 set the C2 flag in the FPU status word; therefore, to calculate a
6991 remainder, you should repeatedly execute \c{FPREM} or \c{FPREM1}
6992 until C2 becomes clear.
6994 \H{insFRNDINT} \i\c{FRNDINT}: Floating-Point Round to Integer
6996 \c FRNDINT ; D9 FC [8086,FPU]
6998 \c{FRNDINT} rounds the contents of \c{ST0} to an integer, according
6999 to the current rounding mode set in the FPU control word, and stores
7000 the result back in \c{ST0}.
7002 \H{insFRSTOR} \i\c{FSAVE}, \i\c{FRSTOR}: Save/Restore Floating-Point State
7004 \c FSAVE mem ; 9B DD /6 [8086,FPU]
7005 \c FNSAVE mem ; DD /6 [8086,FPU]
7007 \c FRSTOR mem ; DD /4 [8086,FPU]
7009 \c{FSAVE} saves the entire floating-point unit state, including all
7010 the information saved by \c{FSTENV} (\k{insFSTENV}) plus the
7011 contents of all the registers, to a 94 or 108 byte area of memory
7012 (depending on the CPU mode). \c{FRSTOR} restores the floating-point
7013 state from the same area of memory.
7015 \c{FNSAVE} does the same as \c{FSAVE}, without first waiting for
7016 pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
7018 \H{insFSCALE} \i\c{FSCALE}: Scale Floating-Point Value by Power of Two
7020 \c FSCALE ; D9 FD [8086,FPU]
7022 \c{FSCALE} scales a number by a power of two: it rounds \c{ST1}
7023 towards zero to obtain an integer, then multiplies \c{ST0} by two to
7024 the power of that integer, and stores the result in \c{ST0}.
7026 \H{insFSETPM} \i\c{FSETPM}: Set Protected Mode
7028 \c FSETPM ; DB E4 [286,FPU]
7030 This instruction initalises protected mode on the 287 floating-point
7031 coprocessor. It is only meaningful on that processor: the 387 and
7032 above treat the instruction as a no-operation.
7034 \H{insFSIN} \i\c{FSIN}, \i\c{FSINCOS}: Sine and Cosine
7036 \c FSIN ; D9 FE [386,FPU]
7037 \c FSINCOS ; D9 FB [386,FPU]
7039 \c{FSIN} calculates the sine of \c{ST0} (in radians) and stores the
7040 result in \c{ST0}. \c{FSINCOS} does the same, but then pushes the
7041 cosine of the same value on the register stack, so that the sine
7042 ends up in \c{ST1} and the cosine in \c{ST0}. \c{FSINCOS} is faster
7043 than executing \c{FSIN} and \c{FCOS} (see \k{insFCOS}) in
7046 \H{insFSQRT} \i\c{FSQRT}: Floating-Point Square Root
7048 \c FSQRT ; D9 FA [8086,FPU]
7050 \c{FSQRT} calculates the square root of \c{ST0} and stores the
7053 \H{insFST} \i\c{FST}, \i\c{FSTP}: Floating-Point Store
7055 \c FST mem32 ; D9 /2 [8086,FPU]
7056 \c FST mem64 ; DD /2 [8086,FPU]
7057 \c FST fpureg ; DD D0+r [8086,FPU]
7059 \c FSTP mem32 ; D9 /3 [8086,FPU]
7060 \c FSTP mem64 ; DD /3 [8086,FPU]
7061 \c FSTP mem80 ; DB /0 [8086,FPU]
7062 \c FSTP fpureg ; DD D8+r [8086,FPU]
7064 \c{FST} stores the value in \c{ST0} into the given memory location
7065 or other FPU register. \c{FSTP} does the same, but then pops the
7068 \H{insFSTCW} \i\c{FSTCW}: Store Floating-Point Control Word
7070 \c FSTCW mem16 ; 9B D9 /0 [8086,FPU]
7071 \c FNSTCW mem16 ; D9 /0 [8086,FPU]
7073 \c{FSTCW} stores the FPU control word (governing things like the
7074 rounding mode, the precision, and the exception masks) into a 2-byte
7075 memory area. See also \c{FLDCW} (\k{insFLDCW}).
7077 \c{FNSTCW} does the same thing as \c{FSTCW}, without first waiting
7078 for pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
7080 \H{insFSTENV} \i\c{FSTENV}: Store Floating-Point Environment
7082 \c FSTENV mem ; 9B D9 /6 [8086,FPU]
7083 \c FNSTENV mem ; D9 /6 [8086,FPU]
7085 \c{FSTENV} stores the FPU operating environment (control word,
7086 status word, tag word, instruction pointer, data pointer and last
7087 opcode) into memory. The memory area is 14 or 28 bytes long,
7088 depending on the CPU mode at the time. See also \c{FLDENV}
7091 \c{FNSTENV} does the same thing as \c{FSTENV}, without first waiting
7092 for pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
7094 \H{insFSTSW} \i\c{FSTSW}: Store Floating-Point Status Word
7096 \c FSTSW mem16 ; 9B DD /0 [8086,FPU]
7097 \c FSTSW AX ; 9B DF E0 [286,FPU]
7099 \c FNSTSW mem16 ; DD /0 [8086,FPU]
7100 \c FNSTSW AX ; DF E0 [286,FPU]
7102 \c{FSTSW} stores the FPU status word into \c{AX} or into a 2-byte
7105 \c{FNSTSW} does the same thing as \c{FSTSW}, without first waiting
7106 for pending floating-point exceptions to clear.
7108 \H{insFSUB} \i\c{FSUB}, \i\c{FSUBP}, \i\c{FSUBR}, \i\c{FSUBRP}: Floating-Point Subtract
7110 \c FSUB mem32 ; D8 /4 [8086,FPU]
7111 \c FSUB mem64 ; DC /4 [8086,FPU]
7113 \c FSUB fpureg ; D8 E0+r [8086,FPU]
7114 \c FSUB ST0,fpureg ; D8 E0+r [8086,FPU]
7116 \c FSUB TO fpureg ; DC E8+r [8086,FPU]
7117 \c FSUB fpureg,ST0 ; DC E8+r [8086,FPU]
7119 \c FSUBR mem32 ; D8 /5 [8086,FPU]
7120 \c FSUBR mem64 ; DC /5 [8086,FPU]
7122 \c FSUBR fpureg ; D8 E8+r [8086,FPU]
7123 \c FSUBR ST0,fpureg ; D8 E8+r [8086,FPU]
7125 \c FSUBR TO fpureg ; DC E0+r [8086,FPU]
7126 \c FSUBR fpureg,ST0 ; DC E0+r [8086,FPU]
7128 \c FSUBP fpureg ; DE E8+r [8086,FPU]
7129 \c FSUBP fpureg,ST0 ; DE E8+r [8086,FPU]
7131 \c FSUBRP fpureg ; DE E0+r [8086,FPU]
7132 \c FSUBRP fpureg,ST0 ; DE E0+r [8086,FPU]
7134 \c{FSUB} subtracts the given operand from \c{ST0} and stores the
7135 result back in \c{ST0}, unless the \c{TO} qualifier is given, in
7136 which case it subtracts \c{ST0} from the given operand and stores
7137 the result in the operand.
7139 \c{FSUBR} does the same thing, but does the subtraction the other way
7140 up: so if \c{TO} is not given, it subtracts \c{ST0} from the given
7141 operand and stores the result in \c{ST0}, whereas if \c{TO} is given
7142 it subtracts its operand from \c{ST0} and stores the result in the
7145 \c{FSUBP} operates like \c{FSUB TO}, but pops the register stack
7146 once it has finished. \c{FSUBRP} operates like \c{FSUBR TO}, but
7147 pops the register stack once it has finished.
7149 \H{insFTST} \i\c{FTST}: Test \c{ST0} Against Zero
7151 \c FTST ; D9 E4 [8086,FPU]
7153 \c{FTST} compares \c{ST0} with zero and sets the FPU flags
7154 accordingly. \c{ST0} is treated as the left-hand side of the
7155 comparison, so that a `less-than' result is generated if \c{ST0} is
7158 \H{insFUCOM} \i\c{FUCOMxx}: Floating-Point Unordered Compare
7160 \c FUCOM fpureg ; DD E0+r [386,FPU]
7161 \c FUCOM ST0,fpureg ; DD E0+r [386,FPU]
7163 \c FUCOMP fpureg ; DD E8+r [386,FPU]
7164 \c FUCOMP ST0,fpureg ; DD E8+r [386,FPU]
7166 \c FUCOMPP ; DA E9 [386,FPU]
7168 \c FUCOMI fpureg ; DB E8+r [P6,FPU]
7169 \c FUCOMI ST0,fpureg ; DB E8+r [P6,FPU]
7171 \c FUCOMIP fpureg ; DF E8+r [P6,FPU]
7172 \c FUCOMIP ST0,fpureg ; DF E8+r [P6,FPU]
7174 \c{FUCOM} compares \c{ST0} with the given operand, and sets the FPU
7175 flags accordingly. \c{ST0} is treated as the left-hand side of the
7176 comparison, so that the carry flag is set (for a `less-than' result)
7177 if \c{ST0} is less than the given operand.
7179 \c{FUCOMP} does the same as \c{FUCOM}, but pops the register stack
7180 afterwards. \c{FUCOMPP} compares \c{ST0} with \c{ST1} and then pops
7181 the register stack twice.
7183 \c{FUCOMI} and \c{FUCOMIP} work like the corresponding forms of
7184 \c{FUCOM} and \c{FUCOMP}, but write their results directly to the CPU
7185 flags register rather than the FPU status word, so they can be
7186 immediately followed by conditional jump or conditional move
7189 The \c{FUCOM} instructions differ from the \c{FCOM} instructions
7190 (\k{insFCOM}) only in the way they handle quiet NaNs: \c{FUCOM} will
7191 handle them silently and set the condition code flags to an
7192 `unordered' result, whereas \c{FCOM} will generate an exception.
7194 \H{insFXAM} \i\c{FXAM}: Examine Class of Value in \c{ST0}
7196 \c FXAM ; D9 E5 [8086,FPU]
7198 \c{FXAM} sets the FPU flags C3, C2 and C0 depending on the type of
7199 value stored in \c{ST0}: 000 (respectively) for an unsupported
7200 format, 001 for a NaN, 010 for a normal finite number, 011 for an
7201 infinity, 100 for a zero, 101 for an empty register, and 110 for a
7202 denormal. It also sets the C1 flag to the sign of the number.
7204 \H{insFXCH} \i\c{FXCH}: Floating-Point Exchange
7206 \c FXCH ; D9 C9 [8086,FPU]
7207 \c FXCH fpureg ; D9 C8+r [8086,FPU]
7208 \c FXCH fpureg,ST0 ; D9 C8+r [8086,FPU]
7209 \c FXCH ST0,fpureg ; D9 C8+r [8086,FPU]
7211 \c{FXCH} exchanges \c{ST0} with a given FPU register. The no-operand
7212 form exchanges \c{ST0} with \c{ST1}.
7214 \H{insFXRSTOR} \i\c{FXRSTOR}: Restore FP and MMXTM State and
7215 Streaming SIMD Extension State
7217 \c FXRSTOR memory ; 0F,AE,/1 [P6,SSE,FPU]
7219 \c{FXRSTOR}The FXRSTOR instruction reloads the FP and MMXTM technology
7220 state, and the Streaming SIMD Extension state (environment and registers),
7221 from the memory area defined by m512byte. This data should have been
7222 written by a previous FXSAVE.
7225 \H{insFXSAVE} \i\c{FXSAVE}: Store FP and MMXTM State
7228 \c FXSAVE memory ; 0F,AE,/0 [P6,SSE,FPU]
7231 \c{FXSAVE}The FXSAVE instruction writes the current FP and
7232 MMXTM technology state, and Streaming SIMD Extension state
7233 (environment and registers), to the specified destination
7234 defined by m512byte. It does this without checking for pending
7235 unmasked floating-point exceptions (similar to the operation of
7236 FNSAVE). Unlike the FSAVE/FNSAVE instructions, the processor
7237 retains the contents of the FP and MMXTM technology state and
7238 Streaming SIMD Extension state in the processor after the state
7239 has been saved. This instruction has been optimized to maximize
7240 floating-point save performance.
7243 \H{insFXTRACT} \i\c{FXTRACT}: Extract Exponent and Significand
7245 \c FXTRACT ; D9 F4 [8086,FPU]
7247 \c{FXTRACT} separates the number in \c{ST0} into its exponent and
7248 significand (mantissa), stores the exponent back into \c{ST0}, and
7249 then pushes the significand on the register stack (so that the
7250 significand ends up in \c{ST0}, and the exponent in \c{ST1}).
7252 \H{insFYL2X} \i\c{FYL2X}, \i\c{FYL2XP1}: Compute Y times Log2(X) or Log2(X+1)
7254 \c FYL2X ; D9 F1 [8086,FPU]
7255 \c FYL2XP1 ; D9 F9 [8086,FPU]
7257 \c{FYL2X} multiplies \c{ST1} by the base-2 logarithm of \c{ST0},
7258 stores the result in \c{ST1}, and pops the register stack (so that
7259 the result ends up in \c{ST0}). \c{ST0} must be non-zero and
7262 \c{FYL2XP1} works the same way, but replacing the base-2 log of
7263 \c{ST0} with that of \c{ST0} plus one. This time, \c{ST0} must have
7264 magnitude no greater than 1 minus half the square root of two.
7266 \H{insHLT} \i\c{HLT}: Halt Processor
7270 \c{HLT} puts the processor into a halted state, where it will
7271 perform no more operations until restarted by an interrupt or a
7274 \H{insIBTS} \i\c{IBTS}: Insert Bit String
7276 \c IBTS r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F A7 /r [386,UNDOC]
7277 \c IBTS r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F A7 /r [386,UNDOC]
7279 No clear documentation seems to be available for this instruction:
7280 the best I've been able to find reads `Takes a string of bits from
7281 the second operand and puts them in the first operand'. It is
7282 present only in early 386 processors, and conflicts with the opcodes
7283 for \c{CMPXCHG486}. NASM supports it only for completeness. Its
7284 counterpart is \c{XBTS} (see \k{insXBTS}).
7286 \H{insIDIV} \i\c{IDIV}: Signed Integer Divide
7288 \c IDIV r/m8 ; F6 /7 [8086]
7289 \c IDIV r/m16 ; o16 F7 /7 [8086]
7290 \c IDIV r/m32 ; o32 F7 /7 [386]
7292 \c{IDIV} performs signed integer division. The explicit operand
7293 provided is the divisor; the dividend and destination operands are
7294 implicit, in the following way:
7296 \b For \c{IDIV r/m8}, \c{AX} is divided by the given operand; the
7297 quotient is stored in \c{AL} and the remainder in \c{AH}.
7299 \b For \c{IDIV r/m16}, \c{DX:AX} is divided by the given operand; the
7300 quotient is stored in \c{AX} and the remainder in \c{DX}.
7302 \b For \c{IDIV r/m32}, \c{EDX:EAX} is divided by the given operand;
7303 the quotient is stored in \c{EAX} and the remainder in \c{EDX}.
7305 Unsigned integer division is performed by the \c{DIV} instruction:
7308 \H{insIMUL} \i\c{IMUL}: Signed Integer Multiply
7310 \c IMUL r/m8 ; F6 /5 [8086]
7311 \c IMUL r/m16 ; o16 F7 /5 [8086]
7312 \c IMUL r/m32 ; o32 F7 /5 [386]
7314 \c IMUL reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F AF /r [386]
7315 \c IMUL reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F AF /r [386]
7317 \c IMUL reg16,imm8 ; o16 6B /r ib [286]
7318 \c IMUL reg16,imm16 ; o16 69 /r iw [286]
7319 \c IMUL reg32,imm8 ; o32 6B /r ib [386]
7320 \c IMUL reg32,imm32 ; o32 69 /r id [386]
7322 \c IMUL reg16,r/m16,imm8 ; o16 6B /r ib [286]
7323 \c IMUL reg16,r/m16,imm16 ; o16 69 /r iw [286]
7324 \c IMUL reg32,r/m32,imm8 ; o32 6B /r ib [386]
7325 \c IMUL reg32,r/m32,imm32 ; o32 69 /r id [386]
7327 \c{IMUL} performs signed integer multiplication. For the
7328 single-operand form, the other operand and destination are implicit,
7329 in the following way:
7331 \b For \c{IMUL r/m8}, \c{AL} is multiplied by the given operand; the
7332 product is stored in \c{AX}.
7334 \b For \c{IMUL r/m16}, \c{AX} is multiplied by the given operand;
7335 the product is stored in \c{DX:AX}.
7337 \b For \c{IMUL r/m32}, \c{EAX} is multiplied by the given operand;
7338 the product is stored in \c{EDX:EAX}.
7340 The two-operand form multiplies its two operands and stores the
7341 result in the destination (first) operand. The three-operand form
7342 multiplies its last two operands and stores the result in the first
7345 The two-operand form is in fact a shorthand for the three-operand
7346 form, as can be seen by examining the opcode descriptions: in the
7347 two-operand form, the code \c{/r} takes both its register and
7348 \c{r/m} parts from the same operand (the first one).
7350 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate operand and another longer
7351 source operand, the immediate operand is considered to be signed,
7352 and is sign-extended to the length of the other source operand. In
7353 these cases, the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to
7354 generate this form of the instruction.
7356 Unsigned integer multiplication is performed by the \c{MUL}
7357 instruction: see \k{insMUL}.
7359 \H{insIN} \i\c{IN}: Input from I/O Port
7361 \c IN AL,imm8 ; E4 ib [8086]
7362 \c IN AX,imm8 ; o16 E5 ib [8086]
7363 \c IN EAX,imm8 ; o32 E5 ib [386]
7364 \c IN AL,DX ; EC [8086]
7365 \c IN AX,DX ; o16 ED [8086]
7366 \c IN EAX,DX ; o32 ED [386]
7368 \c{IN} reads a byte, word or doubleword from the specified I/O port,
7369 and stores it in the given destination register. The port number may
7370 be specified as an immediate value if it is between 0 and 255, and
7371 otherwise must be stored in \c{DX}. See also \c{OUT} (\k{insOUT}).
7373 \H{insINC} \i\c{INC}: Increment Integer
7375 \c INC reg16 ; o16 40+r [8086]
7376 \c INC reg32 ; o32 40+r [386]
7377 \c INC r/m8 ; FE /0 [8086]
7378 \c INC r/m16 ; o16 FF /0 [8086]
7379 \c INC r/m32 ; o32 FF /0 [386]
7381 \c{INC} adds 1 to its operand. It does \e{not} affect the carry
7382 flag: to affect the carry flag, use \c{ADD something,1} (see
7383 \k{insADD}). See also \c{DEC} (\k{insDEC}).
7385 \H{insINSB} \i\c{INSB}, \i\c{INSW}, \i\c{INSD}: Input String from I/O Port
7388 \c INSW ; o16 6D [186]
7389 \c INSD ; o32 6D [386]
7391 \c{INSB} inputs a byte from the I/O port specified in \c{DX} and
7392 stores it at \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]}. It then increments or
7393 decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag
7394 is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{DI} or \c{EDI}.
7396 The register used is \c{DI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
7397 \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
7398 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
7399 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
7401 Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
7402 use of \c{ES} for the load from \c{[DI]} or \c{[EDI]} cannot be
7405 \c{INSW} and \c{INSD} work in the same way, but they input a word or
7406 a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
7407 addressing register by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
7409 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
7410 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
7412 See also \c{OUTSB}, \c{OUTSW} and \c{OUTSD} (\k{insOUTSB}).
7414 \H{insINT} \i\c{INT}: Software Interrupt
7416 \c INT imm8 ; CD ib [8086]
7418 \c{INT} causes a software interrupt through a specified vector
7419 number from 0 to 255.
7421 The code generated by the \c{INT} instruction is always two bytes
7422 long: although there are short forms for some \c{INT} instructions,
7423 NASM does not generate them when it sees the \c{INT} mnemonic. In
7424 order to generate single-byte breakpoint instructions, use the
7425 \c{INT3} or \c{INT1} instructions (see \k{insINT1}) instead.
7427 \H{insINT1} \i\c{INT3}, \i\c{INT1}, \i\c{ICEBP}, \i\c{INT01}: Breakpoints
7435 \c{INT1} and \c{INT3} are short one-byte forms of the instructions
7436 \c{INT 1} and \c{INT 3} (see \k{insINT}). They perform a similar
7437 function to their longer counterparts, but take up less code space.
7438 They are used as breakpoints by debuggers.
7440 \c{INT1}, and its alternative synonyms \c{INT01} and \c{ICEBP}, is
7441 an instruction used by in-circuit emulators (ICEs). It is present,
7442 though not documented, on some processors down to the 286, but is
7443 only documented for the Pentium Pro. \c{INT3} is the instruction
7444 normally used as a breakpoint by debuggers.
7446 \c{INT3} is not precisely equivalent to \c{INT 3}: the short form,
7447 since it is designed to be used as a breakpoint, bypasses the normal
7448 IOPL checks in virtual-8086 mode, and also does not go through
7449 interrupt redirection.
7451 \H{insINTO} \i\c{INTO}: Interrupt if Overflow
7455 \c{INTO} performs an \c{INT 4} software interrupt (see \k{insINT})
7456 if and only if the overflow flag is set.
7458 \H{insINVD} \i\c{INVD}: Invalidate Internal Caches
7460 \c INVD ; 0F 08 [486]
7462 \c{INVD} invalidates and empties the processor's internal caches,
7463 and causes the processor to instruct external caches to do the same.
7464 It does not write the contents of the caches back to memory first:
7465 any modified data held in the caches will be lost. To write the data
7466 back first, use \c{WBINVD} (\k{insWBINVD}).
7468 \H{insINVLPG} \i\c{INVLPG}: Invalidate TLB Entry
7470 \c INVLPG mem ; 0F 01 /0 [486]
7472 \c{INVLPG} invalidates the translation lookahead buffer (TLB) entry
7473 associated with the supplied memory address.
7475 \H{insIRET} \i\c{IRET}, \i\c{IRETW}, \i\c{IRETD}: Return from Interrupt
7478 \c IRETW ; o16 CF [8086]
7479 \c IRETD ; o32 CF [386]
7481 \c{IRET} returns from an interrupt (hardware or software) by means
7482 of popping \c{IP} (or \c{EIP}), \c{CS} and the flags off the stack
7483 and then continuing execution from the new \c{CS:IP}.
7485 \c{IRETW} pops \c{IP}, \c{CS} and the flags as 2 bytes each, taking
7486 6 bytes off the stack in total. \c{IRETD} pops \c{EIP} as 4 bytes,
7487 pops a further 4 bytes of which the top two are discarded and the
7488 bottom two go into \c{CS}, and pops the flags as 4 bytes as well,
7489 taking 12 bytes off the stack.
7491 \c{IRET} is a shorthand for either \c{IRETW} or \c{IRETD}, depending
7492 on the default \c{BITS} setting at the time.
7494 \H{insJCXZ} \i\c{JCXZ}, \i\c{JECXZ}: Jump if CX/ECX Zero
7496 \c JCXZ imm ; a16 E3 rb [8086]
7497 \c JECXZ imm ; a32 E3 rb [386]
7499 \c{JCXZ} performs a short jump (with maximum range 128 bytes) if and
7500 only if the contents of the \c{CX} register is 0. \c{JECXZ} does the
7501 same thing, but with \c{ECX}.
7503 \H{insJMP} \i\c{JMP}: Jump
7505 \c JMP imm ; E9 rw/rd [8086]
7506 \c JMP SHORT imm ; EB rb [8086]
7507 \c JMP imm:imm16 ; o16 EA iw iw [8086]
7508 \c JMP imm:imm32 ; o32 EA id iw [386]
7509 \c JMP FAR mem ; o16 FF /5 [8086]
7510 \c JMP FAR mem ; o32 FF /5 [386]
7511 \c JMP r/m16 ; o16 FF /4 [8086]
7512 \c JMP r/m32 ; o32 FF /4 [386]
7514 \c{JMP} jumps to a given address. The address may be specified as an
7515 absolute segment and offset, or as a relative jump within the
7518 \c{JMP SHORT imm} has a maximum range of 128 bytes, since the
7519 displacement is specified as only 8 bits, but takes up less code
7520 space. NASM does not choose when to generate \c{JMP SHORT} for you:
7521 you must explicitly code \c{SHORT} every time you want a short jump.
7523 You can choose between the two immediate \i{far jump} forms (\c{JMP
7524 imm:imm}) by the use of the \c{WORD} and \c{DWORD} keywords: \c{JMP
7525 WORD 0x1234:0x5678}) or \c{JMP DWORD 0x1234:0x56789abc}.
7527 The \c{JMP FAR mem} forms execute a far jump by loading the
7528 destination address out of memory. The address loaded consists of 16
7529 or 32 bits of offset (depending on the operand size), and 16 bits of
7530 segment. The operand size may be overridden using \c{JMP WORD FAR
7531 mem} or \c{JMP DWORD FAR mem}.
7533 The \c{JMP r/m} forms execute a \i{near jump} (within the same
7534 segment), loading the destination address out of memory or out of a
7535 register. The keyword \c{NEAR} may be specified, for clarity, in
7536 these forms, but is not necessary. Again, operand size can be
7537 overridden using \c{JMP WORD mem} or \c{JMP DWORD mem}.
7539 As a convenience, NASM does not require you to jump to a far symbol
7540 by coding the cumbersome \c{JMP SEG routine:routine}, but instead
7541 allows the easier synonym \c{JMP FAR routine}.
7543 The \c{CALL r/m} forms given above are near calls; NASM will accept
7544 the \c{NEAR} keyword (e.g. \c{CALL NEAR [address]}), even though it
7545 is not strictly necessary.
7547 \H{insJcc} \i\c{Jcc}: Conditional Branch
7549 \c Jcc imm ; 70+cc rb [8086]
7550 \c Jcc NEAR imm ; 0F 80+cc rw/rd [386]
7552 The \i{conditional jump} instructions execute a near (same segment)
7553 jump if and only if their conditions are satisfied. For example,
7554 \c{JNZ} jumps only if the zero flag is not set.
7556 The ordinary form of the instructions has only a 128-byte range; the
7557 \c{NEAR} form is a 386 extension to the instruction set, and can
7558 span the full size of a segment. NASM will not override your choice
7559 of jump instruction: if you want \c{Jcc NEAR}, you have to use the
7562 The \c{SHORT} keyword is allowed on the first form of the
7563 instruction, for clarity, but is not necessary.
7565 \H{insLAHF} \i\c{LAHF}: Load AH from Flags
7569 \c{LAHF} sets the \c{AH} register according to the contents of the
7570 low byte of the flags word. See also \c{SAHF} (\k{insSAHF}).
7572 \H{insLAR} \i\c{LAR}: Load Access Rights
7574 \c LAR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 02 /r [286,PRIV]
7575 \c LAR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 02 /r [286,PRIV]
7577 \c{LAR} takes the segment selector specified by its source (second)
7578 operand, finds the corresponding segment descriptor in the GDT or
7579 LDT, and loads the access-rights byte of the descriptor into its
7580 destination (first) operand.
7582 \H{insLDS} \i\c{LDS}, \i\c{LES}, \i\c{LFS}, \i\c{LGS}, \i\c{LSS}: Load Far Pointer
7584 \c LDS reg16,mem ; o16 C5 /r [8086]
7585 \c LDS reg32,mem ; o32 C5 /r [8086]
7587 \c LES reg16,mem ; o16 C4 /r [8086]
7588 \c LES reg32,mem ; o32 C4 /r [8086]
7590 \c LFS reg16,mem ; o16 0F B4 /r [386]
7591 \c LFS reg32,mem ; o32 0F B4 /r [386]
7593 \c LGS reg16,mem ; o16 0F B5 /r [386]
7594 \c LGS reg32,mem ; o32 0F B5 /r [386]
7596 \c LSS reg16,mem ; o16 0F B2 /r [386]
7597 \c LSS reg32,mem ; o32 0F B2 /r [386]
7599 These instructions load an entire far pointer (16 or 32 bits of
7600 offset, plus 16 bits of segment) out of memory in one go. \c{LDS},
7601 for example, loads 16 or 32 bits from the given memory address into
7602 the given register (depending on the size of the register), then
7603 loads the \e{next} 16 bits from memory into \c{DS}. \c{LES},
7604 \c{LFS}, \c{LGS} and \c{LSS} work in the same way but use the other
7608 \H{insLDMXCSR} \i\c{LDMXCSR}: Load Streaming SIMD Extension
7611 \c LDMXCSR memory ; 0F,AE,/2 [KATMAI,SSE,SD]
7613 \c{LDMXCSR} The MXCSR control/status register is used to enable
7614 masked/unmasked exception handling, to set rounding modes, to
7615 set flush-to-zero mode, and to view exception status flags.
7618 \H{insLEA} \i\c{LEA}: Load Effective Address
7620 \c LEA reg16,mem ; o16 8D /r [8086]
7621 \c LEA reg32,mem ; o32 8D /r [8086]
7623 \c{LEA}, despite its syntax, does not access memory. It calculates
7624 the effective address specified by its second operand as if it were
7625 going to load or store data from it, but instead it stores the
7626 calculated address into the register specified by its first operand.
7627 This can be used to perform quite complex calculations (e.g. \c{LEA
7628 EAX,[EBX+ECX*4+100]}) in one instruction.
7630 \c{LEA}, despite being a purely arithmetic instruction which
7631 accesses no memory, still requires square brackets around its second
7632 operand, as if it were a memory reference.
7634 \H{insLEAVE} \i\c{LEAVE}: Destroy Stack Frame
7638 \c{LEAVE} destroys a stack frame of the form created by the
7639 \c{ENTER} instruction (see \k{insENTER}). It is functionally
7640 equivalent to \c{MOV ESP,EBP} followed by \c{POP EBP} (or \c{MOV
7641 SP,BP} followed by \c{POP BP} in 16-bit mode).
7643 \H{insLGDT} \i\c{LGDT}, \i\c{LIDT}, \i\c{LLDT}: Load Descriptor Tables
7645 \c LGDT mem ; 0F 01 /2 [286,PRIV]
7646 \c LIDT mem ; 0F 01 /3 [286,PRIV]
7647 \c LLDT r/m16 ; 0F 00 /2 [286,PRIV]
7649 \c{LGDT} and \c{LIDT} both take a 6-byte memory area as an operand:
7650 they load a 32-bit linear address and a 16-bit size limit from that
7651 area (in the opposite order) into the GDTR (global descriptor table
7652 register) or IDTR (interrupt descriptor table register). These are
7653 the only instructions which directly use \e{linear} addresses,
7654 rather than segment/offset pairs.
7656 \c{LLDT} takes a segment selector as an operand. The processor looks
7657 up that selector in the GDT and stores the limit and base address
7658 given there into the LDTR (local descriptor table register).
7660 See also \c{SGDT}, \c{SIDT} and \c{SLDT} (\k{insSGDT}).
7662 \H{insLMSW} \i\c{LMSW}: Load/Store Machine Status Word
7664 \c LMSW r/m16 ; 0F 01 /6 [286,PRIV]
7666 \c{LMSW} loads the bottom four bits of the source operand into the
7667 bottom four bits of the \c{CR0} control register (or the Machine
7668 Status Word, on 286 processors). See also \c{SMSW} (\k{insSMSW}).
7670 \H{insLOADALL} \i\c{LOADALL}, \i\c{LOADALL286}: Load Processor State
7672 \c LOADALL ; 0F 07 [386,UNDOC]
7673 \c LOADALL286 ; 0F 05 [286,UNDOC]
7675 This instruction, in its two different-opcode forms, is apparently
7676 supported on most 286 processors, some 386 and possibly some 486.
7677 The opcode differs between the 286 and the 386.
7679 The function of the instruction is to load all information relating
7680 to the state of the processor out of a block of memory: on the 286,
7681 this block is located implicitly at absolute address \c{0x800}, and
7682 on the 386 and 486 it is at \c{[ES:EDI]}.
7684 \H{insLODSB} \i\c{LODSB}, \i\c{LODSW}, \i\c{LODSD}: Load from String
7686 \c LODSB ; AC [8086]
7687 \c LODSW ; o16 AD [8086]
7688 \c LODSD ; o32 AD [386]
7690 \c{LODSB} loads a byte from \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} into \c{AL}.
7691 It then increments or decrements (depending on the direction flag:
7692 increments if the flag is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{SI} or
7695 The register used is \c{SI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
7696 \c{ESI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
7697 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
7698 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
7700 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
7701 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
7702 example, \c{es lodsb}).
7704 \c{LODSW} and \c{LODSD} work in the same way, but they load a
7705 word or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement
7706 the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
7708 \H{insLOOP} \i\c{LOOP}, \i\c{LOOPE}, \i\c{LOOPZ}, \i\c{LOOPNE}, \i\c{LOOPNZ}: Loop with Counter
7710 \c LOOP imm ; E2 rb [8086]
7711 \c LOOP imm,CX ; a16 E2 rb [8086]
7712 \c LOOP imm,ECX ; a32 E2 rb [386]
7714 \c LOOPE imm ; E1 rb [8086]
7715 \c LOOPE imm,CX ; a16 E1 rb [8086]
7716 \c LOOPE imm,ECX ; a32 E1 rb [386]
7717 \c LOOPZ imm ; E1 rb [8086]
7718 \c LOOPZ imm,CX ; a16 E1 rb [8086]
7719 \c LOOPZ imm,ECX ; a32 E1 rb [386]
7721 \c LOOPNE imm ; E0 rb [8086]
7722 \c LOOPNE imm,CX ; a16 E0 rb [8086]
7723 \c LOOPNE imm,ECX ; a32 E0 rb [386]
7724 \c LOOPNZ imm ; E0 rb [8086]
7725 \c LOOPNZ imm,CX ; a16 E0 rb [8086]
7726 \c LOOPNZ imm,ECX ; a32 E0 rb [386]
7728 \c{LOOP} decrements its counter register (either \c{CX} or \c{ECX} -
7729 if one is not specified explicitly, the \c{BITS} setting dictates
7730 which is used) by one, and if the counter does not become zero as a
7731 result of this operation, it jumps to the given label. The jump has
7732 a range of 128 bytes.
7734 \c{LOOPE} (or its synonym \c{LOOPZ}) adds the additional condition
7735 that it only jumps if the counter is nonzero \e{and} the zero flag
7736 is set. Similarly, \c{LOOPNE} (and \c{LOOPNZ}) jumps only if the
7737 counter is nonzero and the zero flag is clear.
7739 \H{insLSL} \i\c{LSL}: Load Segment Limit
7741 \c LSL reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 03 /r [286,PRIV]
7742 \c LSL reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 03 /r [286,PRIV]
7744 \c{LSL} is given a segment selector in its source (second) operand;
7745 it computes the segment limit value by loading the segment limit
7746 field from the associated segment descriptor in the GDT or LDT.
7747 (This involves shifting left by 12 bits if the segment limit is
7748 page-granular, and not if it is byte-granular; so you end up with a
7749 byte limit in either case.) The segment limit obtained is then
7750 loaded into the destination (first) operand.
7752 \H{insLTR} \i\c{LTR}: Load Task Register
7754 \c LTR r/m16 ; 0F 00 /3 [286,PRIV]
7756 \c{LTR} looks up the segment base and limit in the GDT or LDT
7757 descriptor specified by the segment selector given as its operand,
7758 and loads them into the Task Register.
7761 \H{insMASKMOVQ} \i\c{MASKMOVQ}: Byte Mask Write
7763 \c MASKMOVQ mmxreg,mmxreg ; 0F,F7,/r [KATMAI,MMX]
7765 \c{MASKMOVQ} Data is stored from the mm1 register to the location
7766 specified by the di/edi register (using DS segment). The size
7767 of the store depends on the address-size attribute. The most
7768 significant bit in each byte of the mask register mm2 is used
7769 to selectively write the data (0 = no write, 1 = write) on a
7773 \H{insMAXPS} \i\c{MAXPS}: Packed Single-FP Maximum
7775 \c MAXPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,5F,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7776 \c MAXPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
7778 \c{MAXPS}The MAXPS instruction returns the maximum SP FP numbers
7779 from XMM1 and XMM2/Mem.If the values being compared are both
7780 zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
7781 (xmm2/m128) is an sNaN, this sNaN is forwarded unchanged
7782 to the destination (i.e., a quieted version of the sNaN
7786 \H{insMAXSS} \i\c{MAXSS}: Scalar Single-FP Maximum
7788 \c MAXSS xmmreg,memory ; F3,0F,5F,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7789 \c MAXSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
7791 \c{MAXSS}The MAXSS instruction returns the maximum SP FP number
7792 from the lower SP FP numbers of XMM1 and XMM2/Mem; the upper
7793 three fields are passed through from xmm1. If the values being
7794 compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) will be returned.
7795 If source2 (xmm2/m128) is an sNaN, this sNaN is forwarded
7796 unchanged to the destination (i.e., a quieted version of the
7797 sNaN is not returned).
7800 \H{insMINPS} \i\c{MINPS}: Packed Single-FP Minimum
7802 \c MINPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,5D,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7803 \c MINPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
7805 \c{MINPS} The MINPS instruction returns the minimum SP FP
7806 numbers from XMM1 and XMM2/Mem. If the values being compared
7807 are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If
7808 source2 (xmm2/m128) is an sNaN, this sNaN is forwarded unchanged
7809 to the destination (i.e., a quieted version of the sNaN is
7813 \H{insMINSS} \i\c{MINSS}: Scalar Single-FP Minimum
7815 \c MINSS xmmreg,memory ; F3,0F,5D,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7816 \c MINSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
7818 \c{MINSS} The MINSS instruction returns the minimum SP FP number
7819 from the lower SP FP numbers from XMM1 and XMM2/Mem; the upper
7820 three fields are passed through from xmm1. If the values being
7821 compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned.
7822 If source2 (xmm2/m128) is an sNaN, this sNaN is forwarded
7823 unchanged to the destination (i.e., a quieted version of the
7824 sNaN is not returned).
7827 \H{insMOV} \i\c{MOV}: Move Data
7829 \c MOV r/m8,reg8 ; 88 /r [8086]
7830 \c MOV r/m16,reg16 ; o16 89 /r [8086]
7831 \c MOV r/m32,reg32 ; o32 89 /r [386]
7832 \c MOV reg8,r/m8 ; 8A /r [8086]
7833 \c MOV reg16,r/m16 ; o16 8B /r [8086]
7834 \c MOV reg32,r/m32 ; o32 8B /r [386]
7836 \c MOV reg8,imm8 ; B0+r ib [8086]
7837 \c MOV reg16,imm16 ; o16 B8+r iw [8086]
7838 \c MOV reg32,imm32 ; o32 B8+r id [386]
7839 \c MOV r/m8,imm8 ; C6 /0 ib [8086]
7840 \c MOV r/m16,imm16 ; o16 C7 /0 iw [8086]
7841 \c MOV r/m32,imm32 ; o32 C7 /0 id [386]
7843 \c MOV AL,memoffs8 ; A0 ow/od [8086]
7844 \c MOV AX,memoffs16 ; o16 A1 ow/od [8086]
7845 \c MOV EAX,memoffs32 ; o32 A1 ow/od [386]
7846 \c MOV memoffs8,AL ; A2 ow/od [8086]
7847 \c MOV memoffs16,AX ; o16 A3 ow/od [8086]
7848 \c MOV memoffs32,EAX ; o32 A3 ow/od [386]
7850 \c MOV r/m16,segreg ; o16 8C /r [8086]
7851 \c MOV r/m32,segreg ; o32 8C /r [386]
7852 \c MOV segreg,r/m16 ; o16 8E /r [8086]
7853 \c MOV segreg,r/m32 ; o32 8E /r [386]
7855 \c MOV reg32,CR0/2/3/4 ; 0F 20 /r [386]
7856 \c MOV reg32,DR0/1/2/3/6/7 ; 0F 21 /r [386]
7857 \c MOV reg32,TR3/4/5/6/7 ; 0F 24 /r [386]
7858 \c MOV CR0/2/3/4,reg32 ; 0F 22 /r [386]
7859 \c MOV DR0/1/2/3/6/7,reg32 ; 0F 23 /r [386]
7860 \c MOV TR3/4/5/6/7,reg32 ; 0F 26 /r [386]
7862 \c{MOV} copies the contents of its source (second) operand into its
7863 destination (first) operand.
7865 In all forms of the \c{MOV} instruction, the two operands are the
7866 same size, except for moving between a segment register and an
7867 \c{r/m32} operand. These instructions are treated exactly like the
7868 corresponding 16-bit equivalent (so that, for example, \c{MOV
7869 DS,EAX} functions identically to \c{MOV DS,AX} but saves a prefix
7870 when in 32-bit mode), except that when a segment register is moved
7871 into a 32-bit destination, the top two bytes of the result are
7874 \c{MOV} may not use \c{CS} as a destination.
7876 \c{CR4} is only a supported register on the Pentium and above.
7878 \H{insMOVAPS} \i\c{MOVAPS}: Move Aligned Four Packed Single-FP
7880 \c MOVAPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,28,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7881 \c MOVAPS memory,xmmreg ; 0F,29,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7882 \c MOVAPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
7883 \c MOVAPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
7885 \c{MOVAPS} The linear address corresponds to the address of the
7886 least-significant byte of the referenced memory data. When a
7887 memory address is indicated, the 16 bytes of data at memory
7888 location m128 are loaded or stored. When the register-register
7889 form of this operation is used, the content of the 128-bit
7890 source register is copied into the 128-bit destination register.
7893 \H{insMOVD} \i\c{MOVD}: Move Doubleword to/from MMX Register
7895 \c MOVD mmxreg,r/m32 ; 0F 6E /r [PENT,MMX]
7896 \c MOVD r/m32,mmxreg ; 0F 7E /r [PENT,MMX]
7898 \c{MOVD} copies 32 bits from its source (second) operand into its
7899 destination (first) operand. When the destination is a 64-bit MMX
7900 register, the top 32 bits are set to zero.
7903 \H{insMOVHLPS} \i\c{MOVHLPS}: High to Low Packed Single-FP
7905 \c MOVHLPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; OF,12,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7907 \c{MOVHLPS} The upper 64-bits of the source register xmm2 are
7908 loaded into the lower 64-bits of the 128-bit register xmm1,
7909 and the upper 64-bits of xmm1 are left unchanged.
7912 \H{insMOVHPS} \i\c{MOVHPS}: Move High Packed Single-FP
7914 \c MOVHPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,16,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7915 \c MOVHPS memory,xmmreg ; 0F,17,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7916 \c MOVHPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,ND]
7918 \c{MOVHPS} The linear address corresponds to the address of the
7919 least-significant byte of the referenced memory data. When the
7920 load form of this operation is used, m64 is loaded into the
7921 upper 64-bits of the 128-bit register xmm, and the lower 64-bits
7925 \H{insMOVMSKPS} \i\c{MOVMSKPS}: Move Mask To Integer
7927 \c MOVMSKPS reg32,xmmreg ; 0F,50,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7929 \c{MOVMSKPS} The MOVMSKPS instruction returns to the integer
7930 register r32 a 4-bit mask formed of the most significant bits
7931 of each SP FP number of its operand.
7934 \H{insMOVNTPS} \i\c{MOVNTPS}: Move Aligned Four Packed Single-FP
7937 \c MOVNTPS memory,xmmreg ; 0F,2B, /r [KATMAI,SSE]
7939 \c{MOVNTPS} The linear address corresponds to the address of the
7940 least-significant byte of the referenced memory data. This store
7941 instruction minimizes cache pollution.
7944 \H{insMOVNTQ} \i\c{MOVNTQ}: Move 64 Bits Non Temporal
7946 \c MOVNTQ memory,mmxreg ; 0F,E7,/r [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
7948 \c{MOVNTQ} The linear address corresponds to the address of the
7949 least-significant byte of the referenced memory data. This store
7950 instruction minimizes cache pollution.
7953 \H{insMOVQ} \i\c{MOVQ}: Move Quadword to/from MMX Register
7955 \c MOVQ mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 6F /r [PENT,MMX]
7956 \c MOVQ r/m64,mmxreg ; 0F 7F /r [PENT,MMX]
7958 \c{MOVQ} copies 64 bits from its source (second) operand into its
7959 destination (first) operand.
7963 \H{insMOVSB} \i\c{MOVSB}, \i\c{MOVSW}, \i\c{MOVSD}: Move String
7965 \c MOVSB ; A4 [8086]
7966 \c MOVSW ; o16 A5 [8086]
7967 \c MOVSD ; o32 A5 [386]
7969 \c{MOVSB} copies the byte at \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} to
7970 \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]}. It then increments or decrements
7971 (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag is clear,
7972 decrements if it is set) \c{SI} and \c{DI} (or \c{ESI} and \c{EDI}).
7974 The registers used are \c{SI} and \c{DI} if the address size is 16
7975 bits, and \c{ESI} and \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use
7976 an address size not equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can
7977 use an explicit \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
7979 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
7980 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
7981 example, \c{es movsb}). The use of \c{ES} for the store to \c{[DI]}
7982 or \c{[EDI]} cannot be overridden.
7984 \c{MOVSW} and \c{MOVSD} work in the same way, but they copy a word
7985 or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
7986 addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
7988 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
7989 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
7991 \H{insMOVSS} \i\c{MOVSS}: Move Scalar Single-FP
7993 \c MOVSS xmmreg,memory ; F3,0F,10,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7994 \c MOVSS memory,xmmreg ; F3,0F,11,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
7995 \c MOVSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
7996 \c MOVSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
7998 \c{MOVSS} The linear address corresponds to the address of
7999 the least-significant byte of the referenced memory data.
8000 When a memory address is indicated, the four bytes of data
8001 at memory location m32 are loaded or stored. When the load
8002 form of this operation is used, the 32 bits from memory are
8003 copied into the lower 32 bits of the 128-bit register xmm,
8004 the 96 most significant bits being cleared.
8007 \H{insMOVSX} \i\c{MOVSX}, \i\c{MOVZX}: Move Data with Sign or Zero Extend
8009 \c MOVSX reg16,r/m8 ; o16 0F BE /r [386]
8010 \c MOVSX reg32,r/m8 ; o32 0F BE /r [386]
8011 \c MOVSX reg32,r/m16 ; o32 0F BF /r [386]
8013 \c MOVZX reg16,r/m8 ; o16 0F B6 /r [386]
8014 \c MOVZX reg32,r/m8 ; o32 0F B6 /r [386]
8015 \c MOVZX reg32,r/m16 ; o32 0F B7 /r [386]
8017 \c{MOVSX} sign-extends its source (second) operand to the length of
8018 its destination (first) operand, and copies the result into the
8019 destination operand. \c{MOVZX} does the same, but zero-extends
8020 rather than sign-extending.
8023 \H{insMOVUPS} \i\c{MOVUPS}: Move Unaligned Four Packed Single-FP
8025 \c MOVUPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,10,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
8026 \c MOVUPS memory,xmmreg ; 0F,11,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
8027 \c MOVUPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
8028 \c MOVUPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
8030 \c{MOVUPS} The linear address corresponds to the address of the
8031 least-significant byte of the referenced memory data. When a
8032 memory address is indicated, the 16 bytes of data at memory
8033 location m128 are loaded to the 128-bit multimedia register
8034 xmm or stored from the 128-bit multimedia register xmm. When
8035 the register-register form of this operation is used, the content
8036 of the 128-bit source register is copied into 128-bit register
8037 xmm. No assumption is made about alignment.
8040 \H{insMUL} \i\c{MUL}: Unsigned Integer Multiply
8042 \c MUL r/m8 ; F6 /4 [8086]
8043 \c MUL r/m16 ; o16 F7 /4 [8086]
8044 \c MUL r/m32 ; o32 F7 /4 [386]
8046 \c{MUL} performs unsigned integer multiplication. The other operand
8047 to the multiplication, and the destination operand, are implicit, in
8050 \b For \c{MUL r/m8}, \c{AL} is multiplied by the given operand; the
8051 product is stored in \c{AX}.
8053 \b For \c{MUL r/m16}, \c{AX} is multiplied by the given operand;
8054 the product is stored in \c{DX:AX}.
8056 \b For \c{MUL r/m32}, \c{EAX} is multiplied by the given operand;
8057 the product is stored in \c{EDX:EAX}.
8059 Signed integer multiplication is performed by the \c{IMUL}
8060 instruction: see \k{insIMUL}.
8062 \H{insMULPS} \i\c{MULPS}: Packed Single-FP Multiply
8064 \c MULPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,59,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
8065 \c MULPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
8068 \c{MULPS} The MULPS instructions multiply the packed SP FP
8069 numbers of both their operands.
8072 \H{insMULSS} \i\c{MULSS}: Scalar Single-FP Multiply
8075 \c MULSS xmmreg,memory ; F3,0F,59,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
8076 \c MULSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
8078 \c{MULSS}The MULSS instructions multiply the lowest SP FP
8079 numbers of both their operands; the upper three fields
8080 are passed through from xmm1.
8083 \H{insNEG} \i\c{NEG}, \i\c{NOT}: Two's and One's Complement
8085 \c NEG r/m8 ; F6 /3 [8086]
8086 \c NEG r/m16 ; o16 F7 /3 [8086]
8087 \c NEG r/m32 ; o32 F7 /3 [386]
8089 \c NOT r/m8 ; F6 /2 [8086]
8090 \c NOT r/m16 ; o16 F7 /2 [8086]
8091 \c NOT r/m32 ; o32 F7 /2 [386]
8093 \c{NEG} replaces the contents of its operand by the two's complement
8094 negation (invert all the bits and then add one) of the original
8095 value. \c{NOT}, similarly, performs one's complement (inverts all
8098 \H{insNOP} \i\c{NOP}: No Operation
8102 \c{NOP} performs no operation. Its opcode is the same as that
8103 generated by \c{XCHG AX,AX} or \c{XCHG EAX,EAX} (depending on the
8104 processor mode; see \k{insXCHG}).
8106 \H{insOR} \i\c{OR}: Bitwise OR
8108 \c OR r/m8,reg8 ; 08 /r [8086]
8109 \c OR r/m16,reg16 ; o16 09 /r [8086]
8110 \c OR r/m32,reg32 ; o32 09 /r [386]
8112 \c OR reg8,r/m8 ; 0A /r [8086]
8113 \c OR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0B /r [8086]
8114 \c OR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0B /r [386]
8116 \c OR r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /1 ib [8086]
8117 \c OR r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /1 iw [8086]
8118 \c OR r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /1 id [386]
8120 \c OR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /1 ib [8086]
8121 \c OR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /1 ib [386]
8123 \c OR AL,imm8 ; 0C ib [8086]
8124 \c OR AX,imm16 ; o16 0D iw [8086]
8125 \c OR EAX,imm32 ; o32 0D id [386]
8127 \c{OR} performs a bitwise OR operation between its two operands
8128 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if at least one of the
8129 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
8130 in the destination (first) operand.
8132 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
8133 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
8134 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
8135 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
8136 form of the instruction.
8138 The MMX instruction \c{POR} (see \k{insPOR}) performs the same
8139 operation on the 64-bit MMX registers.
8141 \H{insORPS} \i\c{ORPS}: Bit-wise Logical OR for Single-FP Data
8143 \c ORPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,56,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
8144 \c ORPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
8146 \c{ORPS} The ORPS instructions return a bit-wise logical
8147 OR between xmm1 and xmm2/mem.
8150 \H{insOUT} \i\c{OUT}: Output Data to I/O Port
8152 \c OUT imm8,AL ; E6 ib [8086]
8153 \c OUT imm8,AX ; o16 E7 ib [8086]
8154 \c OUT imm8,EAX ; o32 E7 ib [386]
8155 \c OUT DX,AL ; EE [8086]
8156 \c OUT DX,AX ; o16 EF [8086]
8157 \c OUT DX,EAX ; o32 EF [386]
8159 \c{OUT} writes the contents of the given source register to the
8160 specified I/O port. The port number may be specified as an immediate
8161 value if it is between 0 and 255, and otherwise must be stored in
8162 \c{DX}. See also \c{IN} (\k{insIN}).
8164 \H{insOUTSB} \i\c{OUTSB}, \i\c{OUTSW}, \i\c{OUTSD}: Output String to I/O Port
8168 \c OUTSW ; o16 6F [186]
8170 \c OUTSD ; o32 6F [386]
8172 \c{OUTSB} loads a byte from \c{[DS:SI]} or \c{[DS:ESI]} and writes
8173 it to the I/O port specified in \c{DX}. It then increments or
8174 decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag
8175 is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{SI} or \c{ESI}.
8177 The register used is \c{SI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
8178 \c{ESI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
8179 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
8180 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
8182 The segment register used to load from \c{[SI]} or \c{[ESI]} can be
8183 overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
8184 example, \c{es outsb}).
8186 \c{OUTSW} and \c{OUTSD} work in the same way, but they output a
8187 word or a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement
8188 the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.
8190 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
8191 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
8193 \H{insPACKSSDW} \i\c{PACKSSDW}, \i\c{PACKSSWB}, \i\c{PACKUSWB}: Pack Data
8195 \c PACKSSDW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 6B /r [PENT,MMX]
8196 \c PACKSSWB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 63 /r [PENT,MMX]
8197 \c PACKUSWB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 67 /r [PENT,MMX]
8199 All these instructions start by forming a notional 128-bit word by
8200 placing the source (second) operand on the left of the destination
8201 (first) operand. \c{PACKSSDW} then splits this 128-bit word into
8202 four doublewords, converts each to a word, and loads them side by
8203 side into the destination register; \c{PACKSSWB} and \c{PACKUSWB}
8204 both split the 128-bit word into eight words, converts each to a
8205 byte, and loads \e{those} side by side into the destination
8208 \c{PACKSSDW} and \c{PACKSSWB} perform signed saturation when
8209 reducing the length of numbers: if the number is too large to fit
8210 into the reduced space, they replace it by the largest signed number
8211 (\c{7FFFh} or \c{7Fh}) that \e{will} fit, and if it is too small
8212 then they replace it by the smallest signed number (\c{8000h} or
8213 \c{80h}) that will fit. \c{PACKUSWB} performs unsigned saturation:
8214 it treats its input as unsigned, and replaces it by the largest
8215 unsigned number that will fit.
8217 \H{insPADDB} \i\c{PADDxx}: MMX Packed Addition
8219 \c PADDB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F FC /r [PENT,MMX]
8220 \c PADDW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F FD /r [PENT,MMX]
8221 \c PADDD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F FE /r [PENT,MMX]
8223 \c PADDSB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F EC /r [PENT,MMX]
8224 \c PADDSW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F ED /r [PENT,MMX]
8226 \c PADDUSB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F DC /r [PENT,MMX]
8227 \c PADDUSW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F DD /r [PENT,MMX]
8229 \c{PADDxx} all perform packed addition between their two 64-bit
8230 operands, storing the result in the destination (first) operand. The
8231 \c{PADDxB} forms treat the 64-bit operands as vectors of eight
8232 bytes, and add each byte individually; \c{PADDxW} treat the operands
8233 as vectors of four words; and \c{PADDD} treats its operands as
8234 vectors of two doublewords.
8236 \c{PADDSB} and \c{PADDSW} perform signed saturation on the sum of
8237 each pair of bytes or words: if the result of an addition is too
8238 large or too small to fit into a signed byte or word result, it is
8239 clipped (saturated) to the largest or smallest value which \e{will}
8240 fit. \c{PADDUSB} and \c{PADDUSW} similarly perform unsigned
8241 saturation, clipping to \c{0FFh} or \c{0FFFFh} if the result is
8244 \H{insPADDSIW} \i\c{PADDSIW}: MMX Packed Addition to Implicit
8247 \c PADDSIW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 51 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8249 \c{PADDSIW}, specific to the Cyrix extensions to the MMX instruction
8250 set, performs the same function as \c{PADDSW}, except that the
8251 result is not placed in the register specified by the first operand,
8252 but instead in the register whose number differs from the first
8253 operand only in the last bit. So \c{PADDSIW MM0,MM2} would put the
8254 result in \c{MM1}, but \c{PADDSIW MM1,MM2} would put the result in
8257 \H{insPAND} \i\c{PAND}, \i\c{PANDN}: MMX Bitwise AND and AND-NOT
8259 \c PAND mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F DB /r [PENT,MMX]
8260 \c PANDN mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F DF /r [PENT,MMX]
8262 \c{PAND} performs a bitwise AND operation between its two operands
8263 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if the corresponding
8264 bits of the two inputs were both 1), and stores the result in the
8265 destination (first) operand.
8267 \c{PANDN} performs the same operation, but performs a one's
8268 complement operation on the destination (first) operand first.
8270 \H{insPAVEB} \i\c{PAVEB}: MMX Packed Average
8272 \c PAVEB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 50 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8274 \c{PAVEB}, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats its two
8275 operands as vectors of eight unsigned bytes, and calculates the
8276 average of the corresponding bytes in the operands. The resulting
8277 vector of eight averages is stored in the first operand.
8280 \H{insPAVGB} \i\c{PAVGB}: Packed Average
8282 \c PAVGB mmxreg,mmxreg ; 0F,E0, /r [KATMAI,MMX]
8283 \c PAVGB mmxreg,memory ; 0F,E3, /r [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
8286 \H{insPAVGW} \i\c{PAVGW}: Packed Average
8288 \c PAVGW mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX]
8289 \c PAVGW mmxreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
8291 \c{PAVGB} The PAVG instructions add the unsigned data elements
8292 of the source operand to the unsigned data elements of the
8293 destination register, along with a carry-in. The results of
8294 the add are then each independently right-shifted by one bit
8295 position. The high order bits of each element are filled with
8296 the carry bits of the corresponding sum. The destination operand
8297 is an MMXTM technology register. The source operand can either
8298 be an MMXTM technology register or a 64-bit memory operand.
8299 The PAVGB instruction operates on packed unsigned bytes, and
8300 the PAVGW instruction operates on packed unsigned words.
8303 \H{insPAVGUSB} \i\c{PAVGUSB}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8305 \c PAVGUSB mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8306 \c PAVGUSB mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8308 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8311 \H{insPCMPEQB} \i\c{PCMPxx}: MMX Packed Comparison
8313 \c PCMPEQB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 74 /r [PENT,MMX]
8314 \c PCMPEQW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 75 /r [PENT,MMX]
8315 \c PCMPEQD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 76 /r [PENT,MMX]
8317 \c PCMPGTB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 64 /r [PENT,MMX]
8318 \c PCMPGTW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 65 /r [PENT,MMX]
8319 \c PCMPGTD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 66 /r [PENT,MMX]
8321 The \c{PCMPxx} instructions all treat their operands as vectors of
8322 bytes, words, or doublewords; corresponding elements of the source
8323 and destination are compared, and the corresponding element of the
8324 destination (first) operand is set to all zeros or all ones
8325 depending on the result of the comparison.
8327 \c{PCMPxxB} treats the operands as vectors of eight bytes,
8328 \c{PCMPxxW} treats them as vectors of four words, and \c{PCMPxxD} as
8331 \c{PCMPEQx} sets the corresponding element of the destination
8332 operand to all ones if the two elements compared are equal;
8333 \c{PCMPGTx} sets the destination element to all ones if the element
8334 of the first (destination) operand is greater (treated as a signed
8335 integer) than that of the second (source) operand.
8337 \H{insPDISTIB} \i\c{PDISTIB}: MMX Packed Distance and Accumulate
8338 with Implied Register
8340 \c PDISTIB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 54 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8342 \c{PDISTIB}, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats its two
8343 input operands as vectors of eight unsigned bytes. For each byte
8344 position, it finds the absolute difference between the bytes in that
8345 position in the two input operands, and adds that value to the byte
8346 in the same position in the implied output register. The addition is
8347 saturated to an unsigned byte in the same way as \c{PADDUSB}.
8349 The implied output register is found in the same way as \c{PADDSIW}
8352 Note that \c{PDISTIB} cannot take a register as its second source
8356 \H{insPEXTRW} \i\c{PEXTRW}: Extract Word
8358 \c PEXTRW reg32,mmxreg,immediate ; 0F,C5,/r,ib [KATMAI,MMX,SB,AR2]
8360 \c{PEXTRW}PEXTRW instruction moves the word in MM (selected by the
8361 two least significant bits of imm8) to the lower half of a 32-bit
8365 \H{insPF2ID} \i\c{PF2ID}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8367 \c PF2ID mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8368 \c PF2ID mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8370 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8373 \H{insPFACC} \i\c{PFACC}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8375 \c PFACC mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8376 \c PFACC mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8378 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8381 \H{insPFADD} \i\c{PFADD}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8383 \c PFADD mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8384 \c PFADD mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8386 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8389 \H{insPFCMPEQ} \i\c{PFCMPEQ}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8391 \c PFCMPEQ mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8392 \c PFCMPEQ mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8394 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8397 \H{insPFCMPGE} \i\c{PFCMPGE}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8399 \c PFCMPGE mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8400 \c PFCMPGE mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8402 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8405 \H{insPFCMPGT} \i\c{PFCMPGT}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8407 \c PFCMPGT mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8408 \c PFCMPGT mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8410 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8413 \H{insPFMAX} \i\c{PFMAX}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8415 \c PFMAX mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8416 \c PFMAX mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8418 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8421 \H{insPFMIN} \i\c{PFMIN}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8423 \c PFMIN mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8424 \c PFMIN mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8426 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8429 \H{insPFMUL} \i\c{PFMUL}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8431 \c PFMUL mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8432 \c PFMUL mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8434 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8437 \H{insPFRCP} \i\c{PFRCP}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8439 \c PFRCP mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8440 \c PFRCP mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8442 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8445 \H{insPFRCPIT1} \i\c{PFRCPIT1}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8447 \c PFRCPIT1 mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8448 \c PFRCPIT1 mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8450 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8453 \H{insPFRCPIT2} \i\c{PFRCPIT2}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8455 \c PFRCPIT2 mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8456 \c PFRCPIT2 mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8458 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8461 \H{insPFRSQIT1} \i\c{PFRSQIT1}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8463 \c PFRSQIT1 mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8464 \c PFRSQIT1 mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8466 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8469 \H{insPFRSQRT} \i\c{PFRSQRT}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8471 \c PFRSQRT mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8472 \c PFRSQRT mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8474 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8477 \H{insPFSUB} \i\c{PFSUB}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8479 \c PFSUB mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8480 \c PFSUB mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8482 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8485 \H{insPFSUBR} \i\c{PFSUBR}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8487 \c PFSUBR mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8488 \c PFSUBR mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8490 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8493 \H{insPI2FD} \i\c{PI2FD}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8495 \c PI2FD mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8496 \c PI2FD mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8498 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8501 \H{insPINSRW} \i\c{PINSRW}: Insert Word
8503 \c PINSRW mmxreg,reg16,immediate ;0F,C4,/r,ib [KATMAI,MMX,SB,AR2]
8504 \c PINSRW mmxreg,reg32,immediate ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SB,AR2,ND]
8505 \c PINSRW mmxreg,memory,immediate ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SB,AR2]
8506 \c PINSRW mmxreg,memory|bits16,immediate ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SB,AR2,ND]
8508 \c{PINSRW} The PINSRW instruction loads a word from the lower half
8509 of a 32-bit integer register (or from memory) and inserts it in
8510 the MM destination register, at a position defined by the two
8511 least significant bits of the imm8 constant. The insertion is
8512 done in such a way that the three other words from the
8513 destination register are left untouched.
8516 \H{insPMACHRIW} \i\c{PMACHRIW}: MMX Packed Multiply and Accumulate
8519 \c PMACHRIW mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5E /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8521 \c{PMACHRIW} acts almost identically to \c{PMULHRIW}
8522 (\k{insPMULHRW}), but instead of \e{storing} its result in the
8523 implied destination register, it \e{adds} its result, as four packed
8524 words, to the implied destination register. No saturation is done:
8525 the addition can wrap around.
8527 Note that \c{PMACHRIW} cannot take a register as its second source
8530 \H{insPMADDWD} \i\c{PMADDWD}: MMX Packed Multiply and Add
8532 \c PMADDWD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F F5 /r [PENT,MMX]
8534 \c{PMADDWD} treats its two inputs as vectors of four signed words.
8535 It multiplies corresponding elements of the two operands, giving
8536 four signed doubleword results. The top two of these are added and
8537 placed in the top 32 bits of the destination (first) operand; the
8538 bottom two are added and placed in the bottom 32 bits.
8540 \H{insPMAGW} \i\c{PMAGW}: MMX Packed Magnitude
8542 \c PMAGW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 52 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8544 \c{PMAGW}, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats both its
8545 operands as vectors of four signed words. It compares the absolute
8546 values of the words in corresponding positions, and sets each word
8547 of the destination (first) operand to whichever of the two words in
8548 that position had the larger absolute value.
8550 \H{insPMAXSW} \i\c{PMAXSW}: Packed Signed Integer Word Maximum
8552 \c PMAXSW mmxreg,mmxreg ; 0F,EE, /r [KATMAI,MMX]
8553 \c PMAXSW mmxreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
8555 \c{PMAXSW} The PMAXSW instruction returns the maximum between
8556 the four signed words in MM1 and MM2/Mem.
8559 \H{insPMAXUB} \i\c{PMAXUB}: Packed Unsigned Integer Byte Maximum
8561 \c PMAXUB mmxreg,mmxreg ; 0F,DE, /r [KATMAI,MMX]
8562 \c PMAXUB mmxreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
8564 \c{PMAXUB} The PMAXUB instruction returns the maximum between
8565 the eight unsigned words in MM1 and MM2/Mem.
8568 \H{insPMINSW} \i\c{PMINSW}: Packed Signed Integer Word Minimum
8570 \c PMINSW mmxreg,mmxreg ; 0F,EA, /r [KATMAI,MMX]
8571 \c PMINSW mmxreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
8573 \c{PMINSW} The PMINSW instruction returns the minimum between
8574 the four signed words in MM1 and MM2/Mem.
8577 \H{insPMINUB} \i\c{PMINUB}: Packed Unsigned Integer Byte Minimum
8579 \c PMINUB mmxreg,mmxreg ; 0F,DA, /r [KATMAI,MMX]
8580 \c PMINUB mmxreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
8582 \c{PMINUB}The PMINUB instruction returns the minimum between
8583 the eight unsigned words in MM1 and MM2/Mem.
8586 \H{insPMOVMSKB} \i\c{PMOVMSKB}: Move Byte Mask To Integer
8588 \c PMOVMSKB reg32,mmxreg ; 0F,D7,/r [KATMAI,MMX]
8590 \c{PMOVMSKB} The PMOVMSKB instruction returns an 8-bit mask
8591 formed of the most significant bits of each byte of its
8595 \H{insPMULHRW} \i\c{PMULHRW}, \i\c{PMULHRIW}: MMX Packed Multiply
8598 \c PMULHRW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 59 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8599 \c PMULHRIW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 5D /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8601 These instructions, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treat
8602 their operands as vectors of four signed words. Words in
8603 corresponding positions are multiplied, to give a 32-bit value in
8604 which bits 30 and 31 are guaranteed equal. Bits 30 to 15 of this
8605 value (bit mask \c{0x7FFF8000}) are taken and stored in the
8606 corresponding position of the destination operand, after first
8607 rounding the low bit (equivalent to adding \c{0x4000} before
8608 extracting bits 30 to 15).
8610 For \c{PMULHRW}, the destination operand is the first operand; for
8611 \c{PMULHRIW} the destination operand is implied by the first operand
8612 in the manner of \c{PADDSIW} (\k{insPADDSIW}).
8615 \H{insPMULHRWA} \i\c{PMULHRWA}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8617 \c PMULHRWA mmxreg,memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8618 \c PMULHRWA mmxreg,mmxreg ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW]
8620 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8623 \H{insPMULHUW} \i\c{PMULHUW}: Packed Multiply High Unsigned
8625 \c PMULHUW mmxreg,mmxreg ; 0F,E4,/r [KATMAI,MMX]
8626 \c PMULHUW mmxreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
8628 \c{PMULHUW} The PMULHUW instruction multiplies the four unsigned
8629 words in the destination operand with the four unsigned words
8630 in the source operand. The high-order 16 bits of the 32-bit
8631 intermediate results are written to the destination operand.
8634 \H{insPMULHW} \i\c{PMULHW}, \i\c{PMULLW}: MMX Packed Multiply
8636 \c PMULHW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F E5 /r [PENT,MMX]
8637 \c PMULLW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F D5 /r [PENT,MMX]
8639 \c{PMULxW} treats its two inputs as vectors of four signed words. It
8640 multiplies corresponding elements of the two operands, giving four
8641 signed doubleword results.
8643 \c{PMULHW} then stores the top 16 bits of each doubleword in the
8644 destination (first) operand; \c{PMULLW} stores the bottom 16 bits of
8645 each doubleword in the destination operand.
8648 \H{insPMVccZB} \i\c{PMVccZB}: MMX Packed Conditional Move
8650 \c PMVZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 58 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8651 \c PMVNZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5A /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8652 \c PMVLZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5B /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8653 \c PMVGEZB mmxreg,mem64 ; 0F 5C /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8655 These instructions, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, perform
8656 parallel conditional moves. The two input operands are treated as
8657 vectors of eight bytes. Each byte of the destination (first) operand
8658 is either written from the corresponding byte of the source (second)
8659 operand, or left alone, depending on the value of the byte in the
8660 \e{implied} operand (specified in the same way as \c{PADDSIW}, in
8663 \c{PMVZB} performs each move if the corresponding byte in the
8664 implied operand is zero. \c{PMVNZB} moves if the byte is non-zero.
8665 \c{PMVLZB} moves if the byte is less than zero, and \c{PMVGEZB}
8666 moves if the byte is greater than or equal to zero.
8668 Note that these instructions cannot take a register as their second
8671 \H{insPOP} \i\c{POP}: Pop Data from Stack
8673 \c POP reg16 ; o16 58+r [8086]
8674 \c POP reg32 ; o32 58+r [386]
8676 \c POP r/m16 ; o16 8F /0 [8086]
8677 \c POP r/m32 ; o32 8F /0 [386]
8679 \c POP CS ; 0F [8086,UNDOC]
8680 \c POP DS ; 1F [8086]
8681 \c POP ES ; 07 [8086]
8682 \c POP SS ; 17 [8086]
8683 \c POP FS ; 0F A1 [386]
8684 \c POP GS ; 0F A9 [386]
8686 \c{POP} loads a value from the stack (from \c{[SS:SP]} or
8687 \c{[SS:ESP]}) and then increments the stack pointer.
8689 The address-size attribute of the instruction determines whether
8690 \c{SP} or \c{ESP} is used as the stack pointer: to deliberately
8691 override the default given by the \c{BITS} setting, you can use an
8692 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
8694 The operand-size attribute of the instruction determines whether the
8695 stack pointer is incremented by 2 or 4: this means that segment
8696 register pops in \c{BITS 32} mode will pop 4 bytes off the stack and
8697 discard the upper two of them. If you need to override that, you can
8698 use an \i\c{o16} or \i\c{o32} prefix.
8700 The above opcode listings give two forms for general-purpose
8701 register pop instructions: for example, \c{POP BX} has the two forms
8702 \c{5B} and \c{8F C3}. NASM will always generate the shorter form
8703 when given \c{POP BX}. NDISASM will disassemble both.
8705 \c{POP CS} is not a documented instruction, and is not supported on
8706 any processor above the 8086 (since they use \c{0Fh} as an opcode
8707 prefix for instruction set extensions). However, at least some 8086
8708 processors do support it, and so NASM generates it for completeness.
8710 \H{insPOPA} \i\c{POPAx}: Pop All General-Purpose Registers
8713 \c POPAW ; o16 61 [186]
8714 \c POPAD ; o32 61 [386]
8716 \c{POPAW} pops a word from the stack into each of, successively,
8717 \c{DI}, \c{SI}, \c{BP}, nothing (it discards a word from the stack
8718 which was a placeholder for \c{SP}), \c{BX}, \c{DX}, \c{CX} and
8719 \c{AX}. It is intended to reverse the operation of \c{PUSHAW} (see
8720 \k{insPUSHA}), but it ignores the value for \c{SP} that was pushed
8721 on the stack by \c{PUSHAW}.
8723 \c{POPAD} pops twice as much data, and places the results in
8724 \c{EDI}, \c{ESI}, \c{EBP}, nothing (placeholder for \c{ESP}),
8725 \c{EBX}, \c{EDX}, \c{ECX} and \c{EAX}. It reverses the operation of
8728 \c{POPA} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{POPAW} or \c{POPAD},
8729 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
8731 Note that the registers are popped in reverse order of their numeric
8732 values in opcodes (see \k{iref-rv}).
8734 \H{insPOPF} \i\c{POPFx}: Pop Flags Register
8737 \c POPFW ; o16 9D [186]
8738 \c POPFD ; o32 9D [386]
8740 \c{POPFW} pops a word from the stack and stores it in the bottom 16
8741 bits of the flags register (or the whole flags register, on
8742 processors below a 386). \c{POPFD} pops a doubleword and stores it
8743 in the entire flags register.
8745 \c{POPF} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{POPFW} or \c{POPFD},
8746 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
8748 See also \c{PUSHF} (\k{insPUSHF}).
8750 \H{insPOR} \i\c{POR}: MMX Bitwise OR
8752 \c POR mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F EB /r [PENT,MMX]
8754 \c{POR} performs a bitwise OR operation between its two operands
8755 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if at least one of the
8756 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
8757 in the destination (first) operand.
8760 \H{insPREFETCHNTA} \i\c{PREFETCHNTA}: Prefetch
8762 \c PREFETCHNTA memory ; 0F,18,/0 [KATMAI]
8764 \c{PREFETCHNTA} Move data specified by address closer to the
8765 processor using the nta hint.
8768 \H{insPREFETCHT0} \i\c{PREFETCHT0}: Prefetch
8770 \c PREFETCHT0 memory ; 0F,18,/1 [KATMAI]
8772 \c{PREFETCHT0} Move data specified by address closer to the
8773 processor using the t0 hint.
8776 \H{insPREFETCHT1} \i\c{PREFETCHT1}: Prefetch
8778 \c PREFETCHT1 memory ; 0F,18,/2 [KATMAI]
8780 \c{PREFETCHT1}Move data specified by address closer to the
8781 processor using the t1 hint.
8784 \H{insPREFETCHT2} \i\c{PREFETCHT2}: Prefetch
8786 \c PREFETCHT2 memory ; 0F,18,/3 [KATMAI]
8788 \c{PREFETCHT2} Move data specified by address closer to the
8789 processor using the t2 hint.
8792 \H{insPREFETCH} \i\c{PREFETCH}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8794 \c PREFETCH memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8796 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8799 \H{insPREFETCHW} \i\c{PREFETCHW}: 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8801 \c PREFETCHW memory ; ?? [PENT,3DNOW,SM]
8803 3dnow instruction (duh!)
8809 \H{insPSADBW} \i\c{PSADBW}: Packed Sum of Absolute Differences
8811 \c PSADBW mmxreg,mmxreg ; 0F,F6, /r [KATMAI,MMX]
8812 \c PSADBW mmxreg,memory ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SM]
8814 \c{PSADBW} The PSADBW instruction computes the absolute value of
8815 the difference of unsigned bytes for mm1 and mm2/m64. These
8816 differences are then summed to produce a word result in the lower
8817 16-bit field; the upper three words are cleared. The destination
8818 operand is an MMXTM technology register. The source operand can
8819 either be an MMXTM technology register or a 64-bit memory operand.
8822 \H{insPSHUFW} \i\c{PSHUFW}: Packed Shuffle Word
8824 \c PSHUFW mmxreg,mmxreg,immediate ; 0F,70,/r,ib [KATMAI,MMX,SB,AR2]
8825 \c PSHUFW mmxreg,memory,immediate ; ?? [KATMAI,MMX,SM2,SB,AR2]
8827 \c{PSHUFW} The PSHUF instruction uses the imm8 operand to select
8828 which of the four words in MM2/Mem will be placed in each of the
8829 words in MM1. Bits 1 and 0 of imm8 encode the source for
8830 destination word 0 (MM1[15-0]), bits 3 and 2 encode for word 1,
8831 bits 5 and 4 encode for word 2, and bits 7 and 6 encode for
8832 word 3 (MM1[63-48]). Similarly, the two-bit encoding represents
8833 which source word is to be used, e.g., a binary encoding of 10
8834 indicates that source word 2 (MM2/Mem[47-32]) will be used.
8837 \H{insPSLLD} \i\c{PSLLx}, \i\c{PSRLx}, \i\c{PSRAx}: MMX Bit Shifts
8839 \c PSLLW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F F1 /r [PENT,MMX]
8840 \c PSLLW mmxreg,imm8 ; 0F 71 /6 ib [PENT,MMX]
8842 \c PSLLD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F F2 /r [PENT,MMX]
8843 \c PSLLD mmxreg,imm8 ; 0F 72 /6 ib [PENT,MMX]
8845 \c PSLLQ mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F F3 /r [PENT,MMX]
8846 \c PSLLQ mmxreg,imm8 ; 0F 73 /6 ib [PENT,MMX]
8848 \c PSRAW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F E1 /r [PENT,MMX]
8849 \c PSRAW mmxreg,imm8 ; 0F 71 /4 ib [PENT,MMX]
8851 \c PSRAD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F E2 /r [PENT,MMX]
8852 \c PSRAD mmxreg,imm8 ; 0F 72 /4 ib [PENT,MMX]
8854 \c PSRLW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F D1 /r [PENT,MMX]
8855 \c PSRLW mmxreg,imm8 ; 0F 71 /2 ib [PENT,MMX]
8857 \c PSRLD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F D2 /r [PENT,MMX]
8858 \c PSRLD mmxreg,imm8 ; 0F 72 /2 ib [PENT,MMX]
8860 \c PSRLQ mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F D3 /r [PENT,MMX]
8861 \c PSRLQ mmxreg,imm8 ; 0F 73 /2 ib [PENT,MMX]
8863 \c{PSxxQ} perform simple bit shifts on the 64-bit MMX registers: the
8864 destination (first) operand is shifted left or right by the number of
8865 bits given in the source (second) operand, and the vacated bits are
8866 filled in with zeros (for a logical shift) or copies of the original
8867 sign bit (for an arithmetic right shift).
8869 \c{PSxxW} and \c{PSxxD} perform packed bit shifts: the destination
8870 operand is treated as a vector of four words or two doublewords, and
8871 each element is shifted individually, so bits shifted out of one
8872 element do not interfere with empty bits coming into the next.
8874 \c{PSLLx} and \c{PSRLx} perform logical shifts: the vacated bits at
8875 one end of the shifted number are filled with zeros. \c{PSRAx}
8876 performs an arithmetic right shift: the vacated bits at the top of
8877 the shifted number are filled with copies of the original top (sign)
8880 \H{insPSUBB} \i\c{PSUBxx}: MMX Packed Subtraction
8882 \c PSUBB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F F8 /r [PENT,MMX]
8883 \c PSUBW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F F9 /r [PENT,MMX]
8884 \c PSUBD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F FA /r [PENT,MMX]
8886 \c PSUBSB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F E8 /r [PENT,MMX]
8887 \c PSUBSW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F E9 /r [PENT,MMX]
8889 \c PSUBUSB mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F D8 /r [PENT,MMX]
8890 \c PSUBUSW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F D9 /r [PENT,MMX]
8892 \c{PSUBxx} all perform packed subtraction between their two 64-bit
8893 operands, storing the result in the destination (first) operand. The
8894 \c{PSUBxB} forms treat the 64-bit operands as vectors of eight
8895 bytes, and subtract each byte individually; \c{PSUBxW} treat the operands
8896 as vectors of four words; and \c{PSUBD} treats its operands as
8897 vectors of two doublewords.
8899 In all cases, the elements of the operand on the right are
8900 subtracted from the corresponding elements of the operand on the
8901 left, not the other way round.
8903 \c{PSUBSB} and \c{PSUBSW} perform signed saturation on the sum of
8904 each pair of bytes or words: if the result of a subtraction is too
8905 large or too small to fit into a signed byte or word result, it is
8906 clipped (saturated) to the largest or smallest value which \e{will}
8907 fit. \c{PSUBUSB} and \c{PSUBUSW} similarly perform unsigned
8908 saturation, clipping to \c{0FFh} or \c{0FFFFh} if the result is
8911 \H{insPSUBSIW} \i\c{PSUBSIW}: MMX Packed Subtract with Saturation to
8914 \c PSUBSIW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 55 /r [CYRIX,MMX]
8916 \c{PSUBSIW}, specific to the Cyrix extensions to the MMX instruction
8917 set, performs the same function as \c{PSUBSW}, except that the
8918 result is not placed in the register specified by the first operand,
8919 but instead in the implied destination register, specified as for
8920 \c{PADDSIW} (\k{insPADDSIW}).
8922 \H{insPUNPCKHBW} \i\c{PUNPCKxxx}: Unpack Data
8924 \c PUNPCKHBW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 68 /r [PENT,MMX]
8925 \c PUNPCKHWD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 69 /r [PENT,MMX]
8926 \c PUNPCKHDQ mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 6A /r [PENT,MMX]
8928 \c PUNPCKLBW mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 60 /r [PENT,MMX]
8929 \c PUNPCKLWD mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 61 /r [PENT,MMX]
8930 \c PUNPCKLDQ mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F 62 /r [PENT,MMX]
8932 \c{PUNPCKxx} all treat their operands as vectors, and produce a new
8933 vector generated by interleaving elements from the two inputs. The
8934 \c{PUNPCKHxx} instructions start by throwing away the bottom half of
8935 each input operand, and the \c{PUNPCKLxx} instructions throw away
8938 The remaining elements, totalling 64 bits, are then interleaved into
8939 the destination, alternating elements from the second (source)
8940 operand and the first (destination) operand: so the leftmost element
8941 in the result always comes from the second operand, and the
8942 rightmost from the destination.
8944 \c{PUNPCKxBW} works a byte at a time, \c{PUNPCKxWD} a word at a
8945 time, and \c{PUNPCKxDQ} a doubleword at a time.
8947 So, for example, if the first operand held \c{0x7A6A5A4A3A2A1A0A}
8948 and the second held \c{0x7B6B5B4B3B2B1B0B}, then:
8950 \b \c{PUNPCKHBW} would return \c{0x7B7A6B6A5B5A4B4A}.
8952 \b \c{PUNPCKHWD} would return \c{0x7B6B7A6A5B4B5A4A}.
8954 \b \c{PUNPCKHDQ} would return \c{0x7B6B5B4B7A6A5A4A}.
8956 \b \c{PUNPCKLBW} would return \c{0x3B3A2B2A1B1A0B0A}.
8958 \b \c{PUNPCKLWD} would return \c{0x3B2B3A2A1B0B1A0A}.
8960 \b \c{PUNPCKLDQ} would return \c{0x3B2B1B0B3A2A1A0A}.
8962 \H{insPUSH} \i\c{PUSH}: Push Data on Stack
8964 \c PUSH reg16 ; o16 50+r [8086]
8965 \c PUSH reg32 ; o32 50+r [386]
8967 \c PUSH r/m16 ; o16 FF /6 [8086]
8968 \c PUSH r/m32 ; o32 FF /6 [386]
8970 \c PUSH CS ; 0E [8086]
8971 \c PUSH DS ; 1E [8086]
8972 \c PUSH ES ; 06 [8086]
8973 \c PUSH SS ; 16 [8086]
8974 \c PUSH FS ; 0F A0 [386]
8975 \c PUSH GS ; 0F A8 [386]
8977 \c PUSH imm8 ; 6A ib [286]
8978 \c PUSH imm16 ; o16 68 iw [286]
8979 \c PUSH imm32 ; o32 68 id [386]
8981 \c{PUSH} decrements the stack pointer (\c{SP} or \c{ESP}) by 2 or 4,
8982 and then stores the given value at \c{[SS:SP]} or \c{[SS:ESP]}.
8984 The address-size attribute of the instruction determines whether
8985 \c{SP} or \c{ESP} is used as the stack pointer: to deliberately
8986 override the default given by the \c{BITS} setting, you can use an
8987 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
8989 The operand-size attribute of the instruction determines whether the
8990 stack pointer is decremented by 2 or 4: this means that segment
8991 register pushes in \c{BITS 32} mode will push 4 bytes on the stack,
8992 of which the upper two are undefined. If you need to override that,
8993 you can use an \i\c{o16} or \i\c{o32} prefix.
8995 The above opcode listings give two forms for general-purpose
8996 \i{register push} instructions: for example, \c{PUSH BX} has the two
8997 forms \c{53} and \c{FF F3}. NASM will always generate the shorter
8998 form when given \c{PUSH BX}. NDISASM will disassemble both.
9000 Unlike the undocumented and barely supported \c{POP CS}, \c{PUSH CS}
9001 is a perfectly valid and sensible instruction, supported on all
9004 The instruction \c{PUSH SP} may be used to distinguish an 8086 from
9005 later processors: on an 8086, the value of \c{SP} stored is the
9006 value it has \e{after} the push instruction, whereas on later
9007 processors it is the value \e{before} the push instruction.
9009 \H{insPUSHA} \i\c{PUSHAx}: Push All General-Purpose Registers
9012 \c PUSHAD ; o32 60 [386]
9013 \c PUSHAW ; o16 60 [186]
9015 \c{PUSHAW} pushes, in succession, \c{AX}, \c{CX}, \c{DX}, \c{BX},
9016 \c{SP}, \c{BP}, \c{SI} and \c{DI} on the stack, decrementing the
9017 stack pointer by a total of 16.
9019 \c{PUSHAD} pushes, in succession, \c{EAX}, \c{ECX}, \c{EDX},
9020 \c{EBX}, \c{ESP}, \c{EBP}, \c{ESI} and \c{EDI} on the stack,
9021 decrementing the stack pointer by a total of 32.
9023 In both cases, the value of \c{SP} or \c{ESP} pushed is its
9024 \e{original} value, as it had before the instruction was executed.
9026 \c{PUSHA} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{PUSHAW} or \c{PUSHAD},
9027 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
9029 Note that the registers are pushed in order of their numeric values
9030 in opcodes (see \k{iref-rv}).
9032 See also \c{POPA} (\k{insPOPA}).
9034 \H{insPUSHF} \i\c{PUSHFx}: Push Flags Register
9037 \c PUSHFD ; o32 9C [386]
9038 \c PUSHFW ; o16 9C [186]
9040 \c{PUSHFW} pops a word from the stack and stores it in the bottom 16
9041 bits of the flags register (or the whole flags register, on
9042 processors below a 386). \c{PUSHFD} pops a doubleword and stores it
9043 in the entire flags register.
9045 \c{PUSHF} is an alias mnemonic for either \c{PUSHFW} or \c{PUSHFD},
9046 depending on the current \c{BITS} setting.
9048 See also \c{POPF} (\k{insPOPF}).
9050 \H{insPXOR} \i\c{PXOR}: MMX Bitwise XOR
9052 \c PXOR mmxreg,r/m64 ; 0F EF /r [PENT,MMX]
9054 \c{PXOR} performs a bitwise XOR operation between its two operands
9055 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if exactly one of the
9056 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
9057 in the destination (first) operand.
9059 \H{insRCL} \i\c{RCL}, \i\c{RCR}: Bitwise Rotate through Carry Bit
9061 \c RCL r/m8,1 ; D0 /2 [8086]
9062 \c RCL r/m8,CL ; D2 /2 [8086]
9063 \c RCL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /2 ib [286]
9064 \c RCL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /2 [8086]
9065 \c RCL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /2 [8086]
9066 \c RCL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /2 ib [286]
9067 \c RCL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /2 [386]
9068 \c RCL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /2 [386]
9069 \c RCL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /2 ib [386]
9071 \c RCR r/m8,1 ; D0 /3 [8086]
9072 \c RCR r/m8,CL ; D2 /3 [8086]
9073 \c RCR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /3 ib [286]
9074 \c RCR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /3 [8086]
9075 \c RCR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /3 [8086]
9076 \c RCR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /3 ib [286]
9077 \c RCR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /3 [386]
9078 \c RCR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /3 [386]
9079 \c RCR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /3 ib [386]
9081 \c{RCL} and \c{RCR} perform a 9-bit, 17-bit or 33-bit bitwise
9082 rotation operation, involving the given source/destination (first)
9083 operand and the carry bit. Thus, for example, in the operation
9084 \c{RCR AL,1}, a 9-bit rotation is performed in which \c{AL} is
9085 shifted left by 1, the top bit of \c{AL} moves into the carry flag,
9086 and the original value of the carry flag is placed in the low bit of
9089 The number of bits to rotate by is given by the second operand. Only
9090 the bottom five bits of the rotation count are considered by
9091 processors above the 8086.
9093 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
9094 byte) form of \c{RCL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{RCL
9095 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{RCR}.
9098 \H{insRCPPS} \i\c{RCPPS}: Packed Single-FP Reciprocal
9100 \c RCPPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,53,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9101 \c RCPPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9103 \c{RCPPS}RCPPS returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the
9104 SP FP numbers from xmm2/m128. The maximum error for this
9105 approximation is: Error <=1.5x2-12
9108 \H{insRCPSS} \i\c{RCPSS}: Scalar Single-FP Reciprocal
9110 \c RCPSS xmmreg,memory ; F3,0F,53,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9111 \c RCPSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9113 \c{RCPSS}RCPSS returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the
9114 lower SP FP number from xmm2/m32; the upper three fields are
9115 passed through from xmm1. The maximum error for this
9116 approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5x2-12
9119 \H{insRDMSR} \i\c{RDMSR}: Read Model-Specific Registers
9121 \c RDMSR ; 0F 32 [PENT]
9123 \c{RDMSR} reads the processor Model-Specific Register (MSR) whose
9124 index is stored in \c{ECX}, and stores the result in \c{EDX:EAX}.
9125 See also \c{WRMSR} (\k{insWRMSR}).
9127 \H{insRDPMC} \i\c{RDPMC}: Read Performance-Monitoring Counters
9129 \c RDPMC ; 0F 33 [P6]
9131 \c{RDPMC} reads the processor performance-monitoring counter whose
9132 index is stored in \c{ECX}, and stores the result in \c{EDX:EAX}.
9134 \H{insRDTSC} \i\c{RDTSC}: Read Time-Stamp Counter
9136 \c RDTSC ; 0F 31 [PENT]
9138 \c{RDTSC} reads the processor's time-stamp counter into \c{EDX:EAX}.
9140 \H{insRET} \i\c{RET}, \i\c{RETF}, \i\c{RETN}: Return from Procedure Call
9143 \c RET imm16 ; C2 iw [8086]
9146 \c RETF imm16 ; CA iw [8086]
9149 \c RETN imm16 ; C2 iw [8086]
9151 \c{RET}, and its exact synonym \c{RETN}, pop \c{IP} or \c{EIP} from
9152 the stack and transfer control to the new address. Optionally, if a
9153 numeric second operand is provided, they increment the stack pointer
9154 by a further \c{imm16} bytes after popping the return address.
9156 \c{RETF} executes a far return: after popping \c{IP}/\c{EIP}, it
9157 then pops \c{CS}, and \e{then} increments the stack pointer by the
9158 optional argument if present.
9160 \H{insROL} \i\c{ROL}, \i\c{ROR}: Bitwise Rotate
9162 \c ROL r/m8,1 ; D0 /0 [8086]
9163 \c ROL r/m8,CL ; D2 /0 [8086]
9164 \c ROL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /0 ib [286]
9165 \c ROL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /0 [8086]
9166 \c ROL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /0 [8086]
9167 \c ROL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /0 ib [286]
9168 \c ROL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /0 [386]
9169 \c ROL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /0 [386]
9170 \c ROL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /0 ib [386]
9172 \c ROR r/m8,1 ; D0 /1 [8086]
9173 \c ROR r/m8,CL ; D2 /1 [8086]
9174 \c ROR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /1 ib [286]
9175 \c ROR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /1 [8086]
9176 \c ROR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /1 [8086]
9177 \c ROR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /1 ib [286]
9178 \c ROR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /1 [386]
9179 \c ROR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /1 [386]
9180 \c ROR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /1 ib [386]
9182 \c{ROL} and \c{ROR} perform a bitwise rotation operation on the given
9183 source/destination (first) operand. Thus, for example, in the
9184 operation \c{ROR AL,1}, an 8-bit rotation is performed in which
9185 \c{AL} is shifted left by 1 and the original top bit of \c{AL} moves
9186 round into the low bit.
9188 The number of bits to rotate by is given by the second operand. Only
9189 the bottom 3, 4 or 5 bits (depending on the source operand size) of
9190 the rotation count are considered by processors above the 8086.
9192 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
9193 byte) form of \c{ROL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{ROL
9194 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{ROR}.
9196 \H{insRSM} \i\c{RSM}: Resume from System-Management Mode
9198 \c RSM ; 0F AA [PENT]
9200 \c{RSM} returns the processor to its normal operating mode when it
9201 was in System-Management Mode.
9204 \H{insRSQRTPS} \i\c{RSQRTPS}:Packed Single-FP Square Root Reciprocal
9206 \c RSQRTPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,52,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9207 \c RSQRTPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9209 \c{RSQRTPS} RSQRTPS returns an approximation of the reciprocal
9210 of the square root of the SP FP numbers rom xmm2/m128. The
9211 maximum error for this approximation is: Error| <= 1.5x2-12
9214 \H{insRSQRTSS} \i\c{RSQRTSS}:Scalar Single-FP Square Root Reciprocal
9216 \c RSQRTSS xmmreg,memory ; F3,0F,52,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9217 \c RSQRTSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9219 \c{RSQRTSS} RSQRTSS returns an approximation of the reciprocal
9220 of the square root of the lowest SP FP number from xmm2/m32;
9221 the upper three fields are passed through from xmm1. The maximum
9222 error for this approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5x2-12
9225 \H{insSAHF} \i\c{SAHF}: Store AH to Flags
9229 \c{SAHF} sets the low byte of the flags word according to the
9230 contents of the \c{AH} register. See also \c{LAHF} (\k{insLAHF}).
9232 \H{insSAL} \i\c{SAL}, \i\c{SAR}: Bitwise Arithmetic Shifts
9234 \c SAL r/m8,1 ; D0 /4 [8086]
9235 \c SAL r/m8,CL ; D2 /4 [8086]
9236 \c SAL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /4 ib [286]
9237 \c SAL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /4 [8086]
9238 \c SAL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /4 [8086]
9239 \c SAL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /4 ib [286]
9240 \c SAL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /4 [386]
9241 \c SAL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /4 [386]
9242 \c SAL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /4 ib [386]
9244 \c SAR r/m8,1 ; D0 /0 [8086]
9245 \c SAR r/m8,CL ; D2 /0 [8086]
9246 \c SAR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /0 ib [286]
9247 \c SAR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /0 [8086]
9248 \c SAR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /0 [8086]
9249 \c SAR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /0 ib [286]
9250 \c SAR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /0 [386]
9251 \c SAR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /0 [386]
9252 \c SAR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /0 ib [386]
9254 \c{SAL} and \c{SAR} perform an arithmetic shift operation on the given
9255 source/destination (first) operand. The vacated bits are filled with
9256 zero for \c{SAL}, and with copies of the original high bit of the
9257 source operand for \c{SAR}.
9259 \c{SAL} is a synonym for \c{SHL} (see \k{insSHL}). NASM will
9260 assemble either one to the same code, but NDISASM will always
9261 disassemble that code as \c{SHL}.
9263 The number of bits to shift by is given by the second operand. Only
9264 the bottom 3, 4 or 5 bits (depending on the source operand size) of
9265 the shift count are considered by processors above the 8086.
9267 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
9268 byte) form of \c{SAL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{SAL
9269 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{SAR}.
9271 \H{insSALC} \i\c{SALC}: Set AL from Carry Flag
9273 \c SALC ; D6 [8086,UNDOC]
9275 \c{SALC} is an early undocumented instruction similar in concept to
9276 \c{SETcc} (\k{insSETcc}). Its function is to set \c{AL} to zero if
9277 the carry flag is clear, or to \c{0xFF} if it is set.
9279 \H{insSBB} \i\c{SBB}: Subtract with Borrow
9281 \c SBB r/m8,reg8 ; 18 /r [8086]
9282 \c SBB r/m16,reg16 ; o16 19 /r [8086]
9283 \c SBB r/m32,reg32 ; o32 19 /r [386]
9285 \c SBB reg8,r/m8 ; 1A /r [8086]
9286 \c SBB reg16,r/m16 ; o16 1B /r [8086]
9287 \c SBB reg32,r/m32 ; o32 1B /r [386]
9289 \c SBB r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /3 ib [8086]
9290 \c SBB r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /3 iw [8086]
9291 \c SBB r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /3 id [386]
9293 \c SBB r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /3 ib [8086]
9294 \c SBB r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /3 ib [8086]
9296 \c SBB AL,imm8 ; 1C ib [8086]
9297 \c SBB AX,imm16 ; o16 1D iw [8086]
9298 \c SBB EAX,imm32 ; o32 1D id [386]
9300 \c{SBB} performs integer subtraction: it subtracts its second
9301 operand, plus the value of the carry flag, from its first, and
9302 leaves the result in its destination (first) operand. The flags are
9303 set according to the result of the operation: in particular, the
9304 carry flag is affected and can be used by a subsequent \c{SBB}
9307 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
9308 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
9309 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
9310 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
9311 form of the instruction.
9313 To subtract one number from another without also subtracting the
9314 contents of the carry flag, use \c{SUB} (\k{insSUB}).
9316 \H{insSCASB} \i\c{SCASB}, \i\c{SCASW}, \i\c{SCASD}: Scan String
9318 \c SCASB ; AE [8086]
9319 \c SCASW ; o16 AF [8086]
9320 \c SCASD ; o32 AF [386]
9322 \c{SCASB} compares the byte in \c{AL} with the byte at \c{[ES:DI]}
9323 or \c{[ES:EDI]}, and sets the flags accordingly. It then increments
9324 or decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the
9325 flag is clear, decrements if it is set) \c{DI} (or \c{EDI}).
9327 The register used is \c{DI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
9328 \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
9329 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
9330 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
9332 Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
9333 use of \c{ES} for the load from \c{[DI]} or \c{[EDI]} cannot be
9336 \c{SCASW} and \c{SCASD} work in the same way, but they compare a
9337 word to \c{AX} or a doubleword to \c{EAX} instead of a byte to
9338 \c{AL}, and increment or decrement the addressing registers by 2 or
9341 The \c{REPE} and \c{REPNE} prefixes (equivalently, \c{REPZ} and
9342 \c{REPNZ}) may be used to repeat the instruction up to \c{CX} (or
9343 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times until the
9344 first unequal or equal byte is found.
9346 \H{insSETcc} \i\c{SETcc}: Set Register from Condition
9348 \c SETcc r/m8 ; 0F 90+cc /2 [386]
9350 \c{SETcc} sets the given 8-bit operand to zero if its condition is
9351 not satisfied, and to 1 if it is.
9354 \H{insSFENCE} \i\c{SFENCE}: Store Fence
9356 \c SFENCE 0,0,0 ; 0F AE /7 [KATMAI]
9358 \c{SFENCE} Weakly ordered memory types can enable higher
9359 performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue,
9360 write-combining, and write-collapsing. Memory ordering issues
9361 can arise between a producer and a consumer of data and there
9362 are a number of common usage models which may be affected by
9363 weakly ordered stores:
9364 1. library functions, which use weakly ordered memory
9366 2. compiler-generated code, which also benefit from writing
9367 weakly-ordered results
9368 3. hand-written code
9369 The degree to which a consumer of data knows that the data is
9370 weakly ordered can vary for these cases. As a result, the SFENCE
9371 instruction provides a performance-efficient way of ensuring
9372 ordering between routines that produce weakly-ordered results
9373 and routines that consume this data. The SFENCE is ordered with
9374 respect to stores and other SFENCE instructions.
9375 SFENCE uses the following ModRM encoding:
9377 Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 111B
9379 All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use
9380 of these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.
9383 \H{insSGDT} \i\c{SGDT}, \i\c{SIDT}, \i\c{SLDT}: Store Descriptor Table Pointers
9385 \c SGDT mem ; 0F 01 /0 [286,PRIV]
9386 \c SIDT mem ; 0F 01 /1 [286,PRIV]
9387 \c SLDT r/m16 ; 0F 00 /0 [286,PRIV]
9389 \c{SGDT} and \c{SIDT} both take a 6-byte memory area as an operand:
9390 they store the contents of the GDTR (global descriptor table
9391 register) or IDTR (interrupt descriptor table register) into that
9392 area as a 32-bit linear address and a 16-bit size limit from that
9393 area (in that order). These are the only instructions which directly
9394 use \e{linear} addresses, rather than segment/offset pairs.
9396 \c{SLDT} stores the segment selector corresponding to the LDT (local
9397 descriptor table) into the given operand.
9399 See also \c{LGDT}, \c{LIDT} and \c{LLDT} (\k{insLGDT}).
9401 \H{insSHL} \i\c{SHL}, \i\c{SHR}: Bitwise Logical Shifts
9403 \c SHL r/m8,1 ; D0 /4 [8086]
9404 \c SHL r/m8,CL ; D2 /4 [8086]
9405 \c SHL r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /4 ib [286]
9406 \c SHL r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /4 [8086]
9407 \c SHL r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /4 [8086]
9408 \c SHL r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /4 ib [286]
9409 \c SHL r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /4 [386]
9410 \c SHL r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /4 [386]
9411 \c SHL r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /4 ib [386]
9413 \c SHR r/m8,1 ; D0 /5 [8086]
9414 \c SHR r/m8,CL ; D2 /5 [8086]
9415 \c SHR r/m8,imm8 ; C0 /5 ib [286]
9416 \c SHR r/m16,1 ; o16 D1 /5 [8086]
9417 \c SHR r/m16,CL ; o16 D3 /5 [8086]
9418 \c SHR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 C1 /5 ib [286]
9419 \c SHR r/m32,1 ; o32 D1 /5 [386]
9420 \c SHR r/m32,CL ; o32 D3 /5 [386]
9421 \c SHR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 C1 /5 ib [386]
9423 \c{SHL} and \c{SHR} perform a logical shift operation on the given
9424 source/destination (first) operand. The vacated bits are filled with
9427 A synonym for \c{SHL} is \c{SAL} (see \k{insSAL}). NASM will
9428 assemble either one to the same code, but NDISASM will always
9429 disassemble that code as \c{SHL}.
9431 The number of bits to shift by is given by the second operand. Only
9432 the bottom 3, 4 or 5 bits (depending on the source operand size) of
9433 the shift count are considered by processors above the 8086.
9435 You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a \c{C1}
9436 byte) form of \c{SHL foo,1} by using a \c{BYTE} prefix: \c{SHL
9437 foo,BYTE 1}. Similarly with \c{SHR}.
9439 \H{insSHLD} \i\c{SHLD}, \i\c{SHRD}: Bitwise Double-Precision Shifts
9441 \c SHLD r/m16,reg16,imm8 ; o16 0F A4 /r ib [386]
9442 \c SHLD r/m16,reg32,imm8 ; o32 0F A4 /r ib [386]
9443 \c SHLD r/m16,reg16,CL ; o16 0F A5 /r [386]
9444 \c SHLD r/m16,reg32,CL ; o32 0F A5 /r [386]
9446 \c SHRD r/m16,reg16,imm8 ; o16 0F AC /r ib [386]
9447 \c SHRD r/m32,reg32,imm8 ; o32 0F AC /r ib [386]
9448 \c SHRD r/m16,reg16,CL ; o16 0F AD /r [386]
9449 \c SHRD r/m32,reg32,CL ; o32 0F AD /r [386]
9451 \c{SHLD} performs a double-precision left shift. It notionally places
9452 its second operand to the right of its first, then shifts the entire
9453 bit string thus generated to the left by a number of bits specified
9454 in the third operand. It then updates only the \e{first} operand
9455 according to the result of this. The second operand is not modified.
9457 \c{SHRD} performs the corresponding right shift: it notionally
9458 places the second operand to the \e{left} of the first, shifts the
9459 whole bit string right, and updates only the first operand.
9461 For example, if \c{EAX} holds \c{0x01234567} and \c{EBX} holds
9462 \c{0x89ABCDEF}, then the instruction \c{SHLD EAX,EBX,4} would update
9463 \c{EAX} to hold \c{0x12345678}. Under the same conditions, \c{SHRD
9464 EAX,EBX,4} would update \c{EAX} to hold \c{0xF0123456}.
9466 The number of bits to shift by is given by the third operand. Only
9467 the bottom 5 bits of the shift count are considered.
9470 \H{insSHUFPS} \i\c{SHUFPS}: Shuffle Single-FP
9472 \c SHUFPS xmmreg,memory,immediate ; 0F,C6,/r, ib [KATMAI,SSE,SB,AR2]
9473 \c SHUFPS xmmreg,xmmreg,immediate ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE,SB,AR2]
9475 \c{SHUFPS} The SHUFPS instruction is able to shuffle any of the
9476 four SP FP numbers from xmm1 to the lower two destination fields;
9477 the upper two destination fields are generated from a shuffle of
9478 any of the four SP FP numbers from xmm2/m128.
9481 \H{insSMI} \i\c{SMI}: System Management Interrupt
9483 \c SMI ; F1 [386,UNDOC]
9485 This is an opcode apparently supported by some AMD processors (which
9486 is why it can generate the same opcode as \c{INT1}), and places the
9487 machine into system-management mode, a special debugging mode.
9489 \H{insSMSW} \i\c{SMSW}: Store Machine Status Word
9491 \c SMSW r/m16 ; 0F 01 /4 [286,PRIV]
9493 \c{SMSW} stores the bottom half of the \c{CR0} control register (or
9494 the Machine Status Word, on 286 processors) into the destination
9495 operand. See also \c{LMSW} (\k{insLMSW}).
9498 \H{insSQRTPS} \i\c{SQRTPS}: Packed Single-FP Square Root
9500 \c SQRTPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,51,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9501 \c SQRTPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9503 \c{SQRTPS} The SQRTPS instruction returns the square root of
9504 the packed SP FP numbers from xmm2/m128.
9507 \H{insSQRTSS} \i\c{SQRTSS}: Scalar Single-FP Square Root
9509 \c SQRTSS xmmreg,memory ; F3,0F,51,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9510 \c SQRTSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9512 \c{SQRTSS} The SQRTSS instructions return the square root of
9513 the lowest SP FP numbers of their operand.
9516 \H{insSTC} \i\c{STC}, \i\c{STD}, \i\c{STI}: Set Flags
9522 These instructions set various flags. \c{STC} sets the carry flag;
9523 \c{STD} sets the direction flag; and \c{STI} sets the interrupt flag
9524 (thus enabling interrupts).
9526 To clear the carry, direction, or interrupt flags, use the \c{CLC},
9527 \c{CLD} and \c{CLI} instructions (\k{insCLC}). To invert the carry
9528 flag, use \c{CMC} (\k{insCMC}).
9531 \H{insSTMXCSR} \i\c{STMXCSR}: Store Streaming SIMD Extension
9534 \c STMXCSR memory ; 0F,AE,/3 [KATMAI,SSE,SD]
9536 \c{STMXCSR} The MXCSR control/status register is used to enable
9537 masked/unmasked exception handling, to set rounding modes,
9538 to set flush-to-zero mode, and to view exception status flags.
9539 Refer to LDMXCSR for a description of the format of MXCSR.
9540 The linear address corresponds to the address of the
9541 least-significant byte of the referenced memory data.
9542 The reserved bits in the MXCSR are stored as zeroes.
9545 \H{insSTOSB} \i\c{STOSB}, \i\c{STOSW}, \i\c{STOSD}: Store Byte to String
9547 \c STOSB ; AA [8086]
9548 \c STOSW ; o16 AB [8086]
9549 \c STOSD ; o32 AB [386]
9551 \c{STOSB} stores the byte in \c{AL} at \c{[ES:DI]} or \c{[ES:EDI]},
9552 and sets the flags accordingly. It then increments or decrements
9553 (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag is clear,
9554 decrements if it is set) \c{DI} (or \c{EDI}).
9556 The register used is \c{DI} if the address size is 16 bits, and
9557 \c{EDI} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
9558 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
9559 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
9561 Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
9562 use of \c{ES} for the store to \c{[DI]} or \c{[EDI]} cannot be
9565 \c{STOSW} and \c{STOSD} work in the same way, but they store the
9566 word in \c{AX} or the doubleword in \c{EAX} instead of the byte in
9567 \c{AL}, and increment or decrement the addressing registers by 2 or
9570 The \c{REP} prefix may be used to repeat the instruction \c{CX} (or
9571 \c{ECX} - again, the address size chooses which) times.
9573 \H{insSTR} \i\c{STR}: Store Task Register
9575 \c STR r/m16 ; 0F 00 /1 [286,PRIV]
9577 \c{STR} stores the segment selector corresponding to the contents of
9578 the Task Register into its operand.
9580 \H{insSUB} \i\c{SUB}: Subtract Integers
9582 \c SUB r/m8,reg8 ; 28 /r [8086]
9583 \c SUB r/m16,reg16 ; o16 29 /r [8086]
9584 \c SUB r/m32,reg32 ; o32 29 /r [386]
9586 \c SUB reg8,r/m8 ; 2A /r [8086]
9587 \c SUB reg16,r/m16 ; o16 2B /r [8086]
9588 \c SUB reg32,r/m32 ; o32 2B /r [386]
9590 \c SUB r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /5 ib [8086]
9591 \c SUB r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /5 iw [8086]
9592 \c SUB r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /5 id [386]
9594 \c SUB r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /5 ib [8086]
9595 \c SUB r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /5 ib [386]
9597 \c SUB AL,imm8 ; 2C ib [8086]
9598 \c SUB AX,imm16 ; o16 2D iw [8086]
9599 \c SUB EAX,imm32 ; o32 2D id [386]
9601 \c{SUB} performs integer subtraction: it subtracts its second
9602 operand from its first, and leaves the result in its destination
9603 (first) operand. The flags are set according to the result of the
9604 operation: in particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used
9605 by a subsequent \c{SBB} instruction (\k{insSBB}).
9607 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
9608 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
9609 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
9610 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
9611 form of the instruction.
9613 \H{insSUBPS} \i\c{SUBPS}: Packed Single-FP Subtract
9615 \c SUBPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,5C,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9616 \c SUBPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9618 \c{SUBPS}T he SUBPS instruction subtracts the packed SP FP
9619 numbers of both their operands.
9622 \H{insSUBSS} \i\c{SUBSS}: Scalar Single-FP Subtract
9624 \c SUBSS xmmreg,memory ; F3,0F,5C, /r [KATMAI,SSE]
9625 \c SUBSS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9627 \c{SUBSS} The SUBSS instruction subtracts the lower SP FP
9628 numbers of both their operands.
9631 \H{insTEST} \i\c{TEST}: Test Bits (notional bitwise AND)
9633 \c TEST r/m8,reg8 ; 84 /r [8086]
9634 \c TEST r/m16,reg16 ; o16 85 /r [8086]
9635 \c TEST r/m32,reg32 ; o32 85 /r [386]
9637 \c TEST r/m8,imm8 ; F6 /7 ib [8086]
9638 \c TEST r/m16,imm16 ; o16 F7 /7 iw [8086]
9639 \c TEST r/m32,imm32 ; o32 F7 /7 id [386]
9641 \c TEST AL,imm8 ; A8 ib [8086]
9642 \c TEST AX,imm16 ; o16 A9 iw [8086]
9643 \c TEST EAX,imm32 ; o32 A9 id [386]
9645 \c{TEST} performs a `mental' bitwise AND of its two operands, and
9646 affects the flags as if the operation had taken place, but does not
9647 store the result of the operation anywhere.
9649 \H{insUCOMISS} \i\c{UCOMISS}: Unordered Scalar Single-FP compare
9652 \c UCOMISS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,2E,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9653 \c UCOMISS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9655 \c{UCOMISS} The UCOMISS instructions compare the two lowest scalar
9656 SP FP numbers, and set the ZF,PF,CF bits in the EFLAGS register
9657 as described above. In addition, the OF, SF, and AF bits in the
9658 EFLAGS register are zeroed out. The unordered predicate is
9659 returned if either source operand is a NaN (qNaN or sNaN).
9662 \H{insUMOV} \i\c{UMOV}: User Move Data
9664 \c UMOV r/m8,reg8 ; 0F 10 /r [386,UNDOC]
9665 \c UMOV r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F 11 /r [386,UNDOC]
9666 \c UMOV r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F 11 /r [386,UNDOC]
9668 \c UMOV reg8,r/m8 ; 0F 12 /r [386,UNDOC]
9669 \c UMOV reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F 13 /r [386,UNDOC]
9670 \c UMOV reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F 13 /r [386,UNDOC]
9672 This undocumented instruction is used by in-circuit emulators to
9673 access user memory (as opposed to host memory). It is used just like
9674 an ordinary memory/register or register/register \c{MOV}
9675 instruction, but accesses user space.
9678 \H{insUNPCKHPS} \i\c{UNPCKHPS}: Unpack High Packed Single-FP Data
9680 \c UNPCKHPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,15,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9681 \c UNPCKHPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9683 \c{UNPCKHPS} The UNPCKHPS instruction performs an interleaved
9684 unpack of the high-order data elements of XMM1 and XMM2/Mem.
9685 It ignores the lower half of the sources.
9688 \H{insUNPCKLPS} \i\c{UNPCKLPS}: Unpack Low Packed Single-FP Data
9690 \c UNPCKLPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,14,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9691 \c UNPCKLPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9693 \c{UNPCKLPS} The UNPCKLPS instruction performs an interleaved
9694 unpack of the low-order data elements of XMM1 and XMM2/Mem.
9695 It ignores the upper half part of the sources.
9698 \H{insVERR} \i\c{VERR}, \i\c{VERW}: Verify Segment Readability/Writability
9700 \c VERR r/m16 ; 0F 00 /4 [286,PRIV]
9702 \c VERW r/m16 ; 0F 00 /5 [286,PRIV]
9704 \c{VERR} sets the zero flag if the segment specified by the selector
9705 in its operand can be read from at the current privilege level.
9706 \c{VERW} sets the zero flag if the segment can be written.
9708 \H{insWAIT} \i\c{WAIT}: Wait for Floating-Point Processor
9712 \c{WAIT}, on 8086 systems with a separate 8087 FPU, waits for the
9713 FPU to have finished any operation it is engaged in before
9714 continuing main processor operations, so that (for example) an FPU
9715 store to main memory can be guaranteed to have completed before the
9716 CPU tries to read the result back out.
9718 On higher processors, \c{WAIT} is unnecessary for this purpose, and
9719 it has the alternative purpose of ensuring that any pending unmasked
9720 FPU exceptions have happened before execution continues.
9722 \H{insWBINVD} \i\c{WBINVD}: Write Back and Invalidate Cache
9724 \c WBINVD ; 0F 09 [486]
9726 \c{WBINVD} invalidates and empties the processor's internal caches,
9727 and causes the processor to instruct external caches to do the same.
9728 It writes the contents of the caches back to memory first, so no
9729 data is lost. To flush the caches quickly without bothering to write
9730 the data back first, use \c{INVD} (\k{insINVD}).
9732 \H{insWRMSR} \i\c{WRMSR}: Write Model-Specific Registers
9734 \c WRMSR ; 0F 30 [PENT]
9736 \c{WRMSR} writes the value in \c{EDX:EAX} to the processor
9737 Model-Specific Register (MSR) whose index is stored in \c{ECX}. See
9738 also \c{RDMSR} (\k{insRDMSR}).
9740 \H{insXADD} \i\c{XADD}: Exchange and Add
9742 \c XADD r/m8,reg8 ; 0F C0 /r [486]
9743 \c XADD r/m16,reg16 ; o16 0F C1 /r [486]
9744 \c XADD r/m32,reg32 ; o32 0F C1 /r [486]
9746 \c{XADD} exchanges the values in its two operands, and then adds
9747 them together and writes the result into the destination (first)
9748 operand. This instruction can be used with a \c{LOCK} prefix for
9749 multi-processor synchronisation purposes.
9751 \H{insXBTS} \i\c{XBTS}: Extract Bit String
9753 \c XBTS reg16,r/m16 ; o16 0F A6 /r [386,UNDOC]
9754 \c XBTS reg32,r/m32 ; o32 0F A6 /r [386,UNDOC]
9756 No clear documentation seems to be available for this instruction:
9757 the best I've been able to find reads `Takes a string of bits from
9758 the first operand and puts them in the second operand'. It is
9759 present only in early 386 processors, and conflicts with the opcodes
9760 for \c{CMPXCHG486}. NASM supports it only for completeness. Its
9761 counterpart is \c{IBTS} (see \k{insIBTS}).
9763 \H{insXCHG} \i\c{XCHG}: Exchange
9765 \c XCHG reg8,r/m8 ; 86 /r [8086]
9766 \c XCHG reg16,r/m8 ; o16 87 /r [8086]
9767 \c XCHG reg32,r/m32 ; o32 87 /r [386]
9769 \c XCHG r/m8,reg8 ; 86 /r [8086]
9770 \c XCHG r/m16,reg16 ; o16 87 /r [8086]
9771 \c XCHG r/m32,reg32 ; o32 87 /r [386]
9773 \c XCHG AX,reg16 ; o16 90+r [8086]
9774 \c XCHG EAX,reg32 ; o32 90+r [386]
9775 \c XCHG reg16,AX ; o16 90+r [8086]
9776 \c XCHG reg32,EAX ; o32 90+r [386]
9778 \c{XCHG} exchanges the values in its two operands. It can be used
9779 with a \c{LOCK} prefix for purposes of multi-processor
9782 \c{XCHG AX,AX} or \c{XCHG EAX,EAX} (depending on the \c{BITS}
9783 setting) generates the opcode \c{90h}, and so is a synonym for
9784 \c{NOP} (\k{insNOP}).
9786 \H{insXLATB} \i\c{XLATB}: Translate Byte in Lookup Table
9788 \c XLATB ; D7 [8086]
9790 \c{XLATB} adds the value in \c{AL}, treated as an unsigned byte, to
9791 \c{BX} or \c{EBX}, and loads the byte from the resulting address (in
9792 the segment specified by \c{DS}) back into \c{AL}.
9794 The base register used is \c{BX} if the address size is 16 bits, and
9795 \c{EBX} if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not
9796 equal to the current \c{BITS} setting, you can use an explicit
9797 \i\c{a16} or \i\c{a32} prefix.
9799 The segment register used to load from \c{[BX+AL]} or \c{[EBX+AL]}
9800 can be overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
9801 example, \c{es xlatb}).
9803 \H{insXOR} \i\c{XOR}: Bitwise Exclusive OR
9805 \c XOR r/m8,reg8 ; 30 /r [8086]
9806 \c XOR r/m16,reg16 ; o16 31 /r [8086]
9807 \c XOR r/m32,reg32 ; o32 31 /r [386]
9809 \c XOR reg8,r/m8 ; 32 /r [8086]
9810 \c XOR reg16,r/m16 ; o16 33 /r [8086]
9811 \c XOR reg32,r/m32 ; o32 33 /r [386]
9813 \c XOR r/m8,imm8 ; 80 /6 ib [8086]
9814 \c XOR r/m16,imm16 ; o16 81 /6 iw [8086]
9815 \c XOR r/m32,imm32 ; o32 81 /6 id [386]
9817 \c XOR r/m16,imm8 ; o16 83 /6 ib [8086]
9818 \c XOR r/m32,imm8 ; o32 83 /6 ib [386]
9820 \c XOR AL,imm8 ; 34 ib [8086]
9821 \c XOR AX,imm16 ; o16 35 iw [8086]
9822 \c XOR EAX,imm32 ; o32 35 id [386]
9824 \c{XOR} performs a bitwise XOR operation between its two operands
9825 (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if exactly one of the
9826 corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
9827 in the destination (first) operand.
9829 In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
9830 first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
9831 sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
9832 the \c{BYTE} qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
9833 form of the instruction.
9835 The MMX instruction \c{PXOR} (see \k{insPXOR}) performs the same
9836 operation on the 64-bit MMX registers.
9839 \H{insXORPS} \i\c{XORPS}: Bit-wise Logical Xor for Single-FP Data
9841 \c XORPS xmmreg,memory ; 0F,57,/r [KATMAI,SSE]
9842 \c XORPS xmmreg,xmmreg ; ?? [KATMAI,SSE]
9844 \c{XORPS} The XORPS instruction returns a bit-wise logical XOR
9845 between XMM1 and XMM2/Mem.